summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/38774-h/38774-h.htm
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to '38774-h/38774-h.htm')
-rw-r--r--38774-h/38774-h.htm13036
1 files changed, 13036 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/38774-h/38774-h.htm b/38774-h/38774-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ae90440
--- /dev/null
+++ b/38774-h/38774-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,13036 @@
+<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Transitional//EN" "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-transitional.dtd">
+<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en">
+ <head>
+ <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=iso-8859-1" />
+ <title>
+ The Project Gutenberg eBook of Oregon and Eldorado, by Thomas Bulfinch.
+ </title>
+ <style type="text/css">
+ p { margin-top: .5em;
+ text-align: justify;
+ margin-bottom: .5em;
+ text-indent: 1em;
+ }
+ h1 {
+ text-align: center; font-family: garamond, serif; /* all headings centered */
+ }
+ h5,h6 {
+ text-align: center; font-family: garamond, serif; /* all headings centered */
+ }
+ h2 {
+ text-align: center; font-family: garamond, serif; /* all headings centered */
+ }
+ h3 {
+ text-align: center; font-family: garamond, serif; /* all headings centered */
+ }
+ h4 {
+ text-align: center; font-family: garamond, serif; /* all headings centered */
+ }
+ hr { width: 33%;
+ margin-top: 1em;
+ margin-bottom: 1em;
+ }
+ body{margin-left: 10%;
+ margin-right: 10%;
+ }
+ a {text-decoration: none} /* no lines under links */
+ div.centered {text-align: center;} /* work around for IE centering with CSS problem part 1 */
+ div.centered table {margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto; text-align: left;} /* work around for IE centering with CSS problem part 2 */
+
+ .cen {text-align: center; text-indent: 0em;} /* centering paragraphs */
+ .smcap {font-variant: small-caps;} /* small caps */
+ .noin {text-indent: 0em;} /* no indenting */
+ .note {margin-left: 2em; margin-right: 2em; margin-bottom: 1em;} /* footnote */
+ .blockquot {margin-left: 5%; margin-right: 5%;} /* block indent */
+ .right {text-align: right; padding-right: 2em;} /* right aligning paragraphs */
+ .img {text-align: center; padding: 1em; margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto;} /* centering images */
+ .rightsig {width: 30%; text-align: right; position: absolute; right: 0; padding-right: 15%;} /* right sig */ .tdr {text-align: right;} /* right align cell */
+ .tdc {text-align: center;} /* center align cell */
+ .tdl {text-align: left;} /* left align cell */
+ .tr {margin-left: 15%; margin-right: 15%; margin-top: 5%; margin-bottom: 5%; padding: 1em; background-color: #f6f2f2; color: black; border: dotted black 1px;} /* transcriber's notes */
+
+ .pagenum { /* uncomment the next line for invisible page numbers */
+ /* visibility: hidden; */
+ position: absolute; right: 2%;
+ font-size: 75%;
+ color: silver;
+ background-color: inherit;
+ text-align: right;
+ text-indent: 0em;
+ font-style: normal;
+ font-weight: normal;
+ font-variant: normal;} /* page numbers */
+
+ .footnotes {border: dashed 1px;}
+ .footnote {margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; font-size: 90%;}
+ .footnote .label {position: absolute; right: 84%; text-align: right; font-size: 90%;}
+ .fnanchor {vertical-align: text-top; font-size: .8em; text-decoration: none;}
+
+ .poem {margin-left: 15%; margin-right: 15%; text-align: left;}
+ .poem br {display: none;}
+ .poem .stanza {margin: 1em 0em 1em 0em;}
+ .poem span {display: block; margin: 0; padding-left: 3em; text-indent: -3em;}
+ .poem span.i2 {display: block; margin-left: 2em;}
+ .poem span.i4 {display: block; margin-left: 4em;}
+ .poem span.pn { /* uncomment the next line for invisible page numbers */
+ /* visibility: hidden; */
+ position: absolute; right: 2%;
+ font-size: 75%;
+ text-align: right;
+ text-indent: 0em;
+ font-style: normal;
+ font-weight: normal;
+ color: silver; background-color: inherit;
+ font-variant: normal;} /* page numbers in poems */
+
+
+ </style>
+ </head>
+<body>
+
+
+<pre>
+
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of Oregon and Eldorado, by Thomas Bulfinch
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: Oregon and Eldorado
+ or, Romance of the Rivers
+
+Author: Thomas Bulfinch
+
+Release Date: February 6, 2012 [EBook #38774]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK OREGON AND ELDORADO ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Greg Bergquist, Barbara Kosker and the Online
+Distributed Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net (This
+file was produced from images generously made available
+by The Internet Archive/American Libraries.)
+
+
+
+
+
+
+</pre>
+
+
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+
+<h1>OREGON AND ELDORADO.</h1>
+
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+
+<h1>OREGON AND ELDORADO;</h1>
+
+<h4>OR,</h4>
+
+<h2>ROMANCE OF THE RIVERS.</h2>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+
+
+<h4>BY</h4>
+
+<h2>THOMAS BULFINCH,</h2>
+
+<h4>AUTHOR OF "THE AGE OF FABLE," "THE AGE OF CHIVALRY," ETC.</h4>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+
+<h4>BOSTON:<br />
+J. E. TILTON AND COMPANY.<br />
+1866.</h4>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+
+<h4>
+Entered, according to Act of Congress, in the year 1866, by<br />
+<span class="smcap">THOMAS BULFINCH</span>,<br />
+In the Clerk's Office of the District Court of the District of Massachusetts.</h4>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<h4>STEREOTYPED BY C. J. PETERS AND SON.</h4>
+<hr />
+<h4>PRINTED BY GEORGE C. RAND AND AVERY.</h4>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_ix" id="Page_ix">[Pg ix]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>PREFACE.</h2>
+<br />
+
+<p>When one observes attentively the maps of
+South and North America, no feature appears
+more striking than the provision which Nature
+seems to have made, in both continents, for water-communication
+across the breadth of each.
+In the Northern continent, this channel of communication
+is formed by the Missouri and Columbia
+Rivers, which stretch over an extent of
+three thousand miles, interrupted only by the
+ridge of the Rocky Mountains. In the Southern
+continent, the River Amazon, in its path from
+the Andes to the sea, traverses a course of thirty-three
+hundred miles. In both cases, a few
+hundred miles of land-carriage will complete the
+transit from ocean to ocean. The analogy presented
+in the length and direction of these magnificent
+water-pathways is preserved in their
+history. A series of romantic adventures attaches
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_x" id="Page_x">[Pg x]</a></span>to each. I indulge the hope, that young readers
+who have so favorably received my former attempts
+to amuse and instruct them, in my several
+works reviving the fabulous legends of remote
+ages, will find equally attractive these true narratives
+of bold adventure, whose date is comparatively
+recent. Moreover, their scenes are laid, in
+the one instance, in our own country; and, in the
+other, in that great and rising empire of Brazil
+to which our distinguished naturalist, Prof. Agassiz,
+has gone on a pilgrimage of science. It will
+enable us better to appreciate the discoveries and
+observations which the professor will lay before
+us on his return, to know something beforehand
+of the history and peculiarities of the region which
+is the scene of his labors; and, on the other hand,
+the route across the North-American continent,
+to which the first part of the volume relates, deprives
+increased interest, at this time, from the
+fact that it nearly corresponds to the route of
+the contemplated Northern Pacific Railroad.</p>
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Boston</span>, June 1866.<span class="rightsig">T. B.</span></p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_xi" id="Page_xi">[Pg xi]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CONTENTS.</h2>
+<br />
+<h3>OREGON</h3>
+<hr style="width: 15%;" />
+
+<div class="centered">
+<table border="0" width="65%" cellpadding="2" cellspacing="0" summary="Table of Contents">
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER I.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap" width="85%">Discovery of Columbia River</td>
+ <td class="tdr" width="15%"><a href="#Page_1">1</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER II.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Lewis and Clarke</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_14">14</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER III.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">The Sioux</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_23">23</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER IV.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Summary of Travel to Winter-Quarters</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_33">33</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER V.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Indian Tribes</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_45">45</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER VI.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">The March resumed</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_57">57</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER VII.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">The Journey continued</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_85">85</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_xii" id="Page_xii">[Pg xii]</a></span>CHAPTER VIII.
+ </td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">The Sources of the Missouri and Columbia</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_97">97</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER IX.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">The Party in the Boats</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_107">107</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER X.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">The Descent of the Columbia</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_120">120</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XI.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Clarke's River</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_131">131</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XII.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Kooskooskee River</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_147">147</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XIII.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Winter-Quarters</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_176">176</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XIV.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">A New Year</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_187">187</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XV.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Winter Life</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_197">197</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XVI.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">The Return</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_210">210</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XVII.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">The Rocky Mountains</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_230">230</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XVIII.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Capt. Clarke's Route down the Yellowstone</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_241">241</a></td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+</div>
+<h3>ELDORADO</h3>
+<hr style="width: 15%;" />
+<div class="centered">
+<table border="0" width="65%" cellpadding="2" cellspacing="0" summary="Table of Contents2">
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER I.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_xiii" id="Page_xiii">[Pg xiii]</a></span>
+</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap" width="85%">The Discovery</td>
+ <td class="tdr" width="15%"><a href="#Page_255">255</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER II.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Orellana descends the River</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_265">265</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER III.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Orellana's Adventure continued</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_275">275</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER IV.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Sir Walter Raleigh</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_285">285</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER V.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Raleigh's First Expedition</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_293">293</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER VI.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Raleigh's Adventures continued</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_307">307</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER VII.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Raleigh's Second Expedition</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_316">316</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER VIII.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">The French Philosophers</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_326">326</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_xiv" id="Page_xiv">[Pg xiv]</a></span>CHAPTER IX.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Madam Godin's Voyage down the Amazon</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_339">339</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER X.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Madame Godin's Voyage continued</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_349">349</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XI.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Herndon's Expedition</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_361">361</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XII.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Herndon's Expedition continued</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_373">373</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XIII.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Herndon's Expedition continued</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_387">387</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XIV.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Herndon's Expedition concluded</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_396">396</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XV.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Latest Explorations</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_404">404</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XVI.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">The Naturalist on the Amazon</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_427">427</a></td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdc">CHAPTER XVII.</td>
+ </tr>
+ <tr>
+ <td class="tdl smcap">Animated Nature</td>
+ <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_446">446</a></td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+</div>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_xv" id="Page_xv">[Pg xv]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>OREGON.</h2>
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_xvi" id="Page_xvi">[Pg xvi]</a></span>
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_1" id="Page_1">[Pg 1]</a></span>
+<br />
+<h2>OREGON.</h2>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER I.</h2>
+
+<h3>DISCOVERY OF COLUMBIA RIVER.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>A few years ago, there was still standing in
+Bowdoin Square, Boston, opposite the Revere
+House, an ancient mansion, since removed to make
+room for the granite range called the Coolidge Building.
+In that mansion, then neither old nor inelegant,
+but, on the contrary, having good pretensions to rank
+among the principal residences of the place, was assembled,
+in the year 1787, a group, consisting of the
+master of the mansion, Dr. Bulfinch, his only son
+Charles, and Joseph Barrell, their neighbor, an eminent
+merchant of Boston. The conversation turned
+upon the topic of the day,&mdash;the voyages and discoveries
+of Capt. Cook, the account of which had lately
+been published. The brilliant achievements of Capt.
+Cook, his admirable qualities, and his sad fate (slain
+by the chance stroke of a Sandwich-Islander, in a <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_2" id="Page_2">[Pg 2]</a></span>sudden
+brawl which arose between the sailors and the
+natives),&mdash;these formed the current of the conversation;
+till at last it changed, and turned more upon the
+commercial aspects of the subject. Mr. Barrell was
+particularly struck with what Cook relates of the
+abundance of valuable furs offered by the natives of
+the country in exchange for beads, knives, and other
+trifling commodities valued by them. The remark of
+Capt. Cook respecting the sea-otter was cited:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"This animal abounds here: the fur is softer and
+finer than that of any other we know of; and therefore
+the discovery of this part of the continent, where so
+valuable an article of commerce may be met with,
+cannot be a matter of indifference." He adds in a note,
+"The sea-otter skins are sold by the Russians to the
+Chinese at from sixteen to twenty pounds each."</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Barrell remarked, "There is a rich harvest to
+be reaped there by those who shall first go in." The
+idea thus suggested was followed out in future conversations
+at the doctor's fireside, admitting other congenial
+spirits to the discussion, and resulted in the
+equipping of an expedition consisting of two vessels,
+the ship "Columbia" and sloop "Washington," to make
+the proposed adventure. The partners in the enterprise
+were Joseph Barrell, Samuel Brown, Charles <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_3" id="Page_3">[Pg 3]</a></span>Bulfinch,
+John Derby, Crowell Hatch, and J. M. Pintard.
+So important was the expedition deemed by the adventurers
+themselves, that they caused a medal to be
+struck, bearing on one side a representation of the two
+vessels under sail, and on the other the names of the
+parties to the enterprise. Several copies of this medal
+were made both in bronze and silver, and distributed
+to public bodies and distinguished individuals.
+One of these medals lies before the writer as he pens
+these lines. A representation is subjoined:&mdash;</p>
+
+<div class="img">
+<img border="0" src="images/imagep003.jpg" width="50%" alt="Medal" />
+</div>
+
+<p>The expedition was also provided with sea-letters,
+issued by the Federal Government agreeably to a resolution
+of Congress, and with passports from the State
+of Massachusetts; and they received letters from the
+Spanish minister plenipotentiary in the United States,
+recommending them to the attention of the authorities
+of his nation on the Pacific coast.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_4" id="Page_4">[Pg 4]</a></span>The "Columbia" was commanded by John Kendrick,
+to whom was intrusted the general control of the
+expedition. The master of the "Washington" was
+Robert Gray.</p>
+
+<p>The two vessels sailed together from Boston on the
+30th of September, 1787: thence they proceeded to
+the Cape Verde Islands, and thence to the Falkland
+Islands, in each of which groups they procured refreshments.
+In January, 1788, they doubled Cape
+Horn; immediately after which they were separated
+during a violent gale. The "Washington," continuing
+her course through the Pacific, made the north-west
+coast in August, near the 46th degree of latitude.
+Here Capt. Gray thought he perceived indications of
+the mouth of a river; but he was unable to ascertain
+the fact, in consequence of his vessel having grounded,
+and been attacked by the savages, who killed one of
+his men, and wounded the mate. But she escaped
+without further injury, and, on the 17th of September,
+reached Nootka Sound, which had been agreed upon
+as the port of re-union in case of separation. The "Columbia"
+did not enter the sound until some days
+afterward.</p>
+
+<p>The two vessels spent their winter in the sound;
+where the "Columbia" also lay during the following
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_5" id="Page_5">[Pg 5]</a></span>summer, collecting furs, while Capt. Gray, in the
+"Washington," explored the adjacent waters. On his
+return to Nootka, it was agreed upon between the
+two captains that Kendrick should take command of
+the sloop, and remain on the coast, while Gray, in the
+"Columbia," should carry to Canton all the furs
+which had been collected by both vessels. This was
+accordingly done; and Gray arrived on the 6th of December
+at Canton, where he sold his furs, and took in
+a cargo of tea, with which he entered Boston on the
+10th of August, 1790, having carried the flag of the
+United States for the first time round the world.</p>
+
+<p>Kendrick, immediately on parting with the "Columbia,"
+proceeded with the "Washington" to the Strait
+of Fuca, through which he sailed, in its whole length,
+to its issue in the Pacific, in lat. 51. To him belongs
+the credit of ascertaining that Nootka and the parts
+adjacent are an island, to which the name of Vancouver's
+Island has since been given, which it now retains.
+Vancouver was a British commander who followed
+in the track of the Americans a year later.
+The injustice done to Kendrick by thus robbing him
+of the credit of his discovery is but one of many similar
+instances; the greatest of all being that by which
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_6" id="Page_6">[Pg 6]</a></span>our continent itself bears the name, not of Columbus,
+but of a subsequent navigator.</p>
+
+<p>Capt. Kendrick, during the time occupied by Gray
+in his return voyage, besides collecting furs, engaged
+in various speculations; one of which was the collection,
+and transportation to China, of the odoriferous
+wood called "sandal," which grows in many of the
+tropical islands of the Pacific, and is in great demand
+throughout the Celestial Empire, for ornamental fabrics,
+and also for medicinal purposes. Vancouver pronounced
+this scheme chimerical; but experience has
+shown that it was founded on just calculations, and the
+business has ever since been prosecuted with advantage,
+especially by Americans.</p>
+
+<p>Another of Kendrick's speculations has not hitherto
+produced any fruit. In the summer of 1791, he purchased
+from Maquinna, Wicanish, and other Indian
+chiefs, several large tracts of land near Nootka
+Sound, for which he obtained deeds, duly <i>marked</i> by
+those personages, and witnessed by the officers and
+men of the "Washington." Attempts were afterwards
+made by the owners of the vessel to sell these lands
+in London, but no purchasers were found; and applications
+have since been addressed by the legal representatives
+of the owners to the Government of the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_7" id="Page_7">[Pg 7]</a></span>United States for a confirmation of the title, but
+hitherto without success.</p>
+
+<p>Capt. Kendrick lost his life by a singular accident.
+In exchanging salutes with a Spanish vessel
+which they met at the Sandwich Islands, the wad of
+the gun of the Spaniard struck Capt. Kendrick as he
+stood on the deck of his vessel, conspicuous in his
+dress-coat and cocked hat as commander of the expedition.
+It was instantly fatal.</p>
+
+<p>The ship "Columbia" returned to Boston from Canton
+under the command of Gray, as already stated,
+arriving on the 10th of August, 1790; but the cargo
+of Chinese articles brought by her was insufficient to
+cover the expenses of her voyage: nevertheless her
+owners determined to persevere in the enterprise, and
+refitted the ship for a new voyage of the same kind.</p>
+
+<p>The "Columbia," under her former captain, Gray,
+left Boston, on her second voyage, on the 28th of September,
+1790, and, without the occurrence of any
+thing worthy of note, arrived at Clyoquot, near the
+entrance of Fuca's Strait, on the 5th of June, 1791.
+There, and in the neighboring waters, she remained
+through the summer and winter following, engaged in
+trading and exploring. In the spring of 1792, Gray
+took his departure in the ship, on a cruise southward,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_8" id="Page_8">[Pg 8]</a></span>along the coast, bent on ascertaining the truth of appearances
+which had led him in the former voyage
+to suspect the existence of a river discharging its waters
+at or about the latitude of 46 degrees. During
+his cruise, he met the English vessels commanded by
+Commodore Vancouver. "On the 29th of April,"
+Vancouver writes in his journal, "at four o'clock, a
+sail was discovered to the westward, standing in shore.
+This was a very great novelty, not having seen any
+vessel but our consort during the last eight months.
+She soon hoisted American colors, and fired a gun to
+leeward. At six, we spoke her. She proved to be the
+ship 'Columbia,' commanded by Capt. Robert Gray,
+belonging to Boston, whence she had been absent nineteen
+months. I sent two of my officers on board to
+acquire such information as might be serviceable in
+our future operations. Capt. Gray informed them of
+his having been off the mouth of a river, in the latitude
+of 46 degrees 10 minutes, for nine days; but the
+outset or reflux was so strong as to prevent his entering."</p>
+
+<p>To this statement of Capt. Gray, Vancouver gave
+little credit. He remarks, "I was thoroughly persuaded,
+as were also most persons of observation on
+board, that we could not have passed any safe <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_9" id="Page_9">[Pg 9]</a></span>navigable
+opening, harbor, or place of security for shipping,
+from Cape Mendocino to Fuca's Strait."</p>
+
+<p>After parting with the English ships, Gray sailed
+along the coast of the continent southward; and on
+the 7th of May, 1792, he "saw an entrance which
+had a very good appearance of a harbor." Passing
+through this entrance, he found himself in a bay,
+"well sheltered from the sea by long sand-bars and
+spits," where he remained three days trading with
+the natives, and then resumed his voyage, bestowing
+on the place thus discovered the name of Bulfinch's
+Harbor, in honor of one of the owners of his ship.
+This is now known as Gray's Harbor.</p>
+
+<p>At daybreak on the 11th, after leaving Bulfinch's
+Harbor, Gray observed the entrance of his desired
+port, bearing east-south-east, distant six leagues; and
+running into it with all sails set, between the breakers,
+he anchored at one o'clock in a large river of
+fresh water, ten miles above its mouth. At this spot
+he remained three days, engaged in trading with the
+natives, and filling his casks with water; and then
+sailed up the river about twelve miles along its
+northern shore, where, finding that he could proceed
+no farther from having taken the wrong channel, he
+again came to anchor. On the 20th, he recrossed the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_10" id="Page_10">[Pg 10]</a></span>bar at the mouth of the river, and regained the Pacific.</p>
+
+<p>On leaving the river, Gray gave it the name of his
+ship, the Columbia, which it still bears. He called
+the southern point of land, at the entrance, Cape
+Adams; and the northern, Cape Hancock. The former
+of these names retains its place in the maps, the
+latter does not; the promontory being known as Cape
+Disappointment,&mdash;a name it received from Lieut.
+Meares, an English navigator, who, like Capt. Gray,
+judged from appearances that there was the outlet of
+a river at that point, but failed to find it, and recorded
+his failure in the name he assigned to the conspicuous
+headland which marked the place of his fruitless
+search.</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>NOTE. As the discovery of Columbia River was an event of historical
+importance, the reader will perhaps be gratified to see it as recorded
+in the words of Capt. Gray himself, copied from his logbook
+as follows:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"May 11 (1792), at eight, <span class="smcap">P.M.</span>, the entrance of Bulfinch's
+Harbor bore north, distance four miles. Sent up the main-top-gallant
+yard, and set all sail. At four, <span class="smcap">A.M.</span>, saw the entrance
+of our desired port, bearing east-south-east, distance six leagues;
+in steering sails, and hauled our wind in shore. At eight,
+<span class="smcap">A.M.</span>, being a little to windward of the entrance of the harbor,
+bore away, and ran in east-north-east between the breakers, having
+from five to seven fathoms of water. When we were over
+the bar, we found this to be a large river of fresh water, up which
+we steered. Many canoes came alongside. At one, <span class="smcap">P.M.</span>, came
+to, with the small bower in ten fathoms black and white sand.
+The entrance between the bars bore west-south-west, distant ten
+miles; the north side of the river a half-mile distant from the
+ship, the south side of the same two and a half miles distance;
+a village on the north side of the river, west by north,
+distant three-quarters of a mile. Vast numbers of natives came
+alongside. People employed in pumping the salt water out of
+our water-casks, in order to fill with fresh, while the ship floated
+in. So ends."</p></div>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_11" id="Page_11">[Pg 11]</a></span>From the mouth of Columbia River, Gray sailed to
+Nootka Sound, where he communicated his recent
+discoveries to the Spanish commandant, Quadra; to
+whom he also gave charts and descriptions of Bulfinch's
+Harbor, and of the mouth of the Columbia.
+He departed for Canton in September, and thence
+sailed to the United States.</p>
+
+<p>The voyages of Kendrick and Gray were not profitable
+to the adventurers, yet not fruitless of benefit to
+their country. They opened the way to subsequent
+enterprises in the same region, which were eminently
+successful. And, in another point of view, these expeditions
+were fraught with consequences of the <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_12" id="Page_12">[Pg 12]</a></span>utmost
+importance. Gray's discovery of Columbia River
+was the point most relied upon by our negotiators in
+a subsequent era for establishing the claim of the
+United States to the part of the continent through
+which that river flows; and it is in a great measure
+owing to that discovery that the growing State of
+Oregon is now a part of the American Republic.</p>
+
+<p>From the date of the discovery of Columbia River
+to the war of 1812, the direct trade between the American
+coast and China was almost entirely in the hands
+of the citizens of the United States. The British
+merchants were restrained from pursuing it by the
+opposition of their East-India Company; the Russians
+were not admitted into Chinese ports; and few ships
+of any other nation were seen in that part of the
+ocean. The trade was prosecuted by men whose
+names are still distinguished among us as those of the
+master-spirits of American commerce,&mdash;the Thorndikes,
+the Perkinses, Lambs, Sturgis, Cushing, and
+others of Boston, Astor and others of New York. The
+greater number of the vessels sent from the United
+States were fine ships or brigs laden with valuable
+cargoes of West-India productions, British manufactured
+articles, and French, Italian, and Spanish wines
+and spirits; and the owners were men of large
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_13" id="Page_13">[Pg 13]</a></span>capital and high reputation in the commercial world,
+some of whom were able to compete with the British
+companies, and even to control their movements.</p>
+
+<p>During all this period, though constant accessions
+were made to the knowledge of the coast by means
+of commercial adventure, the interior of the continent,
+from the Mississippi to the ocean, remained unknown.
+The intercourse of the people of the United States
+with the native tribes was restricted by several
+causes. One was the possession of Louisiana by the
+Spaniards; another, the retention by the British of
+several important posts south of the Great Lakes,
+within the acknowledged territory of the Union. At
+length, by the treaty of 1794 between Great Britain
+and the United States, those posts were given up to
+the Americans; and by treaty with France, in 1803,
+Louisiana, which had come into possession of that
+power in 1800, was ceded to the United States.
+From this period, the Government and people of the
+United States ceased to be indifferent to the immense
+and important region whose destinies were committed
+to them; and the ensuing narrative will relate the
+first attempt made by national authority to occupy
+and explore the country.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_14" id="Page_14">[Pg 14]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER II.</h2>
+
+<h3>LEWIS AND CLARKE.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>In the year 1786, John Ledyard of Connecticut,
+who had been with Capt. Cook in his voyage of
+discovery to the north-west coast of America in 1776-1780,
+was in Paris, endeavoring to engage a mercantile
+company in the fur-trade of that coast. He had
+seen, as he thought, unequalled opportunities for lucrative
+traffic in the exchange of the furs of that country
+for the silks and teas of China. But his representations
+were listened to with incredulity by the cautious
+merchants of Europe, and he found it impossible
+to interest any so far as to induce them to fit out an
+expedition for the object proposed.</p>
+
+<p>Disappointed and needy, he applied for advice and
+assistance to Mr. Jefferson, at that time the American
+minister at the court of France. Ledyard had no
+views of pecuniary gain in the contemplated enterprise:
+he sought only an opportunity of indulging his
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_15" id="Page_15">[Pg 15]</a></span>love of adventure by exploring regions at that time
+unknown. Mr. Jefferson, as the guardian of his country's
+interests and the friend of science, was warmly
+interested in any scheme which contemplated the
+opening of the vast interior regions of the American
+continent to the occupancy of civilized man. Since
+it was impossible to engage mercantile adventurers to
+fit out an expedition by sea, Mr. Jefferson proposed to
+Ledyard that he should go as a traveller, by land,
+through the Russian territories, as far as the eastern
+coast of the continent of Asia, and from thence get
+such conveyance as he could to the neighboring coast
+of America, and thus reach the spot where his main
+journey was to begin. Ledyard eagerly embraced
+the proposal. Permission was obtained from the Empress
+Catharine of Russia, and the enterprising traveller,
+in December, 1786, set forth. He traversed Denmark
+and Sweden; passed round the head of the Gulf
+of Bothnia, after an unsuccessful attempt to cross it
+on the ice; and reached St. Petersburg in March,
+1787, without money, shoes, or stockings, having gone
+this immense journey on foot in an arctic winter. At
+St. Petersburg he obtained notice, money to the
+amount of twenty guineas, and permission to accompany
+a convoy of stores to Yakoutsk, in Siberia.
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_16" id="Page_16">[Pg 16]</a></span>But, for some unexplained reason, he was arrested at
+that place by order of the empress, and conveyed
+back to Europe; being cautioned, on his release, not
+again to set foot within the Russian territories, under
+penalty of death. This harsh treatment is supposed
+to have arisen from the jealousy of the Russian fur-traders,
+who feared that Ledyard's proceedings would
+rouse up rivals in their trade.</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Jefferson did not, upon this disappointment,
+abandon the idea of an exploration of the interior of
+the American continent. At his suggestion, the
+American Philosophical Society of Philadelphia took
+measures, in 1792, to send suitable persons to make a
+similar transit of the continent in the opposite direction;
+that is, by ascending the Missouri, and descending
+the Columbia. Nothing was effected, however,
+at that time, except awakening the attention of Capt.
+Meriwether Lewis, a young officer in the American
+army, a neighbor and relative of Gen. Washington.
+He eagerly sought to be employed to make the contemplated
+journey.</p>
+
+<p>In 1803, Mr. Jefferson, being then President of the
+United States, proposed to Congress to send an exploring
+party to trace the Missouri to its source; to
+cross the highlands, and follow the best water <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_17" id="Page_17">[Pg 17]</a></span>communication
+which might offer itself, to the Pacific Ocean.
+Congress approved the proposal, and voted a sum of
+money to carry it into execution. Capt. Lewis, who
+had then been two years with Mr. Jefferson as his private
+secretary, immediately renewed his solicitations
+to have the direction of the expedition. Mr. Jefferson
+had now had opportunity of knowing him intimately,
+and believed him to be brave, persevering, familiar
+with the Indian character and customs, habituated
+to the hunting life, honest, and of sound judgment.
+He trusted that he would be careful of those
+committed to his charge, yet steady in the maintenance
+of discipline. On receiving his appointment,
+Capt. Lewis repaired to Philadelphia, and placed himself
+under its distinguished professors, with a view to
+acquire familiarity with the nomenclature of the natural
+sciences. He selected, as his companion in the
+proposed expedition, William Clarke, a brother-officer,
+known and esteemed by him.</p>
+
+<p>While these things were going on, the treaty with
+France was concluded, by which the country of
+Louisiana was ceded to the United States. This
+event, which took place in 1803, greatly increased the
+interest felt by the people of the United States in the
+proposed expedition.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_18" id="Page_18">[Pg 18]</a></span>In the spring of 1804, the preparations being completed,
+the explorers commenced their route. The
+party consisted of nine young men from Kentucky,
+fourteen soldiers of the United-States army who volunteered
+their services, two French watermen, an
+interpreter, a hunter, and a black servant of Capt.
+Clarke. In addition to these, a further force of fifteen
+men attended on the commencement of the expedition
+to secure safety during the transit through some Indian
+tribes whose hostility was apprehended. The
+necessary stores were divided into seven bales and
+one box, the latter containing a small portion of each
+article in case of a loss of any one of the bales. The
+stores consisted of clothing, working tools, ammunition,
+and other articles of prime necessity. To these
+were added fourteen bales and one box of Indian presents,
+composed of richly laced coats and other articles
+of dress, medals, flags, knives, and tomahawks for
+the chiefs; ornaments of different kinds, particularly
+beads, looking-glasses, handkerchiefs, paints, and generally
+such articles as were deemed best calculated
+for the taste of the Indians. The company embarked
+on board of three boats. The first was a keel-boat,
+fifty-five feet long, carrying one large square sail and
+twenty-two oars. A deck of ten feet, at each end,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_19" id="Page_19">[Pg 19]</a></span>formed a forecastle and cabin. This was accompanied
+by two open boats of six oars. Two horses were to
+be led along the banks of the river, for bringing home
+game, or hunting in case of scarcity.</p>
+
+<p>The narrative of the expedition was written by the
+commanders from day to day, and published after
+their return. We shall tell the story of their adventures
+nearly in the language of their own journal,
+with such abridgments as our plan renders necessary.</p>
+
+<p>May 14, 1804.&mdash;All the preparations being completed,
+they left their encampment this day. The
+character of the river itself was the most interesting
+object of examination for the first part of their voyage.
+Having advanced, in two months, about four
+hundred and fifty miles, they write as follows: "The
+ranges of hills on opposite sides of the river are twelve
+or fifteen miles apart, rich plains and prairies, with
+the river, occupying the intermediate space, partially
+covered near the river with cotton-wood or Balm-of-Gilead
+poplar. The whole lowland between the
+parallel ranges of hills seems to have been formed of
+mud of the river, mixed with sand and clay. The
+sand of the neighboring banks, added to that brought
+down by the stream, forms sand-bars, projecting into
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_20" id="Page_20">[Pg 20]</a></span>the river. These drive the stream to the opposite
+bank, the loose texture of which it undermines, and
+at length deserts its ancient bed for a new passage.
+It is thus that the banks of the Missouri are constantly
+falling in, and the river changing its bed.</p>
+
+<p>"On one occasion, the party encamped on a sand-bar
+in the river. Shortly after midnight, the sleepers
+were startled by the sergeant on guard crying out
+that the sand-bar was sinking: and the alarm was
+timely given; for scarcely had they got off with the
+boats before the bank under which they had been
+lying fell in; and, by the time the opposite shore was
+reached, the ground on which they had been encamped
+sunk also.</p>
+
+<p>"We had occasion here to observe the process of
+the undermining of these hills by the Missouri. The
+first attacks seem to be made on the hills which overhang
+the river. As soon as the violence of the current
+destroys the grass at the foot of them, the whole
+texture appears loosened, and the ground dissolves,
+and mixes with the water. At one point, a part of
+the cliff, nearly three-quarters of a mile in length, and
+about two hundred feet in height, had fallen into the
+river. As the banks are washed away, the trees fall
+in, and the channel becomes filled with buried logs."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_21" id="Page_21">[Pg 21]</a></span>RIVER SCENERY.</p>
+
+<p>"July 12.&mdash;We remained to-day for the purpose of
+making lunar observations. Capt. Clarke sailed a few
+miles up the Namaha River, and landed on a spot
+where he found numerous artificial mounds.</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>NOTE. A late traveller, Rev. Samuel Parker, speaks thus of these
+mounds: "The mounds, which some have called the work of
+unknown generations of men, were scattered here in all varieties
+of form and magnitude, thousands in number. Some of them
+were conical, some elliptical, some square, and some parallelograms.
+One group attracted my attention particularly. They
+were twelve in number, of conical form, with their bases joined,
+and twenty or thirty feet high. They formed two-thirds of a
+circle, with an area of two hundred feet in diameter. If these
+were isolated, who would not say they were artificial? But,
+when they are only a group among a thousand others, who will
+presume to say they all are the work of man?...</p>
+
+<p>"It is said by those who advocate the belief that they are the
+work of ancient nations; that they present plain evidence of this
+in the fact that they contain human bones, articles of pottery,
+and the like. That some of them have been used for burying-places,
+is undoubtedly true; but may it not be questioned whether
+they were <i>made</i>, or only <i>selected</i>, for burying-places? No
+one who has ever seen the thousands and ten thousands
+scattered through the Valley of the Mississippi will be so credulous
+as to believe that a hundredth part of them were the work
+of man."</p></div>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_22" id="Page_22">[Pg 22]</a></span>"From the top of the highest mound, a delightful
+prospect presented itself,&mdash;the lowland of the Missouri
+covered with an undulating grass nearly five
+feet high, gradually rising into a second plain, where
+rich weeds and flowers were interspersed with copses
+of the Osage plum. Farther back from the river
+were seen small groves of trees, an abundance of
+grapes, the wild cherry of the Missouri,&mdash;resembling
+our own, but larger, and growing on a small bush.
+The plums are of three kinds,&mdash;two of a yellow color,
+and distinguished by one of the species being larger
+than the other; a third species of red color. All have
+an excellent flavor, particularly the yellow kind."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">PIPE-CLAY ROCK.</p>
+
+<p>"Aug. 21.&mdash;We passed the mouth of the Great
+Sioux River. Our Indian interpreter tells us that on
+the head waters of this river is the quarry of red
+rock of which the Indians make their pipes; and the
+necessity of procuring that article has introduced a
+law of nations, by which the banks of the stream are
+sacred; and even tribes at war meet without hostility
+at these quarries, which possess a right of asylum.
+Thus we find, even among savages, certain principles
+deemed sacred, by which the rigors of their merciless
+system of warfare are mitigated."</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_23" id="Page_23">[Pg 23]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER III.</h2>
+
+<h3>THE SIOUX.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>The Indian tribes which our adventurers had thus
+far encountered had been friendly, or at least
+inoffensive; but they were feeble bands, and all of
+them lived in terror of their powerful neighbors, the
+Sioux. On the 23d of September, the party reached
+a region inhabited by the Tetons, a tribe of Sioux.
+The journal gives an account of their intercourse
+with these new acquaintances as follows:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"The morning was fine; and we raised a flag-staff,
+and spread an awning, under which we assembled,
+with all the party under arms. The chiefs and warriors
+from the Indian camp, about fifty in number, met
+us; and Capt. Lewis made a speech to them. After
+this, we went through the ceremony of acknowledging
+the chiefs by giving to the grand chief a medal, a flag
+of the United States, a laced uniform coat, a cocked
+hat and feather; to the two other chiefs, a medal and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_24" id="Page_24">[Pg 24]</a></span>some small presents; and to two warriors of consideration,
+certificates. We then invited the chiefs on
+board, and showed them the boat, the air-gun, and
+such curiosities as we thought might amuse them.
+In this we succeeded too well; for after giving them
+a quarter of a glass of whiskey, which they seemed
+to like very much, it was with much difficulty we
+could get rid of them. They at last accompanied
+Capt. Clarke back to shore in a boat with five
+men; but no sooner had the party landed than
+three of the Indians seized the cable of the boat,
+and one of the soldiers of the chief put his arms
+round the mast. The second chief, who affected intoxication,
+then said that we should not go on; that
+they had not received presents enough from us.
+Capt. Clarke told him that we would not be prevented
+from going on; that we were not squaws, but warriors;
+that we were sent by our great Father, who
+could in a moment exterminate them. The chief replied
+that he, too, had warriors; and was proceeding
+to lay hands on Capt. Clarke, who immediately drew
+his sword, and made a signal to the boat to prepare
+for action. The Indians who surrounded him drew
+their arrows from their quivers, and were bending
+their bows, when the swivel in the large boat was
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_25" id="Page_25">[Pg 25]</a></span>pointed towards them, and twelve of our most determined
+men jumped into the small boat, and joined
+Capt. Clarke. This movement made an impression
+on them; for the grand chief ordered the young men
+away from the boat, and the chiefs withdrew, and held
+a short council with the warriors. Being unwilling
+to irritate them, Capt. Clarke then went forward, and
+offered his hand to the first and second chiefs, who
+refused to take it. He then turned from them, and
+got into the boat, but had not gone more than a
+stone's-throw, when the two chiefs and two of the
+warriors waded in after him; and he took them on
+board.</p>
+
+<p>"Sept. 26.&mdash;Our conduct yesterday seemed to
+have inspired the Indians with respect; and, as we
+were desirous of cultivating their acquaintance, we
+complied with their wish that we should give them an
+opportunity of treating us well, and also suffer their
+squaws and children to see us and our boat, which
+would be perfectly new to them. Accordingly, after
+passing a small island and several sand-bars, we came
+to on the south shore, where a crowd of men, women,
+and children, were waiting to receive us. Capt.
+Lewis went on shore, and, observing that their disposition
+seemed friendly, resolved to remain during the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_26" id="Page_26">[Pg 26]</a></span>night to a dance which they were preparing for us.
+The captains, who went on shore one after the other,
+were met on the landing by ten well-dressed young
+men, who took them up in a robe highly decorated,
+and carried them to a large council-house, where they
+were placed on a dressed buffalo-skin by the side of
+the grand chief. The hall, or council-room, was in the
+shape of three-quarters of a circle, covered at the top
+and sides with skins well dressed, and sewed together.
+Under this shelter sat about seventy men, forming
+a circle round the chief, before whom were placed a
+Spanish flag and the one we had given them yesterday.
+In the vacant space in the centre, the pipe of
+peace was raised on two forked sticks about six or
+eight inches from the ground, and under it the down
+of the swan was scattered. A large fire, at which
+they were cooking, stood near, and a pile of about
+four hundred pounds of buffalo-meat, as a present
+for us.</p>
+
+<p>"As soon as we were seated, an old man rose, and,
+after approving what we had done, begged us to take
+pity upon their unfortunate situation. To this we replied
+with assurances of protection. After he had
+ceased, the great chief rose, and delivered an harangue
+to the same effect. Then, with great <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_27" id="Page_27">[Pg 27]</a></span>solemnity,
+he took some of the more delicate parts of the
+dog, which was cooked for the festival, and held it to
+the flag by way of sacrifice: this done, he held up
+the pipe of peace, and first pointed it towards the
+heavens, then to the four quarters of the globe, and
+then to the earth; made a short speech; lighted the
+pipe, and presented it to us. We smoked, and he
+again harangued his people; after which the repast
+was served up to us. It consisted of the dog, which
+they had just been cooking; this being a great dish
+among the Sioux, and used at all festivals. To this
+was added <i>pemitigon</i>, a dish made of buffalo-meat,
+dried, and then pounded, and mixed raw with fat; and
+a root like the potato, dressed like the preparation of
+Indian-corn called hominy. Of all these luxuries,
+which were placed before us in platters, with horn
+spoons, we took the pemitigon and the potato, which
+we found good; but we could as yet partake but sparingly
+of the dog. We ate and smoked for an hour,
+when it became dark. Every thing was then cleared
+away for the dance; a large fire being made in the
+centre of the house, giving at once light and warmth
+to the ball-room. The orchestra was composed of
+about ten men, who played on a sort of tambourine
+formed of skin stretched across a hoop, and made a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_28" id="Page_28">[Pg 28]</a></span>jingling noise with a long stick, to which the hoofs
+of deer and goats were hung. The third instrument
+was a small skin bag, with pebbles in it. These, with
+five or six young men for the vocal part, made up the
+band.</p>
+
+<p>"The women then came forward highly decorated;
+some with poles in their hands, on which were hung
+the scalps of their enemies; others with guns, spears,
+or different trophies, taken in war by their husbands,
+brothers, or connections. Having arranged themselves
+in two columns, as soon as the music began
+they danced towards each other till they met in the
+centre; when the rattles were shaken, and they all
+shouted, and returned back to their places. They
+have no steps, but shuffle along the ground; nor does
+the music appear to be any thing more than a confusion
+of noises, distinguished only by hard or gentle blows
+upon the buffalo-skin. The song is perfectly extemporaneous.
+In the pauses of the dance, any man of
+the company comes forward, and recites, in a low,
+guttural tone, some little story or incident, which is
+either martial or ludicrous. This is taken up by the
+orchestra and the dancers, who repeat it in a higher
+strain, and dance to it. Sometimes they alternate,
+the orchestra first performing; and, when it ceases,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_29" id="Page_29">[Pg 29]</a></span>the women raise their voices, and make a music more
+agreeable, that is, less intolerable, than that of the
+musicians.</p>
+
+<p>"The harmony of the entertainment had nearly
+been disturbed by one of the musicians, who, thinking
+he had not received a due share of the tobacco
+we had distributed during the evening, put himself
+into a passion, broke one of the drums, threw two of
+them into the fire, and left the band. They were
+taken out of the fire: a buffalo-robe, held in one hand,
+and beaten with the other, supplied the place of the
+lost drum or tambourine; and no notice was taken of
+the offensive conduct of the man. We staid till
+twelve o'clock at night, when we informed the chiefs
+that they must be fatigued with all these attempts to
+amuse us, and retired, accompanied by four chiefs,
+two of whom spent the night with us on board."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE SIOUX.</p>
+
+<p>"The tribe which we this day saw are a part of the
+great Sioux nation, and are known by the name of
+the <i>Teton Okandandas</i>: they are about two hundred
+men in number, and their chief residence is on both
+sides of the Missouri, between the Cheyenne and
+Teton Rivers.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_30" id="Page_30">[Pg 30]</a></span>"The men shave the hair off their heads, except a
+small tuft on the top, which they suffer to grow, and
+wear in plaits over the shoulders. To this they seem
+much attached, as the loss of it is the usual sacrifice at
+the death of near relations. In full dress, the men of
+consideration wear a hawk's feather or calumet feather,
+worked with porcupine-quills, and fastened to the
+top of the head, from which it falls back. The face
+and body are generally painted with a mixture of
+grease and coal. Over the shoulders is a loose robe or
+mantle of buffalo-skin, adorned with porcupine-quills,
+which are loosely fixed so as to make a jingling noise
+when in motion, and painted with various uncouth
+figures unintelligible to us, but to them emblematic
+of military exploits or any other incident. The hair
+of the robe is worn next the skin in fair weather;
+but, when it rains, the hair is put outside. Under
+this robe they wear in winter a kind of shirt, made
+either of skin or cloth, covering the arms and body.
+Round the middle is fixed a girdle of cloth or elk-skin,
+about an inch in width, and closely tied to the
+body. To this is attached a piece of cloth or blanket
+or skin about a foot wide, which passes between the
+legs, and is tucked under the girdle both before and
+behind. From the hip to the ankle, the man is covered
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_31" id="Page_31">[Pg 31]</a></span>with leggings of dressed antelope-skins, with seams
+at the sides two inches in width, and ornamented
+by little tufts of hair, the product of the scalps they
+have taken in war, which are scattered down the leg.</p>
+
+<p>"The moccasons are of dressed buffalo-skin, the
+hair being worn inwards. On great occasions, or
+whenever they are in full dress, the young men drag
+after them the entire skin of a polecat, fixed to the
+heel of the moccason.</p>
+
+<p>"The hair of the women is suffered to grow long,
+and is parted from the forehead across the head; at
+the back of which it is either collected into a kind of
+bag, or hangs down over the shoulders. Their moccasons
+are like those of the men, as are also the leggings,
+which do not reach beyond the knee, where
+they are met by a long, loose mantle of skin, which
+reaches nearly to the ankles. This is fastened over
+the shoulders by a string, and has no sleeves; but a
+few pieces of the skin hang a short distance down the
+arm. Sometimes a girdle fastens this skin round the
+waist, and over all is thrown a robe like that worn by
+the men.</p>
+
+<p>"Their lodges are very neatly constructed. They
+consist of about one hundred cabins, made of white
+buffalo-hide, with a larger cabin in the centre for <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_32" id="Page_32">[Pg 32]</a></span>holding
+councils and dances. They are built round with
+poles about fifteen or twenty feet high, covered with
+white skins. These lodges may be taken to pieces,
+packed up, and carried with the nation, wherever
+they go, by dogs, which bear great burdens. The
+women are chiefly employed in dressing buffalo-skins.
+These people seem well-disposed, but are addicted to
+stealing any thing which they can take without being
+observed."</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_33" id="Page_33">[Pg 33]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER IV.</h2>
+
+<h3>SUMMARY OF TRAVEL TO WINTER-QUARTERS.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>Sept. 1, 1804.&mdash;The daily progress of the expedition
+from this date is marked by no incidents of
+more importance than the varying fortunes of travel, as
+they found the river more or less favorable to navigation,
+and the game more or less abundant on the banks.
+Their progress was from twelve to twenty miles
+a day. In general, their sails served them; but they
+were sometimes obliged to resort to the use of tow-lines,
+which, being attached to a tree or other firm
+object on the shore, enabled the men to pull the boat
+along. This seems but a slow method of voyaging;
+yet they found it by no means the slowest, and were
+sorry when the nature of the banks, being either too
+lofty or too low, precluded their use of it. Their narrative
+is, however, varied by accounts of the scenery
+and natural productions of the country through which
+they passed, and by anecdotes of the Indians. While
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_34" id="Page_34">[Pg 34]</a></span>they are making their toilsome advance up the river,
+let us see what they have to tell us of the strange
+people and remarkable objects which they found on
+their way.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">PRAIRIE-DOGS.</p>
+
+<p>"We arrived at a spot on the gradual descent of
+the hill, nearly four acres in extent, and covered with
+small holes. These are the residences of little animals
+called prairie-dogs, who sit erect near the mouth
+of the hole, and make a whistling noise, but, when
+alarmed, take refuge in their holes. In order to bring
+them out, we poured into one of the holes five barrels
+of water, without filling it; but we dislodged and
+caught the owner. After digging down another of
+the holes for six feet, we found, on running a pole into
+it, that we had not yet dug half-way to the bottom.
+We discovered two frogs in the hole; and near it we
+killed a rattlesnake, which had swallowed a small
+prairie-dog. We have been told, though we never
+witnessed the fact, that a sort of lizard and a snake
+live habitually with these animals.</p>
+
+<p>"The prairie-dog is well named, as it resembles a
+dog in most particulars, though it has also some points
+of similarity to the squirrel. The head resembles the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_35" id="Page_35">[Pg 35]</a></span>squirrel in every respect, except that the ear is
+shorter. The tail is like that of the ground-squirrel;
+the toe-nails are long, the fur is fine, and the long
+hair is gray."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">ANTELOPES.</p>
+
+<p>"Of all the animals we have seen, the antelope
+possesses the most wonderful fleetness. Shy and
+timorous, they generally repose only on the ridges,
+which command a view in all directions. Their sight
+distinguishes the most distant danger; their power
+of smell defeats the attempt at concealment; and,
+when alarmed, their swiftness seems more like the
+flight of birds than the movement of an animal over
+the ground. Capt. Lewis, after many unsuccessful
+attempts, succeeded in approaching, undiscovered, a
+party of seven, which were on an eminence. The
+only male of the party frequently encircled the summit
+of the hill, as if to discover if any danger threatened
+the party. When Capt. Lewis was at the distance
+of two hundred yards, they became alarmed,
+and fled. He immediately ran to the spot they had
+left. A ravine concealed them from him; but the
+next moment they appeared on a second ridge, at the
+distance of three miles. He doubted whether they
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_36" id="Page_36">[Pg 36]</a></span>could be the same; but their number, and the direction
+in which they fled, satisfied him that it was the
+same party: yet the distance they had made in the
+time was such as would hardly have been possible to
+the swiftest racehorse."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">PELICAN ISLAND.</p>
+
+<p>"42.&mdash;This name we gave to a long island, from
+the numbers of pelicans which were feeding on it.
+One of them being killed, we poured into his bag five
+gallons of water."</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>NOTE. "The antelopes are becoming very numerous. Their speed
+exceeds that of any animal I have ever seen. Our hounds can
+do nothing in giving them the chase: so soon are they left far in
+the rear, that they do not follow them more than ten or twenty
+rods before they return, looking ashamed of their defeat. Our
+hunters occasionally take the antelope by coming upon them by
+stealth. When they are surprised, they start forward a very
+small space, then turn, and, with high-lifted heads, stare for a
+few seconds at the object which has alarmed them, and then,
+with a half-whistling snuff, bound off, seeming to be as much
+upon wings as upon feet. They resemble the goat, but are far
+more beautiful. Though they are of different colors, yet they
+are generally red, and have a large, fine, prominent eye. Their
+flesh is good for food, and about equals venison."&mdash;<i>Parker's
+Tour.</i></p></div>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_37" id="Page_37">[Pg 37]</a></span>INDIAN VILLAGES AND AGRICULTURE.</p>
+
+<p>"We halted for dinner at a deserted village, which
+we suppose to have belonged to the Ricaras. It is
+situated in a low plain on the river, and consists of
+about eighty lodges, of an octagon form, neatly
+covered with earth, placed as close to each other as
+possible, and picketed round. The skin-canoes, mats,
+buckets, and articles of furniture, found in the lodges,
+induce us to suppose that it was left in the spring.
+We found three different kinds of squashes growing
+in the village.</p>
+
+<p>"Another village, which we reached two days later,
+was situated on an island, which is three miles long,
+and covered with fields, in which the Indians raise
+corn, beans, and potatoes. We found here several
+Frenchmen living among the Indians, as interpreters
+or traders. The Indians gave us some corn, beans,
+and dried squashes; and we gave them a steel mill,
+with which they were much pleased. We sat conversing
+with the chiefs some time, during which they
+treated us to a bread made of corn and beans, also
+corn and beans boiled, and a large rich bean which
+they take from the mice of the prairie, who discover
+and collect it. We gave them some sugar, salt, and a
+sun-glass."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_38" id="Page_38">[Pg 38]</a></span>YORK, THE NEGRO.</p>
+
+<p>"The object which seemed to astonish the Indians
+most was Capt. Clarke's servant, York,&mdash;a sturdy
+negro. They had never seen a human being of that
+color, and therefore flocked round him to examine the
+monster. By way of amusement, he told them that
+he had once been a wild animal, and been caught and
+tamed by his master, and, to convince them, showed
+them feats of strength, which, added to his looks,
+made him more terrible than we wished him to be.
+At all the villages he was an object of astonishment.
+The children would follow him constantly, and, if he
+chanced to turn towards them, would run with great
+terror."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">STONE-IDOL CREEK.</p>
+
+<p>"We reached the mouth of a creek, to which we
+gave the name of Stone-Idol Creek; for, on passing
+up, we discovered, that, a few miles back from the Missouri,
+there are two stones resembling human figures,
+and a third like a dog; all which are objects of great
+veneration among the Ricaras. Their history would
+adorn the "Metamorphoses" of Ovid. A young man
+was in love with a girl whose parents refused their
+consent to the marriage. The youth went out into
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_39" id="Page_39">[Pg 39]</a></span>the fields to mourn his misfortunes: a sympathy of
+feeling led the girl to the same spot; and the faithful
+dog would not fail to follow his master. After wandering
+together, and having nothing but grapes to
+subsist on, they were at last converted into stone,
+which, beginning at the feet, gradually invaded the
+nobler parts, leaving nothing unchanged but a bunch
+of grapes, which the female holds in her hands to this
+day. Such is the account given by the Ricara chief,
+which we had no means of testing, except that we
+found one part of the story very agreeably confirmed;
+for on the banks of the creek we found a greater
+abundance of fine grapes than we had seen elsewhere."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">GOATS.</p>
+
+<p>"Great numbers of goats are crossing the river, and
+directing their course to the westward. We are told
+that they spend the summer in the plains east of the
+Missouri, and at this season (October) are returning
+to the Black Mountains, where they subsist on leaves
+and shrubbery during the winter, and resume their
+migrations in the spring. At one place, we saw
+large flocks of them in the water. They had been
+gradually driven into the river by the Indians, who
+now lined the shore so as to prevent their escape, and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_40" id="Page_40">[Pg 40]</a></span>were firing on them; while boys went into the river,
+and killed them with sticks. They seemed to have
+been very successful; for we counted fifty-eight which
+they had killed. In the evening they made a feast,
+that lasted till late at night, and caused much noise
+and merriment.</p>
+
+<p>"The country through which we passed has wider
+river-bottoms and more timber than those we have
+been accustomed to see; the hills rising at a distance,
+and by gradual ascents. We have seen great numbers
+of elk, deer, goats, and buffaloes, and the usual
+attendants of these last,&mdash;the wolves, which follow
+their movements, and feed upon those who die by accident,
+or are too feeble to keep pace with the herd.
+We also wounded a white bear, and saw some fresh
+tracks of those animals, which are twice as large as
+the tracks of a man."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE PRAIRIE ON FIRE.</p>
+
+<p>"In the evening, the prairie took fire, either by accident
+or design, and burned with great fury; the
+whole plain being enveloped in flames. So rapid was
+its progress, that a man and a woman were burned to
+death before they could reach a place of safety. Another
+man, with his wife and child, were much
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_41" id="Page_41">[Pg 41]</a></span>burned, and several other persons narrowly escaped
+destruction. Among the rest, a boy of the half-breed
+escaped unhurt in the midst of the flames. His
+safety was ascribed by the Indians to the Great
+Spirit, who had saved him on account of his being
+white. But a much more natural cause was the presence
+of mind of his mother, who, seeing no hopes of
+carrying off her son, threw him on the ground, and,
+covering him with the fresh hide of a buffalo, escaped
+herself from the flames. As soon as the fire had
+passed, she returned, and found him untouched; the
+skin having prevented the flame from reaching the
+grass where he lay."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">A COUNCIL.</p>
+
+<p>"After making eleven miles, we reached an old field,
+where the Mandans had cultivated grain last summer.
+We encamped for the night about half a mile below
+the first village of the Mandans. As soon as we arrived,
+a crowd of men, women, and children, came
+down to see us. Capt. Lewis returned with the principal
+chiefs to the village, while the others remained
+with us during the evening. The object which
+seemed to surprise them most was a corn-mill, fixed
+to the boat, which we had occasion to use; while they
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_42" id="Page_42">[Pg 42]</a></span>looked on, and were delighted at observing the ease
+with which it reduced the grain to powder.</p>
+
+<p>"Among others who visited us was the son of the
+grand chief of the Mandans, who had both his little
+fingers cut off at the second joint. On inquiring into
+this injury, we found that the custom was to express
+grief for the death of relations by some corporeal suffering,
+and that the usual mode was to lose a joint of
+the little finger, or sometimes of other fingers.</p>
+
+<p>"Oct. 29, 1804.&mdash;The morning was fine, and we
+prepared our presents and speech for the council. At
+ten o'clock, the chiefs were all assembled under an
+awning of our sails. That the impression might be
+the more forcible, the men were all paraded; and the
+council opened by a discharge from the swivel of the
+boat. Capt. Lewis then delivered a speech, which,
+like those we had already made, intermingled advice
+with assurances of friendship and trade. While he
+was speaking, the Ahnahaway chief grew very restless,
+and observed that he could not wait long, as his camp
+was exposed to the hostilities of the Shoshonees. He
+was instantly rebuked with great dignity, by one of
+the chiefs, for this violation of decorum at such a moment,
+and remained quiet during the rest of the council.
+This being over, we proceeded to distribute the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_43" id="Page_43">[Pg 43]</a></span>presents with great ceremony. One chief of each
+town was acknowledged by the gift of a flag, a medal
+with the likeness of the President of the United
+States, a uniform coat, hat, and feather. To the second
+chiefs we gave a medal representing some domestic
+animals, and a loom for weaving; to the third chiefs,
+medals with the impression of a farmer sowing grain.
+A variety of other products were distributed; but
+none seemed to give more satisfaction than an iron
+corn-mill which we gave them.</p>
+
+<p>"In the evening, our men danced among themselves
+to the music of the violin, to the great amusement
+of the Indians."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THEY ENCAMP FOR THE WINTER.</p>
+
+<p>"Friday, Nov. 7, 1804.&mdash;Capt. Clarke having examined
+the shores, and found a position where there
+was plenty of timber, we encamped, and began to fell
+trees to build our huts. The timber which we employ
+is cotton-wood (poplar) and elm, with some ash
+of inferior size. By the 8th, our huts were advanced
+very well; on the 13th, we unloaded the boat,
+and stowed away the contents in a storehouse which
+we had built.</p>
+
+<p>"Nov. 20.&mdash;This day we moved into our huts,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_44" id="Page_44">[Pg 44]</a></span>which are now completed. We call our place Fort
+Mandan. It is situated on a point of low ground
+on the north side of the Missouri, covered with
+tall and heavy cotton-wood. The works consist of
+two rows of huts or sheds, forming an angle where
+they join each other; each row containing four rooms
+of fourteen feet square and seven feet high, with
+plank ceiling, and the roof slanting so as to form a loft
+above the rooms, the highest part of which is eighteen
+feet from the ground. The backs of the huts
+formed a wall of that height; and, opposite the angle,
+the place of the wall was supplied by picketing. In
+the area were two rooms for stores and provisions.
+The latitude, by observation, is 47&deg; 22&acute;, long. 101&deg;;
+and the computed distance from the mouth of the
+Missouri, sixteen hundred miles.</p>
+
+<p>"Nov. 21.&mdash;We are now settled in our winter
+habitation, and shall wait with much impatience the
+first return of spring to continue our journey."</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_45" id="Page_45">[Pg 45]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER V.</h2>
+
+<h3>INDIAN TRIBES.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>"The villages near which we are established are
+the residence of three distinct nations,&mdash;the
+Mandans, the Ahnahaways, and the Minnetarees.
+The Mandans say, that, many years ago,
+their tribe was settled in nine villages, the ruins of
+which we passed about eighty miles below. Finding
+themselves wasting away before the small-pox and
+the Sioux, they moved up the river, and planted
+themselves opposite the Ricaras. Their numbers are
+very much reduced, and they now constitute but two
+villages,&mdash;one on each side of the river, and at a distance
+of three miles from each other. Both villages
+together may raise about three hundred and fifty
+men."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">AHNAHAWAYS.</p>
+
+<p>"Four miles from the lower Mandan village is one
+inhabited by the Ahnahaways. This nation formerly
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_46" id="Page_46">[Pg 46]</a></span>dwelt on the Missouri, about thirty miles below where
+they now live. The Assinaboins and Sioux forced
+them to a spot five miles higher, and thence, by a second
+emigration, to their present situation, in order
+to obtain an asylum near the Minnetarees. Their
+whole force is about fifty men."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">MINNETAREES.</p>
+
+<p>"About half a mile from this village, and in the
+same open plain with it, is a village of Minnetarees,
+who are about one hundred and fifty men in number.
+One and a half miles above this village is a second of
+the same tribe, who may be considered the proper Minnetaree
+nation. It is situated in a beautiful plain, and
+contains four hundred and fifty warriors. The Mandans
+say that this people came out of the water to the
+east, and settled near them. The Minnetarees, however,
+assert that they grew where they now live, and
+will never emigrate from the spot; the Great Spirit
+having declared, that, if they move, they will all
+perish.</p>
+
+<p>"The inhabitants of these villages, all of which are
+within the compass of six miles, live in harmony with
+each other. Their languages differ to some extent;
+but their long residence together has enabled them to
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_47" id="Page_47">[Pg 47]</a></span>understand one another's speech as to objects of daily
+occurrence, and obvious to the senses.</p>
+
+<p>"All these tribes are at deadly feud with the
+Sioux, who are much more powerful, and are consequently
+objects of continual apprehension. The presence
+of our force kept the peace for the present.</p>
+
+<p>"Almost the whole of that vast tract of country
+comprised between the Mississippi, the Red River of
+Lake Winnipeg, the Saskatchawan, and the Missouri,
+is loosely occupied by a great nation whose primitive
+name is Dahcotas, but who are called Sioux by the
+French, Sues by the English. They are divided into
+numerous tribes, named Yanktons, Tetons, Assinaboins,
+&amp;c. These tribes are sometimes at war with
+one another, but still acknowledge relationship, and
+are recognized by similarity of language and by tradition."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">RELIGION.</p>
+
+<p>"The religion of the Mandans consists in the belief
+of one Great Spirit presiding over their destinies.
+This Being must be in the nature of a good genius,
+since it is associated with the healing art; and the
+Great Spirit is synonymous with Great Medicine,&mdash;a
+name also applied to every thing they do not comprehend.
+They also believe in a multiplicity of inferior
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_48" id="Page_48">[Pg 48]</a></span>spirits. Each individual selects for himself the particular
+object of his devotion, which is termed his Medicine,
+and is either an invisible being, or more commonly
+some animal, which thenceforward becomes
+his protector, or his intercessor with the Great Spirit.
+To propitiate the Medicine, every attention is lavished,
+and every personal consideration is sacrificed.
+'I was lately owner of seventeen horses,' said a
+Mandan; 'but I have offered them all up to my Medicine,
+and am now poor.' He had in reality taken
+them into the plain, and, turning them loose, committed
+them to the care of his Medicine, and abandoned
+them.</p>
+
+<p>"Their belief in a future state is connected with a
+tradition of their origin. The whole nation, they say,
+once dwelt in one large village underground. A
+grape-vine extended its roots down to their habitation;
+and the earth, being broken round its stem, gave
+them a view of the light. Some of the more adventurous
+climbed up the vine, and were delighted with
+the sight of the earth, which they found covered
+with buffaloes, and rich with every kind of fruit. Returning
+with the grapes they had gathered, their
+countrymen were so pleased with the taste, that the
+whole nation resolved to leave their dull residence
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_49" id="Page_49">[Pg 49]</a></span>for the upper region. Men, women, and children
+ascended by means of the vine; but, when about half
+the nation had reached the surface, a corpulent woman,
+who was clambering up the vine, broke it with
+her weight, and, falling, closed up the cavity. Those
+who had reached the surface, thus excluded from
+their original seats, cherish the hopes of returning
+there when they die."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">INDIAN MANNERS.</p>
+
+<p>The following extract imparts some traits of Indian
+manners:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"Nov. 22.&mdash;This morning, the sentinel informed
+us that an Indian was about to kill his wife near
+the fort. We went to the house of our interpreter,
+where we found the parties, and, after forbidding
+any violence, inquired into the cause of his intending
+to commit such an atrocity. It appeared
+that, some days ago, a quarrel had taken place between
+him and his wife, in consequence of which she
+had taken refuge in the house where the wives of our
+interpreter lived. By running away, she forfeited
+her life, which might be lawfully taken by the husband.
+He was now come for the purpose of completing
+his revenge. We gave him a few presents, and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_50" id="Page_50">[Pg 50]</a></span>tried to persuade him to take his wife home. The
+grand chief, too, happened to arrive at the same moment,
+and reproached him with his violence; till
+at length husband and wife went off together, but
+by no means in a state of much apparent connubial
+felicity."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE WEATHER.</p>
+
+<p>"Dec. 12, 1804.&mdash;The thermometer at sunrise was
+thirty-eight degrees below zero; on the 16th, twenty-two
+below; on the 17th, forty-five below. On the
+19th, it moderated a little. Notwithstanding the cold,
+we observed the Indians at the village engaged, out
+in the open air, at a game which resembles billiards.
+The platform, which answered for a table, was formed
+with timber, smoothed and joined so as to be as level
+as the floor of one of our houses. Instead of balls,
+they had circular disks made of clay-stone, and flat
+like checkers."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE ARGALI.</p>
+
+<p>"Dec. 22.&mdash;A number of squaws brought corn to
+trade for small articles with the men. Among other
+things, we procured two horns of the animal called by
+the hunters the Rocky-Mountain sheep, and by naturalists
+the argali. The animal is about the size of a
+small elk or large deer; the horns winding like those
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_51" id="Page_51">[Pg 51]</a></span>of a ram, which they resemble also in texture, though
+larger and thicker.</p>
+
+<p>"Dec. 23.&mdash;The weather was fine and warm. We
+were visited by crowds of Indians of all description,
+who came either to trade, or from mere curiosity.
+Among the rest, Kagohami, the Little Raven,
+brought his wife and son, loaded with corn; and she
+entertained us with a favorite Mandan dish,&mdash;a mixture
+of pumpkins, beans, corn, and choke-cherries, all
+boiled together in a kettle, and forming a composition
+by no means unpalatable.</p>
+
+<p>"Dec. 25.&mdash;Christmas Day. We were awakened
+before day by a discharge of fire-arms from the party.
+We had told the Indians not to visit us, as it was one
+of our great Medicine-days; so that the men remained
+at home, and amused themselves in various ways, particularly
+with dancing, in which they take great pleasure.
+The American flag was hoisted for the first
+time in the fort; the best provisions we had were
+brought out; and this, with a little brandy, enabled
+them to pass the day in great festivity."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE BLACKSMITH.</p>
+
+<p>"Dec. 27.&mdash;We were fortunate enough to have
+among our men a good blacksmith, whom we set to
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_52" id="Page_52">[Pg 52]</a></span>work to make a variety of articles. His operations
+seemed to surprise the Indians who came to see
+us; but nothing could equal their astonishment at the
+bellows, which they considered a <i>very great Medicine</i>."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE DYING CHIEF.</p>
+
+<p>"Kagohami came to see us early. His village was
+afflicted by the death of one of their aged chiefs, who,
+from his account, must have been more than a hundred
+years old. Just as he was dying, he requested
+his grand-children to dress him in his best robe, and
+carry him up to a hill, and seat him on a stone, with
+his face down the river, towards their old village,
+that he might go straight to his brother, who had
+passed before him to the ancient village underground."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE MEDICINE-STONE.</p>
+
+<p>"Oheenaw and Shahaka came down to see us, and
+mentioned that several of their countrymen had gone
+to consult their <i>Medicine-stone</i> as to the prospects of
+the following year. This Medicine-stone is the great
+oracle of the Mandans, and whatever it announces is
+believed with implicit confidence. Every spring,
+and on some occasions during the summer, a deputation
+visits the sacred spot, where there is a thick,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_53" id="Page_53">[Pg 53]</a></span>porous stone twenty feet in circumference, with a
+smooth surface. Having reached the place, the ceremony
+of smoking to it is performed by the deputies,
+who alternately take a whiff themselves, and then
+present the pipe to the stone. After this, they retire
+to an adjoining wood for the night, during which it
+may be safely presumed all the embassy do not sleep;
+and, in the morning, they read the destinies of the nation
+in the white marks on the stone, which those
+who made them are at no loss to decipher. The
+Minnetarees have a stone of a similar kind, which has
+the same qualities, and the same influence over the
+nation."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE INDIANS' ENDURANCE OF COLD.</p>
+
+<p>"Jan. 10, 1805.&mdash;The weather now exhibited the
+intensity of cold. This morning, at sunrise, the
+mercury stood at forty degrees below zero. One
+of the men, separated from the rest in hunting,
+was out all night. In the morning he returned, and
+told us that he had made a fire, and kept himself tolerably
+warm. A young Indian, about thirteen years of
+age, came in soon after. He had been overtaken by
+the night, and had slept in the snow, with no covering
+but a pair of deer-skin moccasons and leggings, and a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_54" id="Page_54">[Pg 54]</a></span>buffalo-robe. His feet were frozen; but we restored
+them by putting them in cold water, rendering him
+every attention in our power. Another Indian, who
+had been missing, returned about the same time. Although
+his dress was very thin, and he had slept in
+the snow, without a fire, he had not suffered any inconvenience.
+These Indians support the rigors of
+the season in a way which we had hitherto thought
+impossible."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">SUPPLIES OF FOOD.</p>
+
+<p>"Our supplies are chiefly procured by hunting; but
+occasional additions are made by the Indians, sometimes
+in the way of gifts, and sometimes in exchange
+for the services of the blacksmith, who is a most important
+member of the party.</p>
+
+<p>"Feb. 18.&mdash;Our stock of meat is exhausted, so
+that we must confine ourselves to vegetable diet till
+the return of our hunters. For this, however, we are
+at no loss, since yesterday and to-day our blacksmith
+got large quantities of corn from the Indians
+who came to the fort.</p>
+
+<p>"Sunday, March 3.&mdash;The men are all employed in
+preparing the boats. We are visited by a party of
+Indians with corn. A flock of ducks passed up the
+river to-day.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_55" id="Page_55">[Pg 55]</a></span>"Wednesday, 13.&mdash;We had a fine day, and a south-west
+wind. Many Indians came to see us, who are
+so anxious for battle-axes, that our smiths have not a
+moment's leisure, and procure us an abundance of
+corn."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">HUNTING BUFFALOES ON THE ICE.</p>
+
+<p>"March 25, 1805.&mdash;A fine day, the wind south-west.
+The river rose nine inches, and the ice began breaking
+away. Our canoes are now nearly ready, and we
+expect to set out as soon as the river is sufficiently
+clear of ice to permit us to pass.</p>
+
+<p>"March 29.&mdash;The ice came down this morning in
+great quantities. We have had few Indians at the
+fort for the last three or four days, as they are now
+busy in catching the floating buffaloes. Every
+spring, as the river is breaking up, the surrounding
+plains are set on fire, and the buffaloes tempted to
+cross the river in search of the fresh grass which immediately
+succeeds to the burning. On their way,
+they are often insulated on a large cake or mass of
+ice which floats down the river. The Indians now
+select the most favorable points for attack, and, as the
+buffalo approaches, run with astonishing agility across
+the trembling ice, sometimes pressing lightly a cake
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_56" id="Page_56">[Pg 56]</a></span>of not more than two feet square. The animal is, of
+course, unsteady, and his footsteps insecure, on this
+new element, so that he can make but little resistance;
+and the hunter who has given him his death-wound
+paddles his icy boat to the shore, and secures
+his prey."</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_57" id="Page_57">[Pg 57]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER VI.</h2>
+
+<h3>THE MARCH RESUMED.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>From the 1st of November, 1804, to the 1st of
+April, 1805, the expedition remained stationary
+at their fort. Some of their number had been sent
+back to the States with despatches to the Government,
+and with specimens of the natural productions
+of the country. On resuming their march on the
+4th of April, the party consisted of thirty-two persons.
+Besides the commanders, there were three sergeants,&mdash;Ordway,
+Prior, and Gass; twenty-three privates,
+besides Capt. Clark's black servant York; two
+interpreters,&mdash;George Drewyer and Toussaint Chaboneau.
+The wife of Chaboneau, an Indian woman,
+with her young child, accompanied her husband. All
+this party, with the luggage, was stored in six small
+canoes and two pirogues. They left the fort with
+fair weather, and, after making four miles, encamped
+on the north side of the river, nearly opposite the
+first Mandan village. We continue their journal.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_58" id="Page_58">[Pg 58]</a></span>THE RIVER-SHORE.</p>
+
+<p>"April 8.&mdash;The river-banks exhibit indications of
+volcanic agency. The bluffs which we passed to-day
+are upwards of one hundred feet high, composed of
+yellow clay and sand, with horizontal strata of carbonated
+wood resembling pit-coal, from one to five
+feet in thickness, scattered through the bluff at different
+elevations. Great quantities of pumice-stone and
+lava are seen in many parts of the hills, where they
+are broken and washed into gullies by the rain. We
+passed a bluff which is on fire, and throws out quantities
+of smoke, which has a strong, sulphurous smell.
+On the sides of the hills is a white substance, which
+appears in considerable quantities on the surface, and
+tastes like a mixture of common salt with Glauber
+salts. Many of the springs which come from the foot
+of the hills are so impregnated with this substance,
+that the water has an unpleasant taste, and a purgative
+effect."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE PRAIRIE-MICE.</p>
+
+<p>"April, 1805.&mdash;We saw, but could not procure, an
+animal that burrows in the ground, similar to the
+burrowing-squirrel, except that it is only one-third of
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_59" id="Page_59">[Pg 59]</a></span>its size. This may be the animal whose works we
+have often seen in the plains and prairies. They consist
+of a little hillock of ten or twelve pounds of loose
+earth, which would seem to have been reversed from
+a flower-pot; and no aperture is seen in the ground
+from which it could have been brought. On removing
+gently the earth, you discover that the soil has
+been broken in a circle of about an inch and a half in
+diameter, where the ground is looser, though still no
+opening is perceptible. When we stopped for dinner,
+the Indian woman went out, and, penetrating with a
+sharp stick the holes of the mice, brought a quantity
+of wild artichokes, which the mice collect, and hoard
+in large quantities. The root is white, of an ovate
+form, from one to three inches long, and generally of
+the size of a man's finger; and two, four, and sometimes
+six roots are attached to a single stalk. Its flavor,
+as well as the stalk that issues from it, resemble
+those of the Jerusalem artichoke, except that the latter
+is much larger."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE YELLOW-STONE RIVER.</p>
+
+<p>"Certain signs, known to the hunters, induced them
+to believe that we were at no great distance from the
+Yellow-stone River. In order to prevent delay, Capt.
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_60" id="Page_60">[Pg 60]</a></span>Lewis determined to go on by land in search of that
+river, and make the necessary observations, so as to
+enable us to proceed immediately after the boats
+should join him.</p>
+
+<p>"On leaving the party, he pursued his route along
+the foot of the hills; ascending which, the wide plains
+watered by the Missouri and the Yellow-stone spread
+themselves before his eye, occasionally varied with
+the wood of the banks, enlivened by the windings of
+the two rivers, and animated by vast herds of buffaloes,
+deer, elk, and antelope."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">NATURAL HISTORY.</p>
+
+<p>"May, 1805.&mdash;We reached the mouth of a river
+flowing from the north, which, from the unusual number
+of porcupines near it, we called Porcupine River.
+These animals are so careless and clumsy, that we can
+approach very near without disturbing them as they
+are feeding on the young willows. The porcupine is
+common in all parts of the territory, and for its quills
+is held in high estimation by the Indians. It is interesting
+to see with how much ingenuity, and in how
+many various forms, the Indians manufacture these
+quills into ornamental work, such as moccasons, belts,
+and various other articles."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_61" id="Page_61">[Pg 61]</a></span>WOLVES.</p>
+
+<p>"The wolves are very numerous, and of two species.
+First, the small wolf, or burrowing dog of the
+prairies, which is found in almost all the open plains.
+It is of an intermediate size, between the fox and dog,
+very delicately formed, fleet and active. The ears
+are large, erect, and pointed; the head long and
+pointed, like that of a fox; the tail long and bushy;
+the hair and fur of a pale reddish-brown, and much
+coarser than that of the fox. These animals usually
+associate in bands of ten or twelve, and are rarely, if
+ever, seen alone; not being able singly to attack a
+deer or antelope. They live, and rear their young, in
+burrows, which they fix near some pass much frequented
+by game, and sally out in a body against any
+animal which they think they can overpower, but, on
+the slightest alarm, retreat to their burrows, making
+a noise exactly like that of a small dog.</p>
+
+<p>"The second species is lower, shorter in the legs,
+and thicker, than the Atlantic wolf. They do not
+burrow, nor do they bark, but howl; and they frequent
+the woods and plains, and skulk along the
+herds of buffaloes, in order to attack the weary or
+wounded."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_62" id="Page_62">[Pg 62]</a></span>ELK.</p>
+
+<p>"Among the animals of the deer kind, the elk is the
+largest and most majestic. It combines beauty with
+magnitude and strength; and its large, towering
+horns give it an imposing appearance. Its senses
+are so keen in apprehension, that it is difficult to
+be approached; and its speed in flight is so great,
+that it mocks the chase. Its flesh resembles beef,
+but is less highly flavored, and is much sought for by
+the Indians and hunters. Its skin is esteemed, and
+much used in articles of clothing and for moccasons."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">BEAVERS.</p>
+
+<p>"We saw many beavers to-day. The beaver seems
+to contribute very much to the widening of the river
+and the formation of islands. They begin by damming
+up the channels of about twenty yards width
+between the islands. This obliges the river to seek
+another outlet; and, as soon as this is effected, the
+channel stopped by the beaver becomes filled with
+mud and sand. The industrious animal is thus driven
+to another channel, which soon shares the same fate;
+till the river spreads on all sides, and cuts the projecting
+points of land into islands.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_63" id="Page_63">[Pg 63]</a></span>"The beaver dams differ in shape, according to
+the nature of the place in which they are built. If the
+water in the river or creek have but little motion, the
+dam is almost straight; but, when the current is more
+rapid, it is always made with a considerable curve,
+convex toward the stream. The materials made use
+of are drift-wood, green willows, birch, and poplars,
+if they can be got; also mud and stones, intermixed
+in such a manner as must evidently contribute to the
+strength of the dam. In places which have been long
+frequented by beavers undisturbed, their dams, by
+frequent repairing, become a solid bank, capable of
+resisting a great force both of water and ice; and as
+the willow, poplar, and birch generally take root, and
+shoot up, they, by degrees, form a kind of regular
+planted hedge, in some places so tall that birds
+build their nests among the branches. The beaver-houses
+are constructed of the same materials as their
+dams, and are always proportioned in size to the number
+of inhabitants, which seldom exceeds four old
+and six or eight young ones. The houses are of a
+much ruder construction than their dams: for, notwithstanding
+the sagacity of these animals, it has
+never been observed that they aim at any other convenience
+in their house than to have a dry place to lie
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_64" id="Page_64">[Pg 64]</a></span>on; and there they usually eat their victuals, such as
+they take out of the water. Their food consists of
+roots of plants, like the pond-lily, which grows at the
+bottom of the lakes and rivers. They also eat the
+bark of trees, particularly those of the poplar, birch,
+and willow.</p>
+
+<p>"The instinct of the beavers leading them to live in
+associations, they are in an unnatural position, when,
+in any locality, their numbers are so much reduced as
+to prevent their following this instinct. The beaver
+near the settlement is sad and solitary: his works
+have been swept away, his association broken up,
+and he is reduced to the necessity of burrowing in
+the river-bank, instead of building a house for himself.
+Such beavers are called 'terriers.' One traveller
+says that these solitaries are also called 'old bachelors.'"</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE WHITE, BROWN, OR GRISLY BEAR.</p>
+
+<p>"April 29.&mdash;All these names are given to the same
+species, which probably changes in color with the season,
+or with the time of life. Of the strength and
+ferocity of this animal, the Indians give dreadful accounts.
+They never attack him but in parties of six
+or eight persons, and, even then, are often defeated
+with the loss of some of the party.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_65" id="Page_65">[Pg 65]</a></span>"May 18.&mdash;One of our men who had been suffered
+to go ashore came running to the boats with cries
+and every symptom of terror. As soon as he could
+command his breath, he told us, that, about a mile
+below, he had shot a white bear, which immediately
+turned and ran towards him, but, being wounded,
+had not been able to overtake him. Capt. Lewis, with
+seven men, went in search of the bear, and, having
+found his track, followed him by the blood for a
+mile, came up with him, and shot him with two balls
+through the skull. He was a monstrous animal, and
+a most formidable enemy. Our man had shot him
+through the centre of the lungs: yet the bear
+had pursued him furiously for half a mile; then returned
+more than twice that distance, and, with his
+talons, dug himself a bed in the earth, two feet deep
+and five feet long, and was perfectly alive when they
+found him, which was at least two hours after he received
+the wound. The fleece and skin of the bear
+were a heavy burden for two men; and the oil
+amounted to eight gallons.</p>
+
+<p>"The wonderful power of life of these animals, added
+to their great strength, renders them very formidable.
+Their very track in the mud or sand, which
+we have sometimes found eleven inches long and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_66" id="Page_66">[Pg 66]</a></span>seven and a quarter wide, exclusive of the talons, is
+alarming; and we had rather encounter two Indians
+than a single brown bear. There is no chance of
+killing them by a single shot, unless the ball is sent
+through the brain; and this is very difficult to be
+done, on account of two large muscles which cover
+the side of the forehead, and the sharp projection
+of the frontal bone, which is very thick."</p>
+
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>NOTE. Their strength is astonishingly great. Lieut. Stein of the
+dragoons, a man of undoubted veracity, told me he saw some
+buffaloes passing near some bushes where a grisly bear lay concealed:
+the bear, with one stroke, tore three ribs from a buffalo,
+and left it dead.&mdash;<i>Parker</i>.</p>
+
+<p>Although endowed with such strength, and powers of destruction,
+the grisly bear is not disposed to begin the attack. Mr.
+Drummond, a later traveller, states, that, in his excursions over
+the Rocky Mountains, he had frequent opportunity of observing
+the manners of these animals; and it often happened, that
+in turning the point of a rock, or sharp angle of a valley, he
+came suddenly upon one or more of them. On such occasions
+they reared on their hind-legs, and made a loud noise like a
+person breathing quick, but much harsher. He kept his
+ground, without attempting to molest them; and they on their
+part, after attentively regarding him for some time, generally
+wheeled round, and galloped off: though, from their known disposition,
+there is little doubt but he would have been torn in
+pieces, had he lost his presence of mind and attempted to fly.
+When he discovered them at a distance, he often frightened
+them away by beating on a large tin box in which he carried
+his specimens of plants.</p></div>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_67" id="Page_67">[Pg 67]</a></span>THE BLACK BEAR.</p>
+
+<p>"The black bear, common in the United States, is
+scarcely more than half the size of the grisly bear.
+Its favorite food is berries of various kinds; but,
+when these are not to be procured, it lives upon
+roots, insects, fish, eggs, and such birds and quadrupeds
+as it can surprise. It passes the winter in a
+torpid state, selecting a spot for its den under a fallen
+tree, and, having scratched away a portion of the soil,
+retires to the place at the commencement of a snow storm,
+when the snow soon furnishes it with a close,
+warm covering. Its breath makes a small opening in
+the den, and the quantity of hoar-frost which gathers
+round the hole serves to betray its retreat to the
+hunter. In more southern districts, where the timber
+is of larger size, bears often shelter themselves in hollow
+trees."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">BUFFALOES.</p>
+
+<p>"The buffalo is about as large as our domestic cattle;
+and their long, shaggy, woolly hair, which covers
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_68" id="Page_68">[Pg 68]</a></span>their head, neck, and shoulders, gives them a formidable
+appearance, and, at a distance, something like
+that of the lion. In many respects, they resemble
+our horned cattle; are cloven-footed, chew the cud,
+and select the same kind of food. Their flesh is in
+appearance and taste much like beef, but of superior
+flavor. Their heads are formed like the ox, perhaps
+a little more round and broad; and, when they run,
+they carry them rather low. Their horns, ears,
+and eyes, as seen through their shaggy hair, appear
+small, and, cleared from their covering, are not large.
+Their legs and feet are small and trim; the fore-legs
+covered with the long hair of the shoulders, as low
+down as the knee. Though their figure is clumsy in
+appearance, they run swiftly, and for a long time
+without much slackening their speed; and, up steep
+hills or mountains, they more than equal the best
+horses. They unite in herds, and, when feeding,
+scatter over a large space; but, when fleeing from
+danger, they collect into dense columns: and, having
+once laid their course, they are not easily diverted
+from it, whatever may oppose. So far are they from
+being a fierce or revengeful animal, that they are very
+shy and timid; and in no case did we see them offer
+to make an attack but in self-defence, and then they
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_69" id="Page_69">[Pg 69]</a></span>always sought the first opportunity to escape. When
+they run, they lean alternately from side to side. They
+are fond of rolling upon the ground like horses, which
+is not practised by our domestic cattle. This is so
+much their diversion, that large places are found
+without grass, and considerably excavated by them."</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>NOTE. Rev. Mr. Parker thus describes a buffalo-hunt:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"To-day we unexpectedly saw before us a large herd of buffaloes.
+All halted to make preparation for the chase. The
+young men, and all the good hunters, prepared themselves, selected
+the swiftest horses, examined the few guns they had, and
+also took a supply of arrows with their bows. They advanced
+towards the herd of buffaloes with great caution, lest they
+should frighten them before they should make a near approach,
+and also to reserve the power of their horses for the chase, when
+it should be necessary to bring it into full requisition. When
+the buffaloes took the alarm, and fled, the rush was made, each
+Indian selecting for himself the one to which he happened to
+come nearest. All were in swift motion, scouring the valley.
+A cloud of dust began to rise; firing of guns, and shooting of
+arrows, followed in close succession. Soon, here and there, buffaloes
+were seen prostrated; and the women, who followed close
+in the rear, began the work of securing the acquisition, and the
+men were away again in pursuit of the flying herd. Those in
+the chase, when as near as two rods, shoot and wheel, expecting
+the wounded animal to turn upon them. The horses seemed to
+understand the way to avoid danger. As soon as the wounded
+animal flies again, the chase is renewed; and such is the alternate
+wheeling and chasing, until the buffalo sinks beneath his
+wounds."</p></div>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_70" id="Page_70">[Pg 70]</a></span>INDIAN METHOD OF HUNTING THE BUFFALO.</p>
+
+<p>"May 30, 1805.&mdash;We passed a precipice about
+one hundred and twenty feet high, under which lay
+scattered the fragments of at least a hundred carcasses
+of buffaloes. These buffaloes had been chased
+down the precipice in a way very common on the
+Missouri, and by which vast herds are destroyed in
+a moment. The mode of hunting is to select one of
+the most active and fleet young men, who is disguised
+by a buffalo-skin round his body; the skin of
+the head, with the ears and horns, fastened on his
+own head in such a way as to deceive the buffaloes.
+Thus dressed, he fixes himself at a convenient distance
+between a herd of buffaloes and any of the
+river precipices, which sometimes extend for some
+miles. His companions, in the mean time, get in the
+rear and side of the herd, and, at a given signal, show
+themselves, and advance towards the buffaloes. They
+instantly take the alarm; and, finding the hunters
+beside them, they run toward the disguised Indian,
+or decoy, who leads them on, at full speed, toward
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_71" id="Page_71">[Pg 71]</a></span>the river; when, suddenly securing himself in some
+crevice of the cliff which he had previously fixed on,
+the herd is left on the brink of the precipice. It is
+then in vain for the foremost to retreat, or even to
+stop. They are pressed on by the hindmost rank,
+who, seeing no danger but from the hunters, goad on
+those before them, till the whole are precipitated
+over the cliff, and the shore is covered with their
+dead bodies. Sometimes, in this perilous adventure,
+the Indian decoy is either trodden under foot, or,
+missing his footing in the cliff, is urged down the
+precipice by the falling herd."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">WHICH IS THE TRUE RIVER?</p>
+
+<p>"June 3, 1805.&mdash;We came to for the night, for the
+purpose of examining in the morning a large river
+which enters opposite to us. It now became an interesting
+question, which of those two streams is what
+the Indians call Ahmateahza, or the Missouri, which,
+they tell us, has its head waters very near to the Columbia.
+On our right decision much of the fate of
+the expedition depends; since, if, after ascending to
+the Rocky Mountains or beyond them, we should
+find that the river we have been tracing does not
+come near the Columbia, and be obliged to turn back,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_72" id="Page_72">[Pg 72]</a></span>we shall have lost the travelling season, and seriously
+disheartened our men. We determined, therefore, to
+examine well before deciding on our course, and, for
+this purpose, despatched two canoes with three men
+up each of the streams, with orders to ascertain the
+width, depth, and rapidity of the currents, so as to
+judge of their comparative bodies of water. Parties
+were also sent out by land to penetrate the country,
+and discover from the rising grounds, if possible, the
+distant bearings of the two rivers. While they were
+gone, the two commanders ascended together the
+high grounds in the fork of the two rivers, whence
+they had an extensive prospect of the surrounding
+country. On every side, it was spread into one vast
+plain covered with verdure, in which innumerable
+herds of buffaloes were roaming, attended by their
+enemies the wolves. Some flocks of elk also were
+seen; and the solitary antelopes were scattered, with
+their young, over the plain. The direction of the
+rivers could not be long distinguished, as they were
+soon lost in the extent of the plain.</p>
+
+<p>"On our return, we continued our examination.
+The width of the north branch is two hundred yards;
+that of the south is three hundred and seventy-two.
+The north, though narrower, is deeper than the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_73" id="Page_73">[Pg 73]</a></span>south: its waters also are of the same whitish-brown
+color, thickness, and turbidness as the Missouri.
+They run in the same boiling and roaring manner
+which has uniformly characterized the Missouri;
+and its bed is composed of some gravel, but principally
+mud. The south fork is broader, and its waters
+are perfectly transparent. The current is rapid, but
+the surface smooth and unruffled; and its bed is composed
+of round and flat smooth stones, like those of
+rivers issuing from a mountainous country.</p>
+
+<p>"In the evening, the exploring parties returned,
+after ascending the rivers in canoes for some distance,
+then continuing on foot, just leaving themselves time
+to return by night. Their accounts were far from
+deciding the important question of our future route;
+and we therefore determined each of us to ascend
+one of the rivers during a day and a half's march, or
+farther, if necessary for our satisfaction.</p>
+
+<p>"Tuesday, June 4, 1805.&mdash;This morning, Capt.
+Lewis and Capt. Clarke set out, each with a small
+party, by land, to explore the two rivers. Capt. Lewis
+traced the course of the north fork for fifty-nine miles,
+and found, that, for all that distance, its direction was
+northward; and, as the latitude we were now in was
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_74" id="Page_74">[Pg 74]</a></span>47&deg; 24&acute;, it was highly improbable, that, by going farther
+north, we should find between this and the Saskatchawan
+any stream which can, as the Indians assure
+us the Missouri does, possess a navigable current
+for some distance within the Rocky Mountains.</p>
+
+<p>"These considerations, with others drawn from the
+observations of Capt. Clarke upon the south branch,
+satisfied the chiefs that the South River was the true
+Missouri; but the men generally were of a contrary
+opinion, and much of their belief depended upon Crusatte,
+an experienced waterman on the Missouri, who
+gave it as his opinion that the north fork was the
+main river. In order that nothing might be omitted
+which could prevent our falling into error, it was
+agreed that one of us should ascend the southern
+branch by land until he reached either the falls or
+the mountains. In the mean time, in order to lighten
+our burdens as much as possible, we determined to
+deposit here all the heavy baggage which we could
+possibly spare, as well as some provisions, salt, powder,
+and tools. The weather being fair, we dried all
+our baggage and merchandise, and made our deposit,
+or cache. Our cache is made in this manner: In the
+high plain on the side of the river, we choose a dry
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_75" id="Page_75">[Pg 75]</a></span>situation, and, drawing a small circle of about twenty
+inches diameter, remove the sod as carefully as possible.
+The hole is then sunk perpendicularly a foot
+deep, or more if the ground be not firm. It is now
+worked gradually wider as it deepens, till at length it
+becomes six or seven feet deep, shaped nearly like a
+kettle, or the lower part of a large still, with the bottom
+somewhat sunk at the centre. As the earth is
+dug, it is carefully laid on a skin or cloth, in which it
+is carried away, and thrown into the river, so as to
+leave no trace of it. A floor to the cache is then
+made of dry sticks, on which is thrown hay, or a hide
+perfectly dry. The goods, being well aired and dried,
+are laid on this floor, and prevented from touching the
+sides by other dried sticks, as the baggage is stowed
+away. When the hole is nearly full, a skin is laid
+over the goods; and, on this, earth is thrown, and
+beaten down, until, with the addition of the sod, the
+whole is on a level with the ground, and there remains
+no appearance of an excavation. Careful measurements
+are taken to secure the ready recovery of the
+cache on the return; and the deposit is left in perfect
+confidence of finding every thing safe and sound after
+the lapse of months, or even years."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_76" id="Page_76">[Pg 76]</a></span>THE FALLS OF THE MISSOURI.</p>
+
+<p>"June 12.&mdash;This morning, Capt. Lewis set out
+with four men on an exploration, to ascend the southern
+branch, agreeably to our plan. He left the bank
+of the river in order to avoid the deep ravines,
+which generally extend from the shore to a distance
+of two or three miles in the plain. On the second
+day, having travelled about sixty miles from the point
+of departure, on a sudden their ears were saluted
+with the agreeable sound of falling water; and, as
+they advanced, a spray which seemed driven by the
+wind rose above the plain like a column of smoke,
+and vanished in an instant. Towards this point, Capt.
+Lewis directed his steps; and the noise, increasing as
+he approached, soon became too powerful to be ascribed
+to any thing but the Great Falls of the Missouri.
+Having travelled seven miles after first hearing
+the sound, he reached the falls. The hills, as he
+approached the river, were difficult of transit, and two
+hundred feet high. Down these he hurried, and, seating
+himself on a rock, enjoyed the spectacle of this
+stupendous object, which, ever since the creation,
+had been lavishing its magnificence upon the desert,
+unseen by civilized man.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_77" id="Page_77">[Pg 77]</a></span>"The river, immediately at its cascade, is three
+hundred yards wide, and is pressed in by a perpendicular
+cliff, which rises to about one hundred feet,
+and extends up the stream for a mile. On the other
+side, the bluff is also perpendicular for three hundred
+yards above the falls. For ninety or a hundred
+yards from the left cliff, the water falls in one smooth,
+even sheet, over a precipice eighty feet in height.
+The remaining part of the river rushes with an accelerated
+current, but, being received as it falls by
+irregular rocks below, forms a brilliant spectacle of
+perfectly white foam, two hundred yards in length,
+and eighty in height. The spray is dissipated into a
+thousand shapes, on all of which the sun impresses
+the brightest colors of the rainbow. The principal
+cascade is succeeded by others of less grandeur, but
+of exceeding beauty and great variety, for about
+twenty miles in extent."<a name="FNanchor_1_1" id="FNanchor_1_1"></a><a href="#Footnote_1_1" class="fnanchor">[1]</a></p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">A PORTAGE.</p>
+
+<p>"June 21.&mdash;Having reached the falls, we found
+ourselves obliged to get past them by transporting
+our boats overland by what is called a <i>portage</i>. The
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_78" id="Page_78">[Pg 78]</a></span>distance was eighteen miles. It was necessary to
+construct a truck or carriage to transport the boats;
+and the making of the wheels and the necessary
+framework took ten days. The axle-trees, made of
+an old mast, broke repeatedly, and the cottonwood
+tongues gave way; so that the men were forced to
+carry as much baggage as they could on their backs.
+The prickly pear annoyed them much by sticking
+through their moccasons. It required several trips to
+transport all the canoes and baggage; and, though the
+men put double soles to their moccasons, the prickly
+pear, and the sharp points of earth formed by the
+trampling of the buffaloes during the late rains,
+wounded their feet; and, as the men were laden as
+heavily as their strength would permit, the crossing
+was very painful. They were obliged to halt and
+rest frequently; and, at almost every stopping-place,
+they would throw themselves down, and fall asleep in
+an instant. Yet no one complained, and they went
+on with cheerfulness.</p>
+
+<p>"Having decided to leave here one of the pirogues,
+we set to work to fit up a boat of skins, upon a frame
+of iron which had been prepared at the armory at
+Harper's Ferry. It was thirty-six feet long, four feet
+and a half wide at top, and twenty-six inches wide
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_79" id="Page_79">[Pg 79]</a></span>at bottom. It was with difficulty we found the necessary
+timber to complete it, even tolerably straight
+sticks, four and a half feet long. The sides were
+formed of willow-bark, and, over this, elk and buffalo
+skins."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">A NARROW ESCAPE.</p>
+
+<p>"June 29.&mdash;Capt. Clarke, having lost some notes
+and remarks which he had made on first ascending
+the river, determined to go up along its banks in
+order to supply the deficiency. He had reached the
+falls, accompanied by his negro-servant York, and by
+Chaboneau, the half-breed Indian interpreter, and
+his wife with her young child. On his arrival there, he
+observed a dark cloud in the west, which threatened
+rain; and looked around for some shelter. About a
+quarter of a mile above the falls he found a deep ravine,
+where there were some shelving rocks, under
+which they took refuge. They were perfectly sheltered
+from the rain, and therefore laid down their
+guns, compass, and other articles which they carried
+with them. The shower was at first moderate; it
+then increased to a heavy rain, the effects of which
+they did not feel. Soon after, a torrent of rain and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_80" id="Page_80">[Pg 80]</a></span>hail descended. The rain seemed to fall in a solid
+mass, and, instantly collecting in the ravine, came
+rolling down in a dreadful torrent, carrying the mud
+and rocks, and every thing that opposed it. Capt.
+Clarke fortunately saw it a moment before it reached
+them, and springing up, with his gun in his left hand,
+with his right he clambered up the steep bluff, pushing
+on the Indian woman with her child in her arms.
+Her husband, too, had seized her hand, and was pulling
+her up the hill, but was so terrified at the danger,
+that, but for Capt. Clarke, he would have been lost,
+with his wife and child. So instantaneous was the
+rise of the water, that, before Capt. Clarke had secured
+his gun and begun to ascend the bank, the
+water was up to his waist; and he could scarce get
+up faster than it rose, till it reached the height of fifteen
+feet, with a furious current, which, had they
+waited a moment longer, would have swept them into
+the river, just above the falls, down which they must
+inevitably have been carried. As it was, Capt. Clarke
+lost his compass, Chaboneau his gun, shot-pouch, and
+tomahawk; and the Indian woman had just time to
+grasp her child before the net in which it lay was
+carried down the current."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_81" id="Page_81">[Pg 81]</a></span>PROGRESS RESUMED.</p>
+
+<p>"July 4.&mdash;The boat was now completed, except
+what was in fact the most difficult part,&mdash;the making
+her seams secure. Having been unsuccessful in all
+our attempts to procure tar, we have formed a composition
+of pounded charcoal with beeswax and buffalo-tallow
+to supply its place. If this resource fail
+us, it will be very unfortunate, as, in every other respect,
+the boat answers our purpose completely. Although
+not quite dry, she can be carried with ease by
+five men: she is very strong, and will carry a load of
+eight thousand pounds, with her complement of men.</p>
+
+<p>"July 9.&mdash;The boat having now become sufficiently
+dry, we gave it a coat of the composition, then a
+second, and launched it into the water. She swam
+perfectly well. The seats were then fixed, and the
+oars fitted. But after a few hours' exposure to the
+wind, which blew with violence, we discovered that
+nearly all the composition had separated from the skins,
+so that she leaked very much. To repair this misfortune
+without pitch was impossible; and, as none of
+that article was to be procured, we were obliged to
+abandon her, after having had so much labor in the
+construction.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_82" id="Page_82">[Pg 82]</a></span>"It now becomes necessary to provide other means
+for transporting the baggage which we had intended
+to stow in her. For this purpose, we shall want two
+canoes; but for many miles we have not seen a single
+tree fit to be used for that purpose. The hunters,
+however, report that there is a low ground about
+eight miles above us by land, and more than twice
+that distance by water, in which we may probably
+find trees large enough. Capt. Clarke has therefore
+determined to set out by land for that place, with ten
+of the best workmen, who will be occupied in building
+the canoes, till the rest of the party, after taking
+the boat to pieces and making the necessary deposits,
+shall transport the baggage, and join them with the
+other six canoes.</p>
+
+<p>"Capt. Clarke accordingly proceeded on eight
+miles by land; the distance by water being twenty-three
+miles. Here he found two cottonwood-trees,
+and proceeded to convert them into boats. The rest
+of the party took the iron boat to pieces, and deposited
+it in a <i>cache</i>, or hole, with some other articles of
+less importance.</p>
+
+<p>"July 11.&mdash;Sergeant Ordway, with four canoes
+and eight men, set sail in the morning to the place
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_83" id="Page_83">[Pg 83]</a></span>where Capt. Clarke had fixed his camp. The canoes
+were unloaded and sent back, and the remainder of
+the baggage in a second trip was despatched to the
+upper camp.</p>
+
+<p>"July 15.&mdash;We rose early, embarked all our baggage
+on board the canoes, which, though eight in
+number, were heavily laden, and at ten o'clock set out
+on our journey.</p>
+
+<p>"July 16.&mdash;We had now arrived at the point
+where the Missouri emerges from the Rocky Mountains.
+The current of the river becomes stronger as
+we advance, and the spurs of the mountain approach
+towards the river, which is deep, and not more than
+seventy yards wide. The low grounds are now but
+a few yards in width; yet they furnish room for an
+Indian road, which winds under the hills on the north
+side of the river. The general range of these hills
+is from south-east to north-west; and the cliffs themselves
+are about eight hundred feet above the water,
+formed almost entirely of a hard black rock, on which
+are scattered a few dwarf pine and cedar trees.</p>
+
+<p>"As the canoes were heavily laden, all the men not
+employed in working them walked on shore. The
+navigation is now very laborious. The river is deep,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_84" id="Page_84">[Pg 84]</a></span>but with little current; the low grounds are very narrow;
+the cliffs are steep, and hang over the river so
+much, that, in places, we could not pass them, but
+were obliged to cross and recross from one side of
+the river to the other in order to make our way."</p>
+
+<h4>FOOTNOTE:</h4>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p class="noin"><a name="Footnote_1_1" id="Footnote_1_1"></a><a href="#FNanchor_1_1"><span class="label">[1]</span></a> Dimensions of Niagara Falls,&mdash;American, 960 feet wide, 162 feet
+high; English, 700 feet wide, 150 feet high.</p></div>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_85" id="Page_85">[Pg 85]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER VII.</h2>
+
+<h3>JOURNEY CONTINUED.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>July 4.&mdash;Since our arrival at the falls, we
+have repeatedly heard a strange noise coming
+from the mountains, in a direction a little to the north
+of west. It is heard at different periods of the day
+and night, sometimes when the air is perfectly still
+and without a cloud; and consists of one stroke only,
+or of five or six discharges in quick succession. It
+is loud, and resembles precisely the sound of a six-pound
+piece of ordnance, at the distance of three
+miles. The Minnetarees frequently mentioned this
+noise, like thunder, which they said the mountains
+made; but we had paid no attention to them, believing
+it to be some superstition, or else a falsehood.
+The watermen also of the party say that the Pawnees
+and Ricaras give the same account of a noise heard
+in the Black Mountains, to the westward of them.
+The solution of the mystery, given by the philosophy
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_86" id="Page_86">[Pg 86]</a></span>of the watermen, is, that it is occasioned by the
+bursting of the rich mines of silver confined within
+the bosom of the mountain.<a name="FNanchor_2_2" id="FNanchor_2_2"></a><a href="#Footnote_2_2" class="fnanchor">[2]</a></p>
+
+<p>"An elk and a beaver are all that were killed to-day:
+the buffaloes seem to have withdrawn from our neighborhood.
+We contrived, however, to spread a comfortable
+table in honor of the day; and in the evening
+gave the men a drink of spirits, which was the last of
+our stock."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">VEGETATION.</p>
+
+<p>"July 15.&mdash;We find the prickly-pear&mdash;one of the
+greatest beauties, as well as one of the greatest
+inconveniences, of the plains&mdash;now in full bloom.
+The sunflower too, a plant common to every part of
+the Missouri, is here very abundant, and in bloom.
+The Indians of the Missouri, and more especially those
+who do not cultivate maize, make great use of this
+plant for bread, and in thickening their soup. They
+first parch, and then pound it between two stones
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_87" id="Page_87">[Pg 87]</a></span>until it is reduced to a fine meal. Sometimes they
+add a portion of water, and drink it thus diluted; at
+other times they add a sufficient proportion of marmow-fat
+to reduce it to the consistency of common
+dough, and eat it in that manner. This last composition
+we preferred to the rest, and thought it at that
+time very palatable.</p>
+
+<p>"There are also great quantities of red, purple, yellow,
+and black currants. The currants are very
+pleasant to the taste, and much preferable to those
+of our gardens. The fruit is not so acid, and has a
+more agreeable flavor."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE BIG-HORNED OR MOUNTAIN RAM.</p>
+
+<p>"July 18.&mdash;This morning we saw a large herd of
+the big-horned animals, who were bounding among
+the rocks in the opposite cliff with great agility.
+These inaccessible spots secure them from all their
+enemies; and the only danger they encounter is in
+wandering among these precipices, where we should
+suppose it scarcely possible for any animal to stand.
+A single false step would precipitate them at least
+five hundred feet into the river.</p>
+
+<p>"The game continues abundant. We killed to-day
+the largest male elk we have yet seen. On placing
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_88" id="Page_88">[Pg 88]</a></span>it in its natural, erect position, we found that it
+measured five feet three inches from the point of
+the hoof to the top of the shoulder.</p>
+
+<p>"The antelopes are yet lean. This fleet and quick-sighted
+animal is generally the victim of its curiosity.
+When they first see the hunters, they run with great
+velocity. If the hunter lies down on the ground, and
+lifts up his arm, his hat, or his foot, the antelope
+returns on a light trot to look at the object, and
+sometimes goes and returns two or three times, till
+at last he approaches within reach of the rifle. So,
+too, they sometimes leave their flock to go and look
+at the wolves, who crouch down, and, if the antelope
+be frightened at first, repeat the same man&oelig;uvre,
+and sometimes relieve each other, till they decoy the
+antelope from his party near enough to seize it."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE GATES OF THE ROCKY MOUNTAINS.</p>
+
+<p>"July 20.&mdash;During the day, in the confined valley
+through which we are passing, the heat is almost
+insupportable; yet, whenever we obtain a glimpse of
+the lofty tops of the mountains, we are tantalized
+with a view of the snow. A mile and a half farther
+on, the rocks approach the river on both sides, forming
+a most sublime and extraordinary spectacle. For
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_89" id="Page_89">[Pg 89]</a></span>six miles, these rocks rise perpendicularly from the
+water's edge to the height of nearly twelve hundred
+feet. They are composed of a black granite near the
+base; but judging from its lighter color above, and
+from fragments that have fallen from it, we suppose
+the upper part to be flint, of a yellowish-brown and
+cream color. Nothing can be imagined more tremendous
+than the frowning darkness of these rocks,
+which project over the river, and menace us with
+destruction. The river, one hundred and fifty yards
+in width, seems to have forced its channel down this
+solid mass: but so reluctantly has it given way, that,
+during the whole distance, the water is very deep
+even at the edges; and, for the first three miles, there
+is not a spot, except one of a few yards in extent, on
+which a man could stand between the water and the
+towering perpendicular of the mountain. The convulsion
+of the passage must have been terrible;
+since, at its outlet, there are vast columns of rock
+torn from the mountain, which are strewed on both
+sides of the river, the trophies, as it were, of victory.
+We were obliged to go on some time after dark, not
+being able to find a spot large enough to encamp on.
+This extraordinary range of rocks we called the Gates
+of the Rocky Mountains."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_90" id="Page_90">[Pg 90]</a></span>NATURAL PRODUCTIONS.</p>
+
+<p>"July 29.&mdash;This morning the hunters brought in
+some fat deer of the long-tailed red kind, which are
+the only kind we have found at this place. There
+are numbers of the sandhill-cranes feeding in the
+meadows. We caught a young one, which, though it
+had nearly attained its full growth, could not fly. It
+is very fierce, and strikes a severe blow with its beak.
+The kingfisher has become quite common this side
+of the falls; but we have seen none of the summer
+duck since leaving that place. Small birds are also
+abundant in the plains. Here, too, are great quantities
+of grasshoppers, or crickets; and, among other
+animals, large ants, with a reddish-brown body and
+legs, and a black head, which build little cones of
+gravel ten or twelve inches high, without a mixture
+of sticks, and with but little earth. In the river we
+see a great abundance of fish, but cannot tempt them
+to bite by any thing on our hooks."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE FORKS OF THE MISSOURI.</p>
+
+<p>"July 28, 1805.&mdash;From the height of a limestone
+cliff, Capt. Lewis observed the three forks of the
+Missouri, of which this river is one. The middle and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_91" id="Page_91">[Pg 91]</a></span>south-west forks unite at half a mile above the entrance
+of the south-east fork. The country watered
+by these rivers, as far as the eye could command, was
+a beautiful combination of meadow and elevated plain,
+covered with a rich grass, and possessing more timber
+than is usual on the Missouri. A range of high
+mountains, partially covered with snow, is seen at a
+considerable distance, running from south to west.</p>
+
+<p>"To the south-east fork the name of Gallatin was
+assigned, in honor of the Secretary of the Treasury.
+On examining the other two streams, it was difficult
+to decide which was the larger or real Missouri:
+they are each ninety yards wide, and similar in character
+and appearance. We were therefore induced
+to discontinue the name of Missouri, and to give to
+the south-west branch the name of Jefferson, in honor
+of the President of the United States and the projector
+of the enterprise; and called the middle branch
+Madison, after James Madison, Secretary of State.</p>
+
+<p>"July 30.&mdash;We reloaded our canoes, and began to
+ascend Jefferson River. The river soon became very
+crooked; the current, too, is rapid, impeded with
+shoals, which consist of coarse gravel. The islands
+are numerous. On the 7th of August, we had, with
+much fatigue, ascended the river sixty miles, when
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_92" id="Page_92">[Pg 92]</a></span>we reached the junction of a stream from the north-west,
+which we named Wisdom River. We continued,
+however, to ascend the south-east branch,
+which we were satisfied was the true continuation
+of the Jefferson."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE SHOSHONEES, OR SNAKE INDIANS.</p>
+
+<p>"July 28.&mdash;We are now very anxious to see the
+Snake Indians. After advancing for several hundred
+miles into this wild and mountainous country, we
+may soon expect that the game will abandon us.
+With no information of the route, we may be unable
+to find a passage across the mountains when we
+reach the head of the river, at least such an one as
+will lead us to the Columbia. And, even were we
+so fortunate as to find a branch of that river, the
+timber which we have hitherto seen in these mountains
+does not promise us any wood fit to make
+canoes; so that our chief dependence is on meeting
+some tribe from whom we may procure horses.</p>
+
+<p>"Sacajawea, our Indian woman, informs us that we
+are encamped on the precise spot where her countrymen,
+the Snake Indians, had their huts five years
+ago, when the Minnetarees came upon them, killed
+most of the party, and carried her away prisoner.
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_93" id="Page_93">[Pg 93]</a></span>She does not, however, show any distress at these
+recollections, nor any joy at the prospect of being
+restored to her country; for she seems to possess
+the folly, or the philosophy, of not suffering her
+feelings to extend beyond the anxiety of having
+plenty to eat, and trinkets to wear.</p>
+
+<p>"Aug. 9.&mdash;Persuaded of the absolute necessity of
+procuring horses to cross the mountains, it was determined
+that one of us should proceed in the morning
+to the head of the river, and penetrate the
+mountains till he found the Shoshonees, or some
+other nation, who could assist us in transporting our
+baggage. Immediately after breakfast, Capt. Lewis
+took Drewyer, Shields, and McNeal; and, slinging
+their knapsacks, they set out, with a resolution to
+meet some nation of Indians before they returned,
+however long it might be.</p>
+
+<p>"Aug. 11.&mdash;It was not till the third day after commencing
+their search that they met with any success.
+Capt. Lewis perceived with the greatest delight, at
+the distance of two miles, a man on horseback coming
+towards them. On examining him with the glass,
+Capt. Lewis saw that he was of a different nation
+from any we had hitherto met. He was armed with
+a bow and a quiver of arrows, and mounted on an
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_94" id="Page_94">[Pg 94]</a></span>elegant horse without a saddle; while a small string,
+attached to the under-jaw, answered as a bridle.
+Convinced that he was a Shoshonee, and knowing
+how much our success depended upon the friendly
+offices of that nation, Capt. Lewis was anxious to
+approach without alarming him. He therefore advanced
+towards the Indian at his usual pace. When
+they were within a mile of each other, the Indian
+suddenly stopped. Capt. Lewis immediately followed
+his example; took his blanket from his knapsack, and,
+holding it with both hands at the two corners, threw
+it above his head, and unfolded it as he brought it to
+the ground, as if in the act of spreading it. This
+signal, which originates in the practice of spreading
+a robe or a skin as a seat for guests to whom they
+wish to show kindness, is the universal sign of friendship
+among the Indians. As usual, Capt. Lewis repeated
+this signal three times. Still the Indian kept
+his position, and looked with an air of suspicion on
+Drewyer and Shields, who were now advancing on
+each side. Capt. Lewis was afraid to make any signal
+for them to halt, lest he should increase the
+suspicions of the Indian, who began to be uneasy;
+and they were too distant to hear his voice. He
+therefore took from his pack some beads, a <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_95" id="Page_95">[Pg 95]</a></span>looking-glass,
+and a few trinkets, which he had brought for
+the purpose; and, leaving his gun, advanced unarmed
+towards the Indian, who remained in the same position
+till Capt. Lewis came within two hundred yards
+of him, when he turned his horse, and began to move
+off slowly. Capt. Lewis then called out to him, as
+loud as he could, 'Tabba bone,'&mdash;which, in the Shoshonee
+language, means <i>White man</i>; but, looking
+over his shoulder, the Indian kept his eyes on Drewyer
+and Shields, who were still advancing, till Capt.
+Lewis made a signal to them to halt. This, Drewyer
+obeyed; but Shields did not observe it, and still
+went forward. The Indian, seeing Drewyer halt,
+turned his horse about, as if to wait for Capt. Lewis,
+who had now reached within one hundred and fifty
+paces, repeating the words, 'Tabba bone,' and holding
+up the trinkets in his hand; at the same time stripping
+up his sleeve to show that he was white. The
+Indian suffered him to advance within one hundred
+paces, then suddenly turned his horse, and, giving
+him the whip, leaped across the creek, and disappeared
+in an instant among the willows. They followed
+his track four miles, but could not get sight of
+him again, nor find any encampment to which he
+belonged.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_96" id="Page_96">[Pg 96]</a></span>"Meanwhile the party in the canoes advanced
+slowly up the river till they came to a large island,
+to which they gave the name of Three-thousand-mile
+Island, on account of its being at that distance
+from the mouth of the Missouri."</p>
+
+<h4>FOOTNOTE:</h4>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p class="noin"><a name="Footnote_2_2" id="Footnote_2_2"></a><a href="#FNanchor_2_2"><span class="label">[2]</span></a> There are many stories, from other sources, confirmatory of these
+noises in mountainous districts. One solution, suggested by Humboldt,&mdash;who
+does not, however, record the fact as of his own observation,&mdash;is,
+that "this curious phenomenon announces a disengagement of hydrogen,
+produced by a bed of coal in a state of combustion." This solution
+is applicable only to mountains which contain coal, unless chemical
+changes in other minerals might be supposed capable of producing a
+similar effect.</p></div>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_97" id="Page_97">[Pg 97]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER VIII.</h2>
+
+<h3>THE SOURCES OF THE MISSOURI AND COLUMBIA.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>Aug. 12, 1805.&mdash;Capt. Lewis decided to advance
+along the foot of the mountains, hoping to find
+a road leading across them. At the distance of four
+miles from his camp, he found a large, plain, Indian
+road, which entered the valley from the north-east.
+Following this road towards the south-west, the valley,
+for the first five miles, continued in the same
+direction; then the main stream turned abruptly to
+the west, through a narrow bottom between the
+mountains. We traced the stream, which gradually
+became smaller, till, two miles farther up, it had so
+diminished, that one of the men, in a fit of enthusiasm,
+with one foot on each side of the rivulet, thanked
+God that he had lived to bestride the Missouri. Four
+miles from thence, we came to the spot where, from
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_98" id="Page_98">[Pg 98]</a></span>the foot of a mountain, issues the remotest water
+of the mighty river.</p>
+
+<p>"We had now traced the Missouri to its source,
+which had never before been seen by civilized man;
+and as we quenched our thirst at the pure and icy
+fountain, and stretched ourselves by the brink of the
+little rivulet which yielded its distant and modest
+tribute to the parent ocean, we felt rewarded for
+all our labors.</p>
+
+<p>"We left reluctantly this interesting spot, and,
+pursuing the Indian road, arrived at the top of a
+ridge, from whence we saw high mountains, partially
+covered with snow, still to the west of us. The ridge
+on which we stood formed, apparently, the dividing-line
+between the waters of the Pacific and Atlantic
+Oceans. We followed a descent much steeper than
+that on the eastern side, and, at the distance of
+three-quarters of a mile, reached a handsome, bold
+creek of cold, clear water, running to the westward.
+We stopped for a moment, to taste, for the first time,
+the waters of the Columbia; and then followed the
+road across hills and valleys, till we found a spring,
+and a sufficient quantity of dry willow-brush for fuel;
+and there halted for the night."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_99" id="Page_99">[Pg 99]</a></span>THEY MEET WITH INDIANS.</p>
+
+<p>"Aug. 13.&mdash;Very early in the morning, Capt.
+Lewis resumed the Indian road, which led him in a
+western direction, through an open, broken country.
+At five miles' distance, he reached a creek about ten
+yards wide, and, on rising the hill beyond it, had a
+view of a handsome little valley about a mile in
+width, through which they judged, from the appearance
+of the timber, that a stream probably flowed.
+On a sudden, they discovered two women, a man, and
+some dogs, on an eminence about a mile before them.
+The strangers viewed them apparently with much
+attention; and then two of them sat down, as if to
+await Capt. Lewis's arrival. He went on till he had
+reached within about half a mile; then ordered his
+party to stop, put down his knapsack and rifle, and,
+unfurling the flag, advanced alone towards the Indians.</p>
+
+<p>"The women soon retreated behind the hill; but
+the man remained till Capt. Lewis came within a
+hundred yards of him, when he, too, went off, though
+Capt. Lewis called out 'Tabba bone' ('White man'),
+loud enough to be heard distinctly. The dogs, however,
+were less shy, and came close to him. He
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_100" id="Page_100">[Pg 100]</a></span>therefore thought of tying a handkerchief with some
+beads round their necks, and then to let them loose,
+to convince the fugitives of his friendly intentions;
+but the dogs would not suffer him to take hold of
+them, and soon left him.</p>
+
+<p>"He now made a signal to the men, who joined him;
+and then all followed the track of the Indians, which
+led along a continuation of the same road they had
+been travelling. It was dusty, and seemed to have
+been much used lately both by foot-passengers and
+horsemen.</p>
+
+<p>"They had not gone along it more than a mile,
+when, on a sudden, they saw three female Indians,
+from whom they had been concealed by the deep
+ravines which intersected the road, till they were
+now within thirty paces of them. One of them, a
+young woman, immediately took to flight: the other
+two, an old woman and little girl, seeing we were
+too near for them to escape, sat on the ground, and,
+holding down their heads, seemed as if reconciled to
+the death which they supposed awaited them. Capt.
+Lewis instantly put down his rifle, and, advancing
+towards them, took the woman by the hand, raised
+her up, and repeated the words, 'Tabba bone,' at
+the same time stripping up his sleeve to show that
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_101" id="Page_101">[Pg 101]</a></span>he was a white man; for his hands and face had
+become by exposure quite as dark as their own.</p>
+
+<p>"She appeared immediately relieved from her
+alarm; and, Drewyer and Shields now coming up,
+Capt. Lewis gave her some beads, a few awls, pewter
+mirrors, and a little paint, and told Drewyer to request
+the woman to recall her companion, who had
+escaped to some distance, and, by alarming the Indians,
+might cause them to attack him, without any
+time for explanation. She did as she was desired,
+and the young woman returned readily. Capt. Lewis
+gave her an equal portion of trinkets, and painted
+the tawny cheeks of all three of them with vermilion,
+which, besides its ornamental effect, has the
+advantage of being held among the Indians as emblematic
+of peace.</p>
+
+<p>"After they had become composed, he informed
+them by signs of his wish to go to their camp in
+order to see their chiefs and warriors. They readily
+complied, and conducted the party along the same
+road down the river. In this way they marched
+two miles, when they met a troop of nearly sixty
+warriors, mounted on excellent horses, riding at full
+speed towards them. As they advanced, Capt. Lewis
+put down his gun, and went with the flag about fifty
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_102" id="Page_102">[Pg 102]</a></span>paces in advance. The chief, who, with two men,
+was riding in front of the main body, spoke to the
+women, who now explained that the party was composed
+of white men, and showed exultingly the
+presents they had received. The three men immediately
+leaped from their horses, came up to Capt.
+Lewis, and embraced him with great cordiality,&mdash;putting
+their left arm over his right shoulder, and
+clasping his back,&mdash;applying at the same time their
+left cheek to his, and frequently vociferating, 'Ah-hi-e!'&mdash;'<i>I
+am glad! I am glad!</i>'</p>
+
+<p>"The whole body of warriors now came forward,
+and our men received the caresses, and no small
+share of the grease and paint, of their new friends.
+After this fraternal embrace, Capt. Lewis lighted a
+pipe, and offered it to the Indians, who had now
+seated themselves in a circle around our party. But,
+before they would receive this mark of friendship,
+they pulled off their moccasons; a custom which, we
+afterwards learned, indicates their sincerity when
+they smoke with a stranger.</p>
+
+<p>"After smoking a few pipes, some trifling presents
+were distributed among them, with which they seemed
+very much pleased, particularly with the blue beads
+and the vermilion.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_103" id="Page_103">[Pg 103]</a></span>"Capt. Lewis then informed the chief that the
+object of his visit was friendly, and should be explained
+as soon as he reached their camp; but that
+in the mean time, as the sun was oppressive, and no
+water near, he wished to go there as soon as possible.
+They now put on their moccasons; and their chief,
+whose name was Cameahwait, made a short speech to
+the warriors. Capt. Lewis then gave him the flag,
+which he informed him was the emblem of peace,
+and that now and for the future it was to be the
+pledge of union between us and them. The chief
+then moved on, our party followed, and the rest of
+the warriors brought up the rear.</p>
+
+<p>"At the distance of four miles from where they
+had first met the Indians, they reached the camp,
+which was in a handsome, level meadow on the bank
+of the river. Here they were introduced into a
+leathern lodge which was assigned for their reception.
+After being seated on green boughs and antelope-skins,
+one of the warriors pulled up the grass in
+the centre of the lodge, so as to form a vacant circle
+of two feet in diameter, in which he kindled a fire.
+The chief then produced his pipe and tobacco; the
+warriors all pulled off their moccasons, and our party
+were requested to take off their own. This being
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_104" id="Page_104">[Pg 104]</a></span>done, the chief lighted his pipe at the fire, and then,
+retreating from it, began a speech several minutes
+long; at the end of which he pointed the stem of
+his pipe towards the four cardinal points of the
+heavens, beginning with the east, and concluding
+with the north. After this ceremony, he presented
+the stem in the same way to Capt. Lewis, who, supposing
+it an invitation to smoke, put out his hand to
+receive the pipe; but the chief drew it back, and
+continued to repeat the same offer three times; after
+which he pointed the stem to the heavens, then
+took three whiffs himself, and presented it again to
+Capt. Lewis. Finding that this last offer was in good
+earnest, he smoked a little, and returned it. The
+pipe was then held to each of the white men, and,
+after they had taken a few whiffs, was given to the
+warriors.</p>
+
+<p>"The bowl of the pipe was made of a dense, transparent,
+green stone, very highly polished, about two
+and a half inches long, and of an oval figure; the
+bowl being in the same direction with the stem.
+The tobacco is of the same kind with that used by
+the Minnetarees and Mandans of the Missouri. The
+Shoshonees do not cultivate this plant, but obtain it
+from the bands who live farther south.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_105" id="Page_105">[Pg 105]</a></span>"The ceremony of smoking being concluded, Capt.
+Lewis explained to the chief the purposes of his visit;
+and, as by this time all the women and children of
+the camp had gathered around the lodge to indulge
+in a view of the first white men they had ever seen,
+he distributed among them the remainder of the
+small articles he had brought with him.</p>
+
+<p>"It was now late in the afternoon, and our party
+had tasted no food since the night before. On apprising
+the chief of this fact, he said that he had
+nothing but berries to eat, and presented some cakes
+made of service-berries and choke-cherries which
+had been dried in the sun. Of these, Capt. Lewis
+and his companions made as good a meal as they
+were able.</p>
+
+<p>"The chief informed him that the stream which
+flowed by them discharged itself, at the distance of
+half a day's march, into another of twice its size;
+but added that there was no timber there suitable for
+building canoes, and that the river was rocky and
+rapid. The prospect of going on by land was more
+pleasant; for there were great numbers of horses
+feeding round the camp, which would serve to transport
+our stores over the mountains.</p>
+
+<p>"An Indian invited Capt. Lewis into his lodge,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_106" id="Page_106">[Pg 106]</a></span>and gave him a small morsel of boiled antelope, and
+a piece of fresh salmon, roasted. This was the first
+salmon he had seen, and perfectly satisfied him that
+he was now on the waters of the Pacific.</p>
+
+<p>"On returning to the lodge, he resumed his conversation
+with the chief; after which he was entertained
+with a dance by the Indians. The music and
+dancing&mdash;which were in no respect different from
+those of the Missouri Indians&mdash;continued nearly all
+night; but Capt. Lewis retired to rest about twelve
+o'clock, when the fatigues of the day enabled him to
+sleep, though he was awaked several times by the
+yells of the dancers."</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_107" id="Page_107">[Pg 107]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER IX.</h2>
+
+<h3>THE PARTY IN THE BOATS.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>August, 1805.&mdash;While these things were occurring
+to Capt. Lewis, the party in the boats were
+slowly and laboriously ascending the river. It was
+very crooked, the bends short and abrupt, and obstructed
+by so many shoals, over which the canoes
+had to be dragged, that the men were in the water
+three-fourths of the day. They saw numbers of
+otters, some beavers, antelopes, ducks, geese, and
+cranes; but they killed nothing except a single deer.
+They caught, however, some very fine trout. The
+weather was cloudy and cool; and at eight o'clock a
+shower of rain fell.</p>
+
+<p>Next day, as the morning was cold, and the men
+stiff and sore from the fatigues of yesterday, they
+did not set out till seven o'clock. The river was
+shallow, and, as it approached the mountains, formed
+one continued rapid, over which they were obliged
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_108" id="Page_108">[Pg 108]</a></span>to drag the boats with great labor and difficulty.
+By these means, they succeeded in making fourteen
+miles; but this distance did not exceed more than
+six and a half in a straight line.</p>
+
+<p>Several successive days were passed in this manner
+(the daily progress seldom exceeding a dozen
+miles), while the party anxiously expected to be
+rejoined by Capt. Lewis and his men, with intelligence
+of some relief by the aid of friendly Indians.
+In the mean time, Capt. Lewis was as anxiously expecting
+their arrival, to confirm the good impressions
+he had made on the Indians, as well as to remove
+some lurking doubts they still felt as to his intentions.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">CAPT. LEWIS AMONG THE SHOSHONEES.</p>
+
+<p>Aug. 14.&mdash;In order to give time for the boats to
+reach the forks of Jefferson River, Capt. Lewis determined
+to remain where he was, and obtain all the
+information he could with regard to the country.
+Having nothing to eat but a little flour and parched
+meal, with the berries of the Indians, he sent out
+Drewyer and Shields, who borrowed horses of the
+natives, to hunt. At the same time, the young warriors
+set out for the same purpose.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_109" id="Page_109">[Pg 109]</a></span>There are but few elk or black-tailed deer in this
+region; and, as the common red deer secrete themselves
+in the bushes when alarmed, they are soon
+safe from the arrows of the Indian hunters, which
+are but feeble weapons against any animal which the
+huntsmen cannot previously run down. The chief
+game of the Shoshonees, therefore, is the antelope,
+which, when pursued, runs to the open plains, where
+the horses have full room for the chase. But such is
+this animal's extraordinary fleetness and wind, that a
+single horse has no chance of outrunning it, or tiring
+it down; and the hunters are therefore obliged to
+resort to stratagem. About twenty Indians, mounted
+on fine horses, and armed with bows and arrows, left
+the camp. In a short time, they descried a herd of
+ten antelopes. They immediately separated into little
+squads of two or three, and formed a scattered circle
+round the herd for five or six miles, keeping at a
+wary distance, so as not to alarm them till they were
+perfectly enclosed. Having gained their positions, a
+small party rode towards the herd; the huntsman
+preserving his seat with wonderful tenacity, and the
+horse his footing, as he ran at full speed over the
+hills, and down the ravines, and along the edges
+of precipices. They were soon outstripped by the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_110" id="Page_110">[Pg 110]</a></span>antelopes, which, on gaining the other limit of
+the circle, were driven back, and pursued by fresh
+hunters. They turned, and flew, rather than ran, in
+another direction; but there, too, they found new
+enemies. In this way they were alternately driven
+backwards and forwards, till at length, notwithstanding
+the skill of the hunters, they all escaped; and
+the party, after running two hours, returned without
+having caught any thing, and their horses foaming
+with sweat. This chase, the greater part of which
+was seen from the camp, formed a beautiful scene;
+but to the hunters it is exceedingly laborious, and
+so unproductive, even when they are able to worry
+the animal down and shoot him, that forty or fifty
+hunters will sometimes be engaged for half a day
+without obtaining more than two or three antelopes.
+Soon after they returned, our two huntsmen came in
+with no better success. Capt. Lewis therefore made
+a little paste with the flour, and the addition of some
+berries formed a tolerable repast.</p>
+
+<p>Having now secured the good-will of Cameahwait,
+Capt. Lewis informed him of his wish,&mdash;that he
+would speak to the warriors, and endeavor to engage
+them to accompany him to the forks of Jefferson
+River, where, by this time, another chief, with a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_111" id="Page_111">[Pg 111]</a></span>large party of white men, were waiting his return.
+He added, that it would be necessary to take about
+thirty horses to transport the merchandise; that they
+should be well rewarded for their trouble; and that,
+when all the party should have reached the Shoshonee
+camp, they would remain some time among them,
+and trade for horses, as well as concert plans for
+furnishing them in future with regular supplies of
+merchandise. Cameahwait readily consented to do
+as requested; and, after collecting the tribe together,
+he made a long harangue, and in about an
+hour and a half returned, and told Capt. Lewis that
+they would be ready to accompany him next morning.</p>
+
+<p>Capt. Lewis rose early, and, having eaten nothing
+yesterday except his scanty meal of flour and berries,
+felt the pain of extreme hunger. On inquiry,
+he found that his whole stock of provisions consisted
+of two pounds of flour. This he ordered to be divided
+into two equal parts, and one-half of it boiled
+with the berries into a sort of pudding; and, after
+presenting a large share to the chief, he and his
+three men breakfasted on the remainder. Cameahwait
+was delighted with this new dish. He took a
+little of the flour in his hand, tasted it, and examined
+it very carefully, asking if it was made of roots.
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_112" id="Page_112">[Pg 112]</a></span>Capt. Lewis explained how it was produced, and the
+chief said it was the best thing he had eaten for a
+long time.</p>
+
+<p>Breakfast being finished, Capt. Lewis endeavored
+to hasten the departure of the Indians, who seemed
+reluctant to move, although the chief addressed them
+twice for the purpose of urging them. On inquiring
+the reason, Capt. Lewis learned that the Indians
+were suspicious that they were to be led into an
+ambuscade, and betrayed to their enemies. He exerted
+himself to dispel this suspicion, and succeeded
+so far as to induce eight of the warriors, with Cameahwait,
+to accompany him. It was about twelve
+o'clock when his small party left the camp, attended
+by Cameahwait and the eight warriors. At sunset
+they reached the river, and encamped about four
+miles above the narrow pass between the hills, which
+they had noticed in their progress some days before.
+Drewyer had been sent forward to hunt; but he returned
+in the evening unsuccessful; and their only
+supply, therefore, was the remaining pound of flour,
+stirred in a little boiling water, and divided between
+the four white men and two of the Indians.</p>
+
+<p>Next morning, as neither our party nor the Indians
+had any thing to eat, Capt. Lewis sent two of
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_113" id="Page_113">[Pg 113]</a></span>his hunters out to procure some provision. At the
+same time, he requested Cameahwait to prevent his
+young men from going out, lest, by their noise, they
+might alarm the game. This measure immediately
+revived their suspicions, and some of them followed
+our two men to watch them. After the hunters had
+been gone about an hour, Capt. Lewis mounted, with
+one of the Indians behind him, and the whole party
+set out. Just then, they saw one of the spies coming
+back at full speed across the plain. The chief
+stopped, and seemed uneasy: the whole band were
+moved with fresh suspicions; and Capt. Lewis himself
+was anxious, lest, by some unfortunate accident,
+some hostile tribe might have wandered that way.
+The young Indian had hardly breath to say a few
+words as he came up, when the whole troop dashed
+forward as fast as their horses could carry them; and
+Capt. Lewis, astonished at this movement, was borne
+along for nearly a mile, before he learned, with great
+satisfaction, that it was all caused by the spy's having
+come to announce that one of the white men had
+killed a deer.</p>
+
+<p>When they reached the place where Drewyer, in
+cutting up the deer, had thrown out the intestines,
+the Indians dismounted in confusion, and ran, <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_114" id="Page_114">[Pg 114]</a></span>tumbling
+over each other, like famished dogs: each tore
+away whatever part he could, and instantly began to
+devour it. Some had the liver, some the kidneys:
+in short, no part on which we are accustomed to look
+with disgust escaped them. It was, indeed, impossible
+to see these wretches ravenously feeding on the
+refuse of animals, and the blood streaming from their
+mouths, without deploring how nearly the condition
+of savages approaches that of the brute creation.
+Yet, though suffering with hunger, they did not
+attempt to take (as they might have done) by force
+the whole deer, but contented themselves with what
+had been thrown away by the hunter. Capt. Lewis
+had the deer skinned, and, after reserving a quarter
+of it, gave the rest of the animal to the chief, to
+be divided among the Indians, who immediately devoured
+the whole without cooking.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THEY MEET THE BOAT PARTY.</p>
+
+<p>As they were now approaching the place where
+they had been told they should see the white men,
+Capt. Lewis, to guard against any disappointment,
+explained the possibility of our men not having
+reached the forks, in consequence of the difficulty
+of the navigation; so that, if they should not find
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_115" id="Page_115">[Pg 115]</a></span>us at that spot, they might be assured of our being
+not far below. After stopping two hours to let the
+horses graze, they remounted, and rode on rapidly,
+making one of the Indians carry the flag, so that the
+party in the boats might recognize them as they
+approached. To their great mortification, on coming
+within sight of the forks, no canoes were to be seen.</p>
+
+<p>Uneasy, lest at this moment he should be abandoned,
+and all his hopes of obtaining aid from the
+Indians be destroyed, Capt. Lewis gave the chief
+his gun, telling him, if the enemies of his nation
+were in the bushes, he might defend himself with it;
+and that the chief might shoot him as soon as they
+discovered themselves betrayed. The other three
+men at the same time gave their guns to the Indians,
+who now seemed more easy, but still suspicious.
+Luckily, he had a hold on them by other ties than
+their generosity. He had promised liberal exchanges
+for their horses; but, what was still more attractive,
+he had told them that one of their country-women,
+who had been taken by the Minnetarees, accompanied
+the party below: and one of the men had spread the
+report of our having with us a man perfectly black,
+whose hair was short and curled. This last account
+had excited a great degree of curiosity; and they
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_116" id="Page_116">[Pg 116]</a></span>seemed more desirous of seeing this monster than
+of obtaining the most favorable barter for their
+horses.</p>
+
+<p>In the mean time, the boat party under Capt.
+Clarke, struggling against rapids and shallows, had
+made their way to a point only four miles by land,
+though ten by water, from where Capt. Lewis and
+the Indians were. Capt. Clarke had seen from an
+eminence the forks of the river, and sent the hunters
+up. They must have left it only a short time before
+Capt. Lewis's arrival.</p>
+
+<p>Aug. 17.&mdash;Capt. Lewis rose early, and despatched
+Drewyer and the Indian down the river in
+quest of the boats. They had been gone about two
+hours, and the Indians were all anxiously waiting
+for some news, when an Indian who had straggled
+a short distance down the river returned, with a
+report that he had seen the white men, who were
+not far below, and were coming on. The Indians
+were all delighted; and the chief, in the warmth
+of his affection, renewed his embrace to Capt. Lewis,
+who, though quite as much gratified, would willingly
+have spared that manifestation of it. The report
+proved true. On commencing the day's progress,
+Capt. Clarke, with Chaboneau and his wife, walked
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_117" id="Page_117">[Pg 117]</a></span>by the river-side; but they had not gone more than
+a mile, when Capt. Clarke saw Sacajawea, the Indian
+woman, who was some distance in advance, begin to
+dance, and show every mark of extravagant joy,
+pointing to several Indians, whom he now saw advancing
+on horseback. As they approached, Capt.
+Clarke discovered Drewyer among them, from whom
+he learned the situation of Capt. Lewis and his
+party. While the boats were performing the circuit,
+Capt. Clarke went towards the forks with the
+Indians, who, as they went along, sang aloud with
+the greatest appearance of delight.</p>
+
+<p>They soon drew near the camp; and, as they
+approached it, a woman made her way through the
+crowd towards Sacajawea, when, recognizing each
+other, they embraced with the most tender affection.
+The meeting of these two young women had in it
+something peculiarly touching. They had been companions
+in childhood, and, in the war with the Minnetarees,
+had both been taken prisoners in the same
+battle. They had shared the same captivity, till one
+had escaped, leaving her friend with scarce a hope
+of ever seeing her again.</p>
+
+<p>While Sacajawea was renewing among the women
+the friendships of former days, Capt. Clarke
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_118" id="Page_118">[Pg 118]</a></span>went on, and was received by Capt. Lewis and the
+chief, who, after the first embraces and salutations,
+conducted him to a sort of circular tent constructed
+of willow-branches. Here he was seated on a white
+robe; and the chief tied in his hair six small shells
+resembling pearls,&mdash;an ornament highly valued by
+these people. After smoking, a conference was held,
+Sacajawea acting as interpreter. Capt. Lewis told
+them he had been sent to discover the best route
+by which merchandise could be conveyed to them,
+and, since no trade would be begun before our return,
+it was naturally desirable that we should proceed
+with as little delay as possible; that we were
+under the necessity of requesting them to furnish us
+with horses to transport our baggage across the
+mountains, and a guide to show us the route; but
+that they should be amply remunerated for their
+horses, as well as for any other service they should
+render us. In the mean time, our first wish was
+that they should immediately collect as many horses
+as were necessary to transport our baggage to their
+village, where, at our leisure, we would trade with
+them for as many horses as they could spare.</p>
+
+<p>The speech made a favorable impression. The
+chief thanked us for our friendly intentions, and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_119" id="Page_119">[Pg 119]</a></span>declared their willingness to render us every service.
+He promised to return to the village next
+day, and to bring all his own horses, and to encourage
+his people to bring theirs. We then distributed
+our presents. To Cameahwait we gave a medal of
+the small size, with the likeness of President Jefferson,
+and on the reverse a figure of hands clasped,
+with a pipe and tomahawk. To this were added
+a uniform-coat, a shirt, a pair of scarlet leggings, a
+lump of tobacco, and some small articles. Each of
+the other chiefs received similar presents, excepting
+the dress-coat. These honorary gifts were followed
+by presents of paint, moccasons, awls, knives, beads,
+and looking-glasses. They had abundant sources of
+surprise in all they saw. The appearance of the
+men, their arms, their clothing, the canoes, the
+strange looks of the negro, and the sagacity of our
+dog, all in turn shared their admiration, which was
+raised to astonishment by a shot from the air-gun.
+This was immediately pronounced a <i>Great Medicine</i>,
+by which they mean something produced by the
+Great Spirit himself in some incomprehensible way.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_120" id="Page_120">[Pg 120]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER X.</h2>
+
+<h3>THE DESCENT OF THE COLUMBIA.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>August, 1805.&mdash;Our Indian information as to
+the navigation of the Columbia was of a very
+discouraging character. It was therefore agreed
+that Capt. Clarke should set off in the morning with
+eleven men, furnished, besides their arms, with tools
+for making canoes; that he should take Chaboneau
+and his wife to the camp of the Shoshonees, where he
+was to leave them to hasten the collection of horses;
+that he was then to lead his men down to the Columbia;
+and if he found it navigable, and the timber in
+sufficient quantity, should begin to build canoes. As
+soon as he should have decided on the question of
+proceeding, whether down the river or across the
+mountains, he was to send back one of the men, with
+information of his decision, to Capt. Lewis, who would
+tarry meanwhile at the Shoshonee village.</p>
+
+<p>Aug. 20.&mdash;Capt. Clarke set out at six o'clock.
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_121" id="Page_121">[Pg 121]</a></span>Passing through a continuation of hilly, broken country,
+he met several parties of Indians. An old man
+among them was pointed out, who was said to know
+more of the nature of the country north than any
+other person; and Capt. Clarke engaged him as a
+guide.</p>
+
+<p>The first point to ascertain was the truth of the
+Indian information as to the difficulty of descending
+the river. For this purpose, Capt. Clarke and his
+men set out at three o'clock in the afternoon, accompanied
+by his Indian guide. At the distance of four
+miles he crossed the river, and, eight miles from the
+camp, halted for the night. As Capt. Lewis was the
+first white man who had visited its waters, Capt.
+Clarke gave the stream the name of Lewis's River.</p>
+
+<p>Aug. 23.&mdash;Capt. Clarke set out very early; but
+as his route lay along the steep side of a mountain,
+over irregular and broken masses of rocks, which
+wounded the horses' feet, he was obliged to proceed
+slowly. At the distance of four miles, he reached the
+river; but the rocks here became so steep, and projected
+so far into the stream, that there was no mode
+of passing except through the water. This he did for
+some distance, though the current was very rapid,
+and so deep, that they were forced to swim their
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_122" id="Page_122">[Pg 122]</a></span>horses. After following the edge of the stream for
+about a mile, he reached a small meadow, below which
+the whole current of the river beat against the shore
+on which he was, and which was formed of a solid
+rock, perfectly inaccessible to horses. He therefore
+resolved to leave the horses and the greater part of
+the men at this place, and continue his examination
+of the river on foot, in order to determine if there
+were any possibility of descending it in canoes.</p>
+
+<p>With his guide and three men he proceeded,
+clambering over immense rocks, and along the sides
+of precipices which bordered the stream. The river
+presented a succession of shoals, neither of which
+could be passed with loaded canoes; and the baggage
+must therefore be transported for considerable
+distances over the steep mountains, where it would
+be impossible to employ horses. Even the empty
+boats must be let down the rapids by means of cords,
+and not even in this way without great risk both to
+the canoes and the men.</p>
+
+<p>Disappointed in finding a route by way of the
+river, Capt. Clarke now questioned his guide more
+particularly respecting an Indian road which came in
+from the north. The guide, who seemed intelligent,
+drew a map on the sand, and represented this road as
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_123" id="Page_123">[Pg 123]</a></span>leading to a great river where resided a nation called
+Tushepaws, who, having no salmon on their river,
+came by this road to the fish-wears on Lewis's River.
+After a great deal of conversation, or rather signs,
+Capt. Clarke felt persuaded that his guide knew of a
+road from the Shoshonee village they had left, to the
+great river toward the north, without coming so low
+down as this, on a road impracticable for horses. He
+therefore hastened to return thither, sending forward
+a man on horseback with a note to Capt. Lewis,
+apprising him of the result of his inquiries.</p>
+
+<p>From the 25th to the 29th of August, Capt. Clarke
+and his men were occupied in their return to the
+Shoshonee village, where Capt. Lewis and party were
+awaiting them. During their march, the want of provisions
+was such, that if it had not been for the liberality
+of the Indians, who gave them a share of their
+own scanty supplies, they must have perished. The
+main dependence for food was upon salmon and berries.
+It was seldom they could get enough of these
+for a full meal; and abstinence and the strange diet
+caused some sickness. Capt. Lewis, on the contrary,
+had found the game sufficiently abundant to supply
+their own party, and to spare some to the Indians;
+so that, when their friends rejoined them, they had it
+in their power to immediately relieve their wants.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_124" id="Page_124">[Pg 124]</a></span>THE SHOSHONEES.</p>
+
+<p>The Shoshonees are a small tribe of the nation
+called Snake Indians,&mdash;a vague denomination, which
+embraces at once the inhabitants of the southern
+parts of the Rocky Mountains, and of the plains on
+each side. The Shoshonees, with whom we now are,
+amount to about a hundred warriors, and three times
+that number of women and children. Within their
+own recollection, they formerly lived in the plains;
+but they have been driven into the mountains by the
+roving Indians of the Saskatchawan country, and are
+now obliged to visit only occasionally and by stealth
+the country of their ancestors. From the middle of
+May to the beginning of September, they reside on
+the waters of the Columbia. During this time, they
+subsist chiefly on salmon; and, as that fish disappears
+on the approach of autumn, they are obliged to seek
+subsistence elsewhere. They then cross the ridge to
+the waters of the Missouri, down which they proceed
+cautiously till they are joined by other bands of their
+own nation, or of the Flatheads, with whom they associate
+against the common enemy. Being now strong
+in numbers, they venture to hunt buffaloes in the
+plains eastward of the mountains, near which they
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_125" id="Page_125">[Pg 125]</a></span>spend the winter, till the return of the salmon invites
+them to the Columbia.</p>
+
+<p>In this loose and wandering existence, they suffer
+the extremes of want: for two-thirds of the year they
+are forced to live in the mountains, passing whole
+weeks without meat, and with nothing to eat but a
+few fish and roots.</p>
+
+<p>Yet the Shoshonees are not only cheerful, but gay;
+and their character is more interesting than that of
+any other Indians we have seen. They are frank and
+communicative; fair in their dealings; and we have
+had no reason to suspect that the display of our new
+and valuable wealth has tempted them into a single
+act of theft. While they have shared with us the
+little they possess, they have always abstained from
+begging any thing of us.</p>
+
+<p>Their wealth is in horses. Of these they have at
+least seven hundred, among which are about forty
+colts, and half that number of mules. The original
+stock was procured from the Spaniards; but now they
+raise their own, which are generally of good size, vigorous,
+and patient of fatigue as well as of hunger.
+Every warrior has one or two tied to a stake near his
+hut day and night, so as to be always prepared for
+action. The mules are obtained in the course of
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_126" id="Page_126">[Pg 126]</a></span>trade from the Spaniards of California. They are
+highly valued. The worst are considered as worth
+the price of two horses.</p>
+
+<p>The Shoshonee warrior always fights on horseback.
+He possesses a few bad guns, which are reserved for
+war; but his common arms are the bow and arrow,
+a shield, a lance, and a weapon called <i>pogamogon</i>,
+which consists of a handle of wood, with a stone
+weighing about two pounds, and held in a cover of
+leather, attached to the handle by a leather thong.
+At the other end is a loop, which is passed round the
+wrist, so as to secure the hold of the instrument, with
+which they strike a very severe blow.</p>
+
+<p>The bow is made of cedar or pine, covered on the
+outer side with sinews and glue. Sometimes it is
+made of the horn of an elk, covered on the back like
+those of wood. The arrows are more slender than
+those of other Indians we have seen. They are kept,
+with the implements for striking fire, in a narrow
+quiver formed of different kinds of skin. It is just
+long enough to protect the arrows from the weather,
+and is fastened upon the back of the wearer by means
+of a strap passing over the right shoulder, and under
+the left arm. The shield is a circular piece of buffalo-skin,
+about two feet four inches in diameter,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_127" id="Page_127">[Pg 127]</a></span>ornamented with feathers, with a fringe round it of
+dressed leather, and adorned with paintings of strange
+figures.</p>
+
+<p>Besides these, they have a kind of armor, something
+like a coat of mail, which is formed by a great
+many folds of antelope-skins, united by a mixture of
+glue and sand. With this they cover their own bodies
+and those of their horses, and find it impervious to
+the arrow.</p>
+
+<p>The caparison of their horses is a halter and saddle.
+The halter is made of strands of buffalo-hair
+platted together; or is merely a thong of raw hide,
+made pliant by pounding and rubbing. The halter is
+very long, and is never taken from the neck of the
+horse when in constant use. One end of it is first
+tied round the neck in a knot, and then brought
+down to the under-jaw, round which it is formed into
+a simple noose, passing through the mouth. It is
+then drawn up on the right side, and held by the
+rider in his left hand, while the rest trails after him
+to some distance. With these cords dangling alongside
+of them, the horse is put to his full speed, without
+fear of falling; and, when he is turned to graze,
+the noose is merely taken from his mouth.</p>
+
+<p>The saddle is formed, like the pack-saddles used by
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_128" id="Page_128">[Pg 128]</a></span>the French and Spaniards, of two flat, thin boards,
+which fit the sides of the horse, and are kept together
+by two cross-pieces, one before and the other behind,
+which rise to a considerable height, making the saddle
+deep and narrow. Under this, a piece of buffalo-skin,
+with the hair on, is placed, so as to prevent the
+rubbing of the board; and, when the rider mounts,
+he throws a piece of skin or robe over the saddle,
+which has no permanent cover. When stirrups are
+used, they consist of wood covered with leather; but
+stirrups and saddles are conveniences reserved for
+women and old men. The young warriors rarely use
+any thing except a small, leather pad stuffed with
+hair, and secured by a girth made of a leathern thong.
+In this way, they ride with great expertness; and
+they have particular dexterity in catching the horse
+when he is running at large. They make a noose in
+the rope, and although the horse may be at some distance,
+or even running, rarely fail to fix it on his neck;
+and such is the docility of the animal, that, however
+unruly he may seem, he surrenders as soon as he feels
+the rope on him.</p>
+
+<p>The horse becomes an object of attachment. A
+favorite is frequently painted, and his ears cut into
+various shapes. The mane and tail, which are never
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_129" id="Page_129">[Pg 129]</a></span>drawn nor trimmed, are decorated with feathers of
+birds; and sometimes a warrior suspends at the
+breast of his horse the finest ornaments he possesses.</p>
+
+<p>Thus armed and mounted, the Shoshonee is a formidable
+enemy, even with the feeble weapons which
+he is still obliged to use. When they attack at full
+speed, they bend forward, and cover their bodies with
+the shield, while with the right hand they shoot under
+the horse's neck.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">INDIAN HORSES AND RIDERS.</p>
+
+<p>They are so well supplied with horses, that every
+man, woman, and child is mounted; and all they have
+is packed upon horses. Small children, not more than
+three years old, are mounted alone, and generally
+upon colts. They are tied upon the saddle to keep
+them from falling, especially when they go to sleep,
+which they often do when they become fatigued.
+Then they lie down upon the horse's shoulders; and,
+when they awake, they lay hold of their whip, which
+is fastened to the wrist of their right hand, and apply
+it smartly to their horses: and it is astonishing to see
+how these little creatures will guide and run them.
+Children that are still younger are put into an incasement
+made with a board at the back, and a <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_130" id="Page_130">[Pg 130]</a></span>wicker-work
+around the other parts, covered with cloth
+inside and without, or, more generally, with dressed
+skins; and they are carried upon the mother's back,
+or suspended from a high knob upon the fore part of
+their saddles.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_131" id="Page_131">[Pg 131]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XI.</h2>
+
+<h3>CLARKE'S RIVER.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>AUG. 31.&mdash;Capt. Lewis, during the absence of
+his brother-officer, had succeeded in procuring
+from the Indians, by barter, twenty-nine horses,&mdash;not
+quite one for each man. Capt. Clarke having now
+rejoined us, and the weather being fine, we loaded
+our horses, and prepared to start. We took our leave
+of the Shoshonees, and accompanied by the old guide,
+his four sons, and another Indian, began the descent
+of the river, which Capt. Clarke had named Lewis's
+River. After riding twelve miles, we encamped on
+the bank; and, as the hunters had brought in three
+deer early in the morning, we did not feel in want of
+provisions.</p>
+
+<p>On the 31st of August, we made eighteen miles.
+Here we left the track of Capt. Clarke, and began to
+explore the new route recommended by the Indian
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_132" id="Page_132">[Pg 132]</a></span>guide, and which was our last hope of getting out of
+the mountains.</p>
+
+<p>During all day, we rode over hills, from which are
+many drains and small streams, and, at the distance
+of eighteen miles, came to a large creek, called Fish
+Creek, emptying into the main river, which is about
+six miles from us.</p>
+
+<p>Sept. 2.&mdash;This morning, all the Indians left us, except
+the old guide, who now conducted us up Fish
+Creek. We arrived shortly after at the forks of the
+creek. The road we were following now turned in a
+contrary direction to our course, and we were left
+without any track; but, as no time was to be lost, we
+began to cut our road up the west branch of the
+creek. This we effected with much difficulty. The
+thickets of trees and brush through which we were
+obliged to cut our way required great labor. Our
+course was over the steep and rocky sides of the
+hills, where the horses could not move without danger
+of slipping down, while their feet were bruised
+by the rocks, and stumps of trees. Accustomed as
+these animals were to this kind of life, they suffered
+severely. Several of them fell to some distance down
+the sides of the hills, some turned over with the baggage,
+one was crippled, and two gave out exhausted
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_133" id="Page_133">[Pg 133]</a></span>with fatigue. After crossing the creek several times,
+we had made five miles with great labor, and encamped
+in a small, stony, low ground. It was not,
+however, till after dark that the whole party was collected;
+and then, as it rained, and we killed nothing,
+we passed an uncomfortable night. We had been too
+busily occupied with the horses to make any hunting
+excursion; and, though we saw many beaver-dams in
+the creek, we saw none of the animals.</p>
+
+<p>Next day, our experiences were much the same,
+with the addition of a fall of snow at evening. The
+day following, we reached the head of a stream which
+directed its course more to the westward, and followed
+it till we discovered a large encampment of
+Indians. When we reached them, and alighted from
+our horses, we were received with great cordiality.
+A council was immediately assembled, white robes
+were thrown over our shoulders, and the pipe of
+peace introduced. After this ceremony, as it was too
+late to go any farther, we encamped, and continued
+smoking and conversing with the chiefs till a late
+hour.</p>
+
+<p>Next morning, we assembled the chiefs and warriors,
+and informed them who we were, and the purpose
+for which we visited their country. All this
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_134" id="Page_134">[Pg 134]</a></span>was, however, conveyed to them in so many different
+languages, that it was not comprehended without difficulty.
+We therefore proceeded to the more intelligible
+language of presents, and made four chiefs by
+giving a medal and a small quantity of tobacco to
+each. We received in turn, from the principal chiefs,
+a present, consisting of the skins of an otter and two
+antelopes; and were treated by the women to some
+dried roots and berries. We then began to traffic for
+horses, and succeeded in exchanging seven, and purchasing
+eleven.</p>
+
+<p>These Indians are a band of the Tushepaws, a
+numerous people of four hundred and fifty tents, residing
+on the head waters of the Missouri and Columbia
+Rivers, and some of them lower down the latter
+river. They seemed kind and friendly, and willingly
+shared with us berries and roots, which formed their
+only stock of provisions. Their only wealth is their
+horses, which are very fine, and so numerous that this
+band had with them at least five hundred.</p>
+
+<p>We proceeded next day, and, taking a north-west
+direction, crossed, within a distance of a mile and a
+half, a small river from the right. This river is the
+main stream; and, when it reaches the end of the valley,
+it is joined by two other streams. To the river
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_135" id="Page_135">[Pg 135]</a></span>thus formed we gave the name of Clarke's River; he
+being the first white man who ever visited its
+waters.</p>
+
+<p>We followed the course of the river, which is from
+twenty-five to thirty yards wide, shallow, and stony,
+with the low grounds on its borders narrow; and encamped
+on its right bank, after making ten miles.
+Our stock of flour was now exhausted, and we had
+but little corn; and, as our hunters had killed nothing
+except two pheasants, our supper consisted chiefly of
+berries.</p>
+
+<p>The next day, and the next, we followed the river,
+which widened to fifty yards, with a valley four or five
+miles broad. At ten miles from our camp was a creek,
+which emptied itself on the west side of the river.
+It was a fine bold creek of clear water, about twenty
+yards wide; and we called it Traveller's Rest: for, as
+our guide told us we should here leave the river, we
+determined to make some stay for the purpose of collecting
+food, as the country through which we were
+to pass has no game for a great distance.</p>
+
+<p>Toward evening, one of the hunters returned with
+three Indians whom he had met. We found that
+they were Tushepaw Flatheads in pursuit of strayed
+horses. We gave them some boiled venison and a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_136" id="Page_136">[Pg 136]</a></span>few presents, such as a fish hook, a steel to strike fire,
+and a little powder; but they seemed better pleased
+with a piece of ribbon which we tied in the hair of
+each of them. Their people, they said, were numerous,
+and resided on the great river in the plain below
+the mountains. From that place, they added, the
+river was navigable to the ocean. The distance from
+this place is five "sleeps," or days' journeys.</p>
+
+<p>On resuming our route, we proceeded up the right
+side of the creek (thus leaving Clarke's River), over
+a country, which, at first plain and good, became afterwards
+as difficult as any we had yet traversed.</p>
+
+<p>We had now reached the sources of Traveller's-rest
+Creek, and followed the road, which became less rugged.
+At our encampment this night, the game having
+entirely failed us, we killed a colt, on which we
+made a hearty supper. We reached the river, which
+is here eighty yards wide, with a swift current and
+a rocky channel. Its Indian name is Kooskooskee.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">KOOSKOOSKEE RIVER.</p>
+
+<p>Sept. 16.&mdash;This morning, snow fell, and continued
+all day; so that by evening it was six or eight inches
+deep. It covered the track so completely, that we
+were obliged constantly to halt and examine, lest we
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_137" id="Page_137">[Pg 137]</a></span>should lose the route. The road is, like that of yesterday,
+along steep hillsides, obstructed with fallen timber,
+and a growth of eight different species of pine, so
+thickly strewed, that the snow falls from them upon
+us as we pass, keeping us continually wet to the skin.
+We encamped in a piece of low ground, thickly timbered,
+but scarcely large enough to permit us to lie
+level. We had made thirteen miles. We were wet,
+cold, and hungry; yet we could not procure any game,
+and were obliged to kill another horse for our supper.
+This want of provisions, the extreme fatigue to
+which we were subjected, and the dreary prospect
+before us, began to dispirit the men. They are growing
+weak, and losing their flesh very fast.</p>
+
+<p>After three days more of the same kind of experience,
+on Friday, 20th September, an agreeable
+change occurred. Capt. Clarke, who had gone forward
+in hopes of finding game, came suddenly upon
+a beautiful open plain partially stocked with pine.
+Shortly after, he discovered three Indian boys, who,
+observing the party, ran off, and hid themselves in the
+grass. Capt. Clarke immediately alighted, and, giving
+his horse and gun to one of the men, went after
+the boys. He soon relieved their apprehensions, and
+sent them forward to the village, about a mile off,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_138" id="Page_138">[Pg 138]</a></span>with presents of small pieces of ribbon. Soon after
+the boys had reached home, a man came out to meet
+the party, with great caution; but he conducted them
+to a large tent in the village, and all the inhabitants
+gathered round to view with a mixture of fear and
+pleasure the wonderful strangers. The conductor
+now informed Capt. Clarke, by signs, that the spacious
+tent was the residence of the great chief, who
+had set out three days ago, with all the warriors, to
+attack some of their enemies towards the south-west;
+that, in the mean time, there were only a few men left
+to guard the women and children. They now set before
+them a small piece of buffalo-meat, some dried
+salmon, berries, and several kinds of roots. Among
+these last was one which is round, much like an onion
+in appearance, and sweet to the taste. It is called
+<i>quamash</i>, and is eaten either in its natural state, or
+boiled into a kind of soup, or made into a cake, which
+is called <i>pasheco</i>. After our long abstinence, this was
+a sumptuous repast. We returned the kindness of
+the people with a few small presents, and then went
+on, in company with one of the chiefs, to a second village
+in the same plain, at a distance of two miles.
+Here the party was treated with great kindness, and
+passed the night.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_139" id="Page_139">[Pg 139]</a></span>The two villages consist of about thirty double
+tents; and the people call themselves Chopunnish, or
+Pierced-nose. The chief drew a chart of the river
+on the sand, and explained that a greater chief than
+himself, who governed this village, and was called
+the Twisted-hair, was now fishing at the distance of
+half a day's ride down the river. His chart made the
+Kooskooskee to fork a little below his camp, below
+which the river passed the mountains. Here was a
+great fall of water, near which lived white people,
+from whom they procured the white beads and brass
+ornaments worn by the women.</p>
+
+<p>Capt. Clarke engaged an Indian to guide him to the
+Twisted-hair's camp. For twelve miles, they proceeded
+through the plain before they reached the
+river-hills, which are very high and steep. The
+whole valley from these hills to the Rocky Mountains
+is a beautiful level country, with a rich soil covered
+with grass. There is, however, but little timber, and
+the ground is badly watered. The plain is so much
+sheltered by the surrounding hills, that the weather
+is quite warm (Sept. 21), while the cold of the mountains
+was extreme.</p>
+
+<p>From the top of the river-hills we descended for
+three miles till we reached the water-side, between
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_140" id="Page_140">[Pg 140]</a></span>eleven and twelve o'clock at night. Here we found
+a small camp of five women and three children; the
+chief himself being encamped, with two others, on a
+small island in the river. The guide called to him,
+and he came over. Capt. Clarke gave him a medal,
+and they smoked together till one o'clock.</p>
+
+<p>Next day, Capt. Clarke passed over to the island
+with the Twisted-hair, who seemed to be cheerful and
+sincere. The hunters brought in three deer; after
+which Capt. Clarke left his party, and, accompanied
+by the Twisted-hair and his son, rode back to the village,
+where he found Capt. Lewis and his party just
+arrived.</p>
+
+<p>The plains were now crowded with Indians, who
+came to see the white men and the strange things
+they brought with them; but, as our guide was a perfect
+stranger to their language, we could converse by
+signs only. Our inquiries were chiefly directed to
+the situation of the country. The Twisted-hair drew
+a chart of the river on a white elk-skin. According
+to this, the Kooskooskee forks a few miles from
+this place: two days' journey towards the south is
+another and larger fork, on which the Shoshonee
+Indians fish; five days' journey farther is a large
+river from the north-west, into which Clarke's River
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_141" id="Page_141">[Pg 141]</a></span>empties itself. From the junction with that river to
+the falls is five days' journey farther. On all the
+forks, as well as on the main river, great numbers of
+Indians reside; and at the falls are establishments of
+whites. This was the story of the Twisted-hair.</p>
+
+<p>Provision here was abundant. We purchased a
+quantity of fish, berries, and roots; and in the afternoon
+went on to the second village. We continued
+our purchases, and obtained as much provision as our
+horses could carry in their present weak condition.
+Great crowds of the natives are round us all night;
+but we have not yet missed any thing, except a knife
+and a few other small articles.</p>
+
+<p>Sept. 24.&mdash;The weather is fair. All round the village
+the women are busily employed in gathering and
+dressing the pasheco-root, large quantities of which
+are heaped up in piles all over the plain.</p>
+
+<p>We feel severely the consequence of eating heartily
+after our late privations. Capt. Lewis and two of his
+men were taken very ill last evening, and to-day he
+can hardly sit on his horse. Others could not mount
+without help; and some were forced to lie down by
+the side of the road for some time.</p>
+
+<p>Our situation rendered it necessary to husband our
+remaining strength; and it was determined to proceed
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_142" id="Page_142">[Pg 142]</a></span>down the river in canoes. Capt. Clarke therefore set
+out with Twisted-hair and two young men in quest
+of timber for canoes.</p>
+
+<p>Sept. 27, 28, and 29.&mdash;Sickness continued. Few
+of the men were able to work; yet preparations were
+made for making five canoes. A number of Indians
+collect about us in the course of the day to gaze at
+the strange appearance of every thing belonging to
+us.</p>
+
+<p>Oct. 4.&mdash;The men were now much better, and
+Capt. Lewis so far recovered as to walk about a little.
+The canoes being nearly finished, it became necessary
+to dispose of the horses. They were therefore
+collected to the number of thirty-eight, and, being
+branded and marked, were delivered to three Indians,&mdash;the
+two brothers and the son of a chief;
+the chief having promised to accompany us down the
+river. To each of these men we gave a knife and
+some small articles; and they agreed to take good
+care of the horses till our return.</p>
+
+<p>We had all our saddles buried in a <i>cache</i> near the
+river, about half a mile below, and deposited at
+the same time a canister of powder and a bag of
+balls.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_143" id="Page_143">[Pg 143]</a></span>THE VOYAGE DOWN THE KOOSKOOSKEE RIVER.</p>
+
+<p>Oct. 7.&mdash;This morning, all the canoes were put in
+the water, and loaded, the oars fitted, and every preparation
+made for setting out. When we were all
+ready, the chief who had promised to accompany us
+was not to be found: we therefore proceeded without
+him. The Kooskooskee is a clear, rapid stream, with
+a number of shoals and difficult places. This day
+and the next, we made a distance of fifty miles. We
+passed several encampments of Indians on the islands
+and near the rapids, which situations are chosen
+as the most convenient for taking salmon. At one of
+these camps we found the chief, who, after promising
+to descend the river with us, had left us. He, however,
+willingly came on board, after we had gone
+through the ceremony of smoking.</p>
+
+<p>Oct. 10.&mdash;A fine morning. We loaded the canoes,
+and set off at seven o'clock. After passing twenty
+miles, we landed below the junction of a large fork
+of the river, from the south. Our arrival soon attracted
+the attention of the Indians, who flocked from
+all directions to see us. Being again reduced to fish
+and roots, we made an experiment to vary our food
+by purchasing a few dogs; and, after having been
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_144" id="Page_144">[Pg 144]</a></span>accustomed to horse-flesh, felt no disrelish to this new
+dish. The Chopunnish have great numbers of dogs,
+but never use them for food; and our feeding on the
+flesh of that animal brought us into ridicule as dog-eaters.</p>
+
+<p>This southern branch is, in fact, the main stream of
+Lewis's River, on whose upper waters we encamped
+when among the Shoshonees. At its mouth, Lewis's
+River is about two hundred and fifty yards wide, and
+its water is of a greenish-blue color. The Kooskooskee,
+whose waters are clear as crystal, is one hundred
+and fifty yards in width; and, after the union, the
+joint-stream extends to the width of three hundred
+yards.</p>
+
+<p>The Chopunnish, or Pierced-nose Indians, who reside
+on the Kooskooskee and Lewis's Rivers, are in
+person stout, portly, well-looking men. The women
+are small, with good features, and generally handsome,
+though the complexion of both sexes is darker
+than that of the Tushepaws. In dress, they resemble
+that nation, being fond of displaying their ornaments.
+The buffalo or elk-skin robe, decorated with beads,
+sea-shells (chiefly mother-of-pearl), attached to an
+otter-skin collar, is the dress of the men. The same
+ornaments are hung in the hair, which falls in front
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_145" id="Page_145">[Pg 145]</a></span>in two cues: they add feathers, paints of different
+colors (principally white, green, and blue), which
+they find in their own country. In winter, they
+wear a shirt of dressed skins; long, painted leggings,
+and moccasons; and a plait of twisted grass
+round the neck.</p>
+
+<p>The dress of the women is more simple, consisting
+of a long shirt of the mountain-sheep skin, reaching
+down to the ankles, without a girdle. To this are
+tied little pieces of brass and shells, and other small
+articles; but the head is not at all ornamented.</p>
+
+<p>The Chopunnish have few amusements; for their
+life is painful and laborious, and all their exertions
+are necessary to earn a precarious subsistence. During
+the summer and autumn, they are busily occupied
+in fishing for salmon, and collecting their winter store
+of roots. In winter, they hunt the deer on snow-shoes
+over the plains; and, towards spring, cross the
+mountains to the Missouri in pursuit of the buffalo.</p>
+
+<p>The soil of these prairies is a light-yellow clay.
+It is barren, and produces little more than a bearded
+grass about three inches high, and the prickly-pear,
+of which we found three species. The first is the
+broad-leaved kind, common to this river with the Missouri;
+the second has a leaf of a globular form, and is
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_146" id="Page_146">[Pg 146]</a></span>also frequent on the upper part of the Missouri; the
+third is peculiar to this country. It consists of small,
+thick leaves of a circular form, which grow from the
+margin of each other. These leaves are armed with a
+great number of thorns, which are strong, and appear
+to be barbed. As the leaf itself is very slightly attached
+to the stem, as soon as one thorn touches the
+moccason, it adheres, and brings with it the leaf, which
+is accompanied with a re-enforcement of thorns. This
+species was a greater annoyance on our march than
+either of the others.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_147" id="Page_147">[Pg 147]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XII.</h2>
+
+<h3>FROM THE JUNCTION OF THE KOOSKOOSKEE WITH<br /> LEWIS'S
+RIVER TO THE COLUMBIA.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>From the mouth of the Kooskooskee to that of
+the Lewis is about a hundred miles; which distance
+they descended in seven days. The navigation
+was greatly impeded by rapids, which they passed
+with more or less danger and difficulty; being greatly
+indebted to the assistance of the Indians, as they
+thankfully acknowledge. Sometimes they were obliged
+to unload their boats, and to carry them round by land.
+All these rapids are fishing-places, greatly resorted to
+in the season.</p>
+
+<p>On the 17th of October (1805), having reached the
+junction of Lewis's River with the Columbia, they
+found by observation that they were in latitude 46&deg;
+15&acute;, and longitude 119&deg;. They measured the two
+rivers by angles, and found, that, at the junction,
+the Columbia is 960 yards wide; and Lewis's River,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_148" id="Page_148">[Pg 148]</a></span>575: but, below their junction, the joint river is from
+one to three miles in width, including the islands.
+From the point of junction, the country is a continued
+plain, rising gradually from the water. There is
+through this plain no tree, and scarcely any shrub,
+except a few willow-bushes; and, even of smaller
+plants, there is not much besides the prickly-pear,
+which is abundant.</p>
+
+<p>In the course of the day, Capt. Clarke, in a small
+canoe, with two men, ascended the Columbia. At the
+distance of five miles, he came to a small but not dangerous
+rapid. On the bank of the river opposite to
+this is a fishing-place, consisting of three neat houses.
+Here were great quantities of salmon drying on scaffolds;
+and, from the mouth of the river upwards, he
+saw immense numbers of dead salmon strewed along
+the shore, or floating on the water.</p>
+
+<p>The Indians, who had collected on the banks to
+view him, now joined him in eighteen canoes, and
+accompanied him up the river. A mile above the
+rapids, he observed three houses of mats, and landed
+to visit them. On entering one of the houses, he
+found it crowded with men, women, and children,
+who immediately provided a mat for him to sit on; and
+one of the party undertook to prepare something to
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_149" id="Page_149">[Pg 149]</a></span>eat. He began by bringing in a piece of pine-wood
+that had drifted down the river, which he split into
+small pieces with a wedge made of the elk's horn,
+by means of a mallet of stone curiously carved. The
+pieces were then laid on the fire, and several round
+stones placed upon them. One of the squaws now
+brought a bucket of water, in which was a large
+salmon about half dried; and, as the stones became
+heated, they were put into the bucket till the salmon
+was sufficiently boiled. It was then taken out, put
+on a platter of rushes neatly made, and laid before
+Capt. Clarke. Another was boiled for each of his
+men. Capt. Clarke found the fish excellent.</p>
+
+<p>At another island, four miles distant, the inhabitants
+were occupied in splitting and drying salmon.
+The multitudes of this fish are almost inconceivable.
+The water is so clear, that they can readily be seen at
+the depth of fifteen or twenty feet; but at this season
+they float in such quantities down the stream,
+and are drifted ashore, that the Indians have nothing
+to do but collect, split, and dry them. The Indians
+assured him by signs that they often used dry fish as
+fuel for the common occasions of cooking. The evening
+coming on, he returned to camp.</p>
+
+<p>Capt. Clarke, in the course of his excursion, shot
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_150" id="Page_150">[Pg 150]</a></span>several grouse and ducks; also a prairie-cock,&mdash;a
+bird of the pheasant kind, about the size of a small
+turkey. It measured, from the beak to the end of
+the toe, two feet six inches; from the extremity of the
+wings, three feet six inches; and the feathers of the
+tail were thirteen inches long. This bird we have
+seen nowhere except upon this river. Its chief
+food is the grasshopper, and the seeds of wild plants
+peculiar to this river and the Upper Missouri.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">ADVENTURE OF CAPT. CLARKE.</p>
+
+<p>Oct. 19.&mdash;Having resumed their descent of the
+Columbia, they came to a very dangerous rapid. In
+order to lighten the boats, Capt. Clarke landed, and
+walked to the foot of the rapid. Arriving there before
+either of the boats, except a canoe, he sat down
+on a rock to wait for them; and, seeing a crane fly
+across the river, shot it, and it fell near him. Several
+Indians had been, before this, passing on the opposite
+side; and some of them, alarmed at his appearance
+or the report of the gun, fled to their houses. Capt.
+Clarke was afraid that these people might not have
+heard that white men were coming: therefore, in
+order to allay their uneasiness before the whole
+party should arrive, he got into the canoe with three
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_151" id="Page_151">[Pg 151]</a></span>men, and rowed over towards the houses, and, while
+crossing, shot a duck, which fell into the water. As
+he approached, no person was to be seen, except
+three men; and they also fled as he came near the
+shore. He landed before five houses close to each
+other; but no person appeared: and the doors, which
+were of mat, were closed. He went towards one of
+them with a pipe in his hand, and, pushing aside the
+mat, entered the lodge, where he found thirty-two
+persons, men and women, with a few children, all in
+the greatest consternation; some hanging down their
+heads; others crying, and wringing their hands. He
+went up to them all, and shook hands with them
+in the most friendly manner. Their apprehensions
+gradually subsided, but revived on his taking out a
+burning-glass (there being no roof to the lodge), and
+lighting his pipe. Having at length restored some
+confidence by the gift of some small presents, he visited
+some other houses, where he found the inhabitants
+similarly affected. Confidence was not completely
+attained until the boats arrived, and then the
+two chiefs who accompanied the party explained
+the friendly intentions of the expedition. The sight
+of Chaboneau's wife also dissipated any remaining
+doubts, as it is not the practice among the Indians to
+allow women to accompany a war-party.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_152" id="Page_152">[Pg 152]</a></span>To account for their fears, they told the two chiefs
+that they had seen the white men fall from the sky.
+Having heard the report of Capt. Clarke's rifle, and
+seen the birds fall, and not having seen him till after
+the shot, they fancied that he had himself dropped
+from the clouds.</p>
+
+<p>This belief was strengthened, when, on entering the
+lodge, he brought down fire from heaven by means of
+his burning-glass. We soon convinced them that we
+were only mortals; and, after one of our chiefs had
+explained our history and objects, we all smoked
+together in great harmony.</p>
+
+<p>Our encampment that night was on the river-bank
+opposite an island, on which were twenty-four houses
+of Indians, all of whom were engaged in drying fish.
+We had scarcely landed when about a hundred of
+them came over to visit us, bringing with them a
+present of some wood, which was very acceptable.
+We received them in as kind a manner as we could,
+smoked with them, and gave the principal chief a
+string of wampum; but the highest satisfaction they
+enjoyed was in the music of our two violins, with
+which they seemed much delighted. They remained
+all night at our fires.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_153" id="Page_153">[Pg 153]</a></span>AN INDIAN BURYING-PLACE.</p>
+
+<p>We walked to the head of the island for the purpose
+of examining a vault, or burying-place, which
+we had remarked in coming along. The place in
+which the dead are deposited is a building about
+sixty feet long and twelve feet wide, formed by
+placing in the ground poles, or forks, six feet high,
+across which a long pole is extended the whole
+length of the structure. Against this ridge-pole are
+placed broad boards, and pieces of wood, in a slanting
+direction, so as to form a shed. The structure
+stands east and west, open at both ends. On entering
+the western end, we observed a number of bodies
+wrapped carefully in leather robes, and arranged in
+rows on boards, which were then covered with a mat.
+This part of the building was destined for those who
+had recently died. A little farther on, limbs, half
+decayed, were scattered about; and in the centre of
+the building was a large pile of them heaped promiscuously.
+At the eastern extremity was a mat, on
+which twenty-one skulls were arranged in a circular
+form: the mode of interment being first to wrap the
+body in robes; and, as it decays, the bones are thrown
+into the heap, and the skulls placed together in order.
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_154" id="Page_154">[Pg 154]</a></span>From the different boards and pieces of wood which
+form the vault were suspended on the inside fishing-nets,
+baskets, wooden bowls, robes, skins, trenchers,
+and trinkets of various kinds, intended as offerings
+of affection to deceased relatives. On the outside of
+the vault were the skeletons of several horses, and
+great quantities of bones in the neighborhood, which
+induced us to believe that these animals were sacrificed
+at the funeral-rites of their masters.</p>
+
+<p>In other parts of the route, the travellers found a
+different species of cemetery. The dead were placed
+in canoes, and these canoes were raised above the
+ground by a scaffolding of poles. The motive was
+supposed to be to protect them from wild beasts.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">FALLS OF THE COLUMBIA.</p>
+
+<p>About a hundred and fifty miles below the junction
+of Lewis's River, we reached the Great Falls. At the
+commencement of the pitch, which includes the falls,
+we landed, and walked down to examine them, and
+ascertain on which side we could make a portage
+most easily. From the lower end of the island, where
+the rapids begin, to the perpendicular fall, is about
+two miles. Here the river contracts, when the water
+is low, to a very narrow space; and, with only a short
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_155" id="Page_155">[Pg 155]</a></span>distance of swift water, it makes its plunge twenty
+feet perpendicularly; after which it rushes on, among
+volcanic rocks, through a channel four miles in length,
+and then spreads out into a gentle, broad current.</p>
+
+<p>We will interrupt the narrative here to introduce
+from later travellers some pictures of the remarkable
+region to which our explorers had now arrived. It
+was not to be expected that Capts. Lewis and Clarke
+should have taxed themselves, in their anxious and
+troubled march, to describe natural wonders, however
+striking.</p>
+
+<p>Lieut. Fr&eacute;mont thus describes this remarkable
+spot:&mdash;</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p><span class="smcap">The Dalles.</span>&mdash;"In a few miles we descended to the river,
+which we reached at one of its highly interesting features, known
+as the Dalles of the Columbia. The whole volume of the river
+at this place passes between the walls of a chasm, which has the
+appearance of having been rent through the basaltic strata which
+form the valley-rock of the region. At the narrowest place, we
+found the breadth, by measurement, fifty-eight yards, and the
+average height of the walls above the water twenty-five feet,
+forming a trough between the rocks; whence the name, probably
+applied by a Canadian voyageur."</p></div>
+
+<p>The same scene is described by Theodore Winthrop
+in his "Canoe and Saddle:"&mdash;</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>"The Dalles of the Columbia, upon which I was now looking,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_156" id="Page_156">[Pg 156]</a></span>must be studied by the American Dante, whenever he comes, for
+imagery to construct his Purgatory, if not his Inferno. At
+Walla-walla, two great rivers, Clarke's and Lewis's, drainers of
+the continent north and south, unite to form the Columbia. It
+flows furiously for a hundred and twenty miles westward.
+When it reaches the dreary region where the outlying ridges
+of the Cascade chain commence, it finds a great, low surface,
+paved with enormous polished sheets of basaltic rock. These
+plates, in French, <i>dalles</i>, give the spot its name. The great
+river, a mile wide not far above, finds but a narrow rift in this
+pavement for its passage. The rift gradually draws its sides
+closer, and, at the spot now called the Dalles, subdivides into
+three mere slits in the sharp-edged rock. At the highest water,
+there are other minor channels; but generally this continental
+flood is cribbed and compressed within its three chasms suddenly
+opening in the level floor, each chasm hardly wider than
+a leap a hunted fiend might take."</p></div>
+
+<p>It is not easy to picture to one's self, from these
+descriptions, the peculiar scenery of the Dalles. Fr&eacute;mont
+understands the name as signifying a <i>trough</i>;
+while Winthrop interprets it as <i>plates</i>, or <i>slabs</i>, of
+rock. The following description by Lieut. (now Gen.)
+Henry L. Abbot, in his "Report of Explorations for
+a Railroad Route," &amp;c., will show that the term, in
+each of its meanings, is applicable to different parts
+of the channel:&mdash;</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>"At the Dalles of the Columbia, the river rushes through a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_157" id="Page_157">[Pg 157]</a></span>chasm only about two hundred feet wide, with vertical, basaltic
+sides, rising from twenty to thirty feet above the water. Steep
+hills closely border the chasm, leaving in some places scarcely
+room on the terrace to pass on horseback. The water rushes
+through this basaltic trough with such violence, that it is always
+dangerous, and in some stages of the water impossible, for a boat
+to pass down. The contraction of the river-bed extends for
+about three miles. Near the lower end of it, the channel divides
+into several sluices, and then gradually becomes broader,
+until, where it makes a great bend to the south, it is over a
+quarter of a mile in width."</p></div>
+
+<p>After this interruption, the journal is resumed:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"We soon discovered that the nearest route was on
+the right side, and therefore dropped down to the
+head of the rapid, unloaded the canoes, and took all
+the baggage over by land to the foot of the rapid.
+The distance is twelve hundred yards, part of it over
+loose sands, disagreeable to pass. The labor of crossing
+was lightened by the Indians, who carried some
+of the heavy articles for us on their horses. Having
+ascertained the best mode of bringing down the canoes,
+the operation was conducted by Capt. Clarke,
+by hauling the canoes over a point of land four hundred
+and fifty-seven yards to the water. One mile
+farther down, we reached a pitch of the river, which,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_158" id="Page_158">[Pg 158]</a></span>being divided by two large rocks, descends with great
+rapidity over a fall eight feet in height. As the boats
+could not be navigated down this steep descent, we
+were obliged to land, and let them down as gently as
+possible by strong ropes of elk-skin, which we had
+prepared for the purpose. They all passed in safety,
+except one, which, being loosed by the breaking of
+the ropes, was driven down, but was recovered by the
+Indians below."</p>
+
+<p>Our travellers had now reached what have since
+been called the Cascade Mountains; and we must
+interrupt their narrative to give some notices of this
+remarkable scenery from later explorers. We quote
+from Abbot's Report:&mdash;</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>"There is great similarity in the general topographical features
+of the whole Pacific slope. The Sierra Nevada in California,
+and the Cascade range in Oregon, form a continuous
+wall of mountains nearly parallel to the coast, and from one
+hundred to two hundred miles distant from it. The main crest
+of this range is rarely elevated less than six thousand feet above
+the level of the sea, and many of its peaks tower into the region
+of eternal snow."</p></div>
+
+<p>Lieut. Abbot thus describes a view of these peaks
+and of the Columbia River:&mdash;</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>"At an elevation of five thousand feet above the sea, we
+stood upon the summit of the pass. For days we had been
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_159" id="Page_159">[Pg 159]</a></span>struggling blindly through dense forests; but now the surrounding
+country lay spread out before us for more than a hundred
+miles. The five grand snow-peaks, Mount St. Helens, Mount
+Ranier, Mount Adams, Mount Hood, and Mount Jefferson, rose
+majestically above a rolling sea of dark fir-covered ridges, some
+of which the approaching winter had already begun to mark
+with white. On every side, as far as the eye could reach, terrific
+convulsions of Nature had recorded their fury; and not
+even a thread of blue smoke from the camp-fire of a wandering
+savage disturbed the solitude of the scene."</p>
+
+<p><span class="smcap">The Columbia River</span>.&mdash;"The Columbia River forces its
+way through the Cascade range by a pass, which, for wild and
+sublime natural scenery, equals the celebrated passage of the
+Hudson through the Highlands. For a distance of about fifty
+miles, mountains covered with clinging spruces, firs, and pines,
+where not too precipitous to afford even these a foothold, rise
+abruptly from the water's edge to heights varying from one
+thousand to three thousand feet. Vertical precipices of columnar
+basalt are occasionally seen, rising from fifty to a hundred
+feet above the river level. In other places, the long mountain-walls
+of the river are divided by lateral ca&ntilde;ons (pronounced
+<i>canyons</i>), containing small tributaries, and occasionally little
+open spots of good land, liable to be overflowed at high water."</p></div>
+
+<p><span class="smcap">Ca&ntilde;ons</span>.&mdash;The plains east of the Cascade Mountains,
+through the whole extent of Oregon and California,
+are covered with a volcanic deposit composed
+of trap, basalt, and other rocks of the same class.
+This deposit is cleft by chasms often more than a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_160" id="Page_160">[Pg 160]</a></span>thousand feet deep, at the bottom of which there
+usually flows a stream of clear, cold water. This is
+sometimes the only water to be procured for the distance
+of many miles; and the traveller may be perishing
+with thirst while he sees far below him a
+sparkling stream, from which he is separated by precipices
+of enormous height and perpendicular descent.
+To chasms of this nature the name of <i>ca&ntilde;ons</i>
+has been applied, borrowed from the Spaniards of
+Mexico. We quote Lieut. Abbot's description of the
+ca&ntilde;on of Des Chutes River, a tributary of the Columbia:&mdash;</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>"Sept. 30.&mdash;As it was highly desirable to determine accurately
+the position and character of the ca&ntilde;on of Des Chutes
+River, I started this morning with one man to follow down the
+creek to its mouth, leaving the rest of the party in camp. Having
+yesterday experienced the inconveniences of travelling in
+the bottom of a ca&ntilde;on, I concluded to try to-day the northern
+bluff. It was a dry, barren plain, gravelly, and sometimes
+sandy, with a few bunches of grass scattered here and there.
+Tracks of antelopes or deer were numerous. After crossing
+one small ravine, and riding about five miles from camp, we
+found ourselves on the edge of the vast ca&ntilde;on of the river,
+which, far below us, was rushing through a narrow trough of
+basalt, resembling the Dalles of the Columbia. We estimated
+the depth of the ca&ntilde;on at a thousand feet. On each side, the
+precipices were very steep, and marked in many places by horizontal
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_161" id="Page_161">[Pg 161]</a></span>lines of vertical, basaltic columns, fifty or sixty feet in
+height. The man who was with me rolled a large rock, shaped
+like a grindstone, and weighing about two hundred pounds,
+from the summit. It thundered down for at least a quarter of a
+mile,&mdash;now over a vertical precipice, now over a steep mass of
+detritus, until at length it plunged into the river with a hollow
+roar, which echoed and re-echoed through the gorge for miles.
+By ascending a slight hill, I obtained a fine view of the surrounding
+country. The generally level character of the great
+basaltic table-land around us was very manifest from this point.
+Bounded on the west by the Cascade Mountains, the plain
+extends far towards the south,&mdash;a sterile, treeless waste."</p>
+
+<p><span class="smcap">The Cascades</span>.&mdash;"About forty miles below the Dalles, all
+navigation is suspended by a series of rapids called the Cascades.
+The wild grandeur of this place surpasses description.
+The river rushes furiously over a narrow bed filled with bowlders,
+and bordered by mountains which echo back the roar of
+the waters. The descent at the principal rapids is thirty-four
+feet; and the total fall at the Cascades, sixty-one feet. Salmon
+pass up the river in great numbers; and the Cascades, at certain
+seasons of the year, are a favorite fishing resort with the
+Indians, who build slight stagings over the water's edge, and
+spear the fish, or catch them in rude dip-nets, as they slowly
+force their way up against the current."</p></div>
+
+<p>We now return to our travellers.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">INDIAN MODE OF PACKING SALMON.</p>
+
+<p>Near our camp are five large huts of Indians engaged
+in drying fish, and preparing it for market.
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_162" id="Page_162">[Pg 162]</a></span>The manner of doing this is by first opening the fish,
+and exposing it to the sun on scaffolds. When it is
+sufficiently dried, it is pounded between two stones
+till it is pulverized, and is then placed in a basket,
+about two feet long and one in diameter, neatly made
+of grass and rushes, and lined with the skin of the
+salmon, stretched and dried for the purpose. Here
+they are pressed down as hard as possible, and the
+top covered with skins of fish, which are secured by
+cords through the holes of the basket. These baskets
+are then placed in some dry situation, the corded part
+upwards; seven being usually placed as close as they
+can be together, and five on the top of them. The
+whole is then wrapped up in mats, and made fast by
+cords. Twelve of these baskets, each of which contains
+from ninety to a hundred pounds, form a stack,
+which is now left exposed till it is sent to market.
+The fish thus preserved are kept sound and sweet for
+several years; and great quantities of it, they inform
+us, are sent to the Indians who live lower down the
+river, whence it finds its way to the whites who visit
+the mouth of the Columbia. We observe, both near
+the lodges and on the rocks in the river, great numbers
+of stacks of these pounded fish.</p>
+
+<p>Beside the salmon, there are great quantities of
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_163" id="Page_163">[Pg 163]</a></span>salmon-trout, and another smaller species of trout,
+which they save in another way. A hole of any size
+being dug, the sides and bottom are lined with straw,
+over which skins are laid. On these the fish, after
+being well dried, is laid, covered with other skins,
+and the hole closed with a layer of earth, twelve or
+fifteen inches deep. These supplies are for their
+winter food.</p>
+
+<p>The stock of fish, dried and pounded, was so abundant,
+that Capt. Clarke counted one hundred and
+seven stacks of them, making more than ten thousand
+pounds.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE INDIAN BOATMEN.</p>
+
+<p>The canoes used by these people are built of white
+cedar or pine, very light, wide in the middle, and
+tapering towards the ends; the bow being raised,
+and ornamented with carvings of the heads of animals.
+As the canoe is the vehicle of transportation,
+the Indians have acquired great dexterity in the
+management of it, and guide it safely over the
+roughest waves.</p>
+
+<p>We had an opportunity to-day of seeing the boldness
+of the Indians. One of our men shot a goose,
+which fell into the river, and was floating rapidly
+towards the great shoot, when an Indian, observing
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_164" id="Page_164">[Pg 164]</a></span>it, plunged in after it. The whole mass of the waters
+of the Columbia, just preparing to descend its narrow
+channel, carried the bird down with great rapidity.
+The Indian followed it fearlessly to within a hundred
+and fifty feet of the rocks, where, had he arrived, he
+would inevitably have been dashed to pieces; but,
+seizing his prey, he turned round, and swam ashore
+with great composure. We very willingly relinquished
+our right to the bird in favor of the Indian,
+who had thus secured it at the hazard of his life.
+He immediately set to work, and picked off about
+half the feathers, and then, without opening it, ran a
+stick through it, and carried it off to roast.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">INDIAN HOUSES.</p>
+
+<p>While the canoes were coming on, impeded by the
+difficulties of the navigation, Capt. Clarke, with two
+men, walked down the river-shore, and came to a
+village belonging to a tribe called Echeloots. The village
+consisted of twenty-one houses, scattered promiscuously
+over an elevated position. The houses
+were nearly equal in size, and of similar construction.
+A large hole, twenty feet wide and thirty in length,
+is dug to the depth of six feet. The sides are lined
+with split pieces of timber in an erect position, rising
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_165" id="Page_165">[Pg 165]</a></span>a short distance above the surface of the ground.
+These timbers are secured in their position by a
+pole, stretched along the side of the building, near
+the eaves, supported by a post at each corner. The
+timbers at the gable-ends rise higher, the middle
+pieces being the tallest. Supported by these, there
+is a ridge-pole running the whole length of the house,
+forming the top of the roof. From this ridge-pole to
+the eaves of the house are placed a number of small
+poles, or rafters, secured at each end by fibres of the
+cedar. On these poles is laid a covering of white
+cedar or arbor-vit&aelig;, kept on by strands of cedar-fibres.
+A small distance along the whole length of the ridge-pole
+is left uncovered for the admission of light, and
+to permit the smoke to escape. The entrance is by a
+small door at the gable-end, thirty inches high, and
+fourteen broad. Before this hole is hung a mat; and
+on pushing it aside, and crawling through, the descent
+is by a wooden ladder, made in the form of
+those used among us.</p>
+
+<p>One-half of the inside is used as a place of deposit
+for their dried fish, and baskets of berries: the other
+half, nearest the door, remains for the accommodation
+of the family. On each side are arranged, near the
+walls, beds of mats, placed on platforms or bedsteads,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_166" id="Page_166">[Pg 166]</a></span>raised about two feet from the ground. In the middle
+of the vacant space is the fire, or sometimes two
+or three fires, when, as is usually the case, the house
+contains several families.</p>
+
+<p>The inhabitants received us with great kindness,
+and invited us to their houses. On entering one of
+them, we saw figures of men, birds, and different animals,
+cut and painted on the boards which form the
+sides of the room, the figures uncouth, and the workmanship
+rough; but doubtless they were as much
+esteemed by the Indians as our finest domestic adornments
+are by us. The chief had several articles, such
+as scarlet and blue cloth, a sword, a jacket, and hat,
+which must have been procured from the whites.
+On one side of the room were two wide split boards,
+placed together so as to make space for a rude figure
+of a man, cut and painted on them. On pointing to
+this, and asking what it meant, he said something,
+of which all we understood was "good," and then
+stepped to the image, and brought out his bow and
+quiver, which, with some other warlike implements,
+were kept behind it. The chief then directed his
+wife to hand him his <i>Medicine-bag</i>, from which he
+brought out fourteen fore-fingers, which he told us
+had once belonged to the same number of his <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_167" id="Page_167">[Pg 167]</a></span>enemies.
+They were shown with great exultation; and
+after an harangue, which we were left to presume
+was in praise of his exploits, the fingers were carefully
+replaced among the valuable contents of the red
+Medicine-bag. This bag is an object of religious regard,
+and it is a species of sacrilege for any one but
+its owner to touch it.</p>
+
+<p>In all the houses are images of men, of different
+shapes, and placed as ornaments in the parts of the
+house where they are most likely to be seen.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">A SUBMERGED FOREST.</p>
+
+<p>Oct. 30.&mdash;The river is now about three-quarters of
+a mile wide, with a current so gentle, that it does not
+exceed a mile and a half an hour; but its course is
+obstructed by large rocks, which seem to have fallen
+from the mountains. What is, however, most singular,
+is, that there are stumps of pine-trees scattered
+to some distance in the river, which has the appearance
+of having been dammed below, and forced to
+encroach on the shore.</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>NOTE. Rev. S. Parker says, "We noticed a remarkable phenomenon,&mdash;trees
+standing in their natural position in the river,
+where the water is twenty feet deep. In many places, they
+were so numerous, that we had to pick our way with our canoe
+as through a forest. The water is so clear, that I had an opportunity
+of examining their position down to their spreading roots,
+and found them in the same condition as when standing in their
+native forest. It is evident that there has been an uncommon
+subsidence of a tract of land, more than twenty miles in length,
+and more than a mile in width. That the trees are not wholly
+decayed down to low-water mark, proves that the subsidence is
+comparatively of recent date; and their undisturbed natural
+position proves that it took place in a tranquil manner, not by
+any tremendous convulsion of Nature."</p></div>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_168" id="Page_168">[Pg 168]</a></span>THE RIVER WIDENS.&mdash;THEY MEET THE TIDE.</p>
+
+<p>Nov. 2, 1805.&mdash;Longitude about 122&deg;. At this
+point the first tidewater commences, and the river
+widens to nearly a mile in extent. The low grounds,
+too, become wider; and they, as well as the mountains
+on each side, are covered with pine, spruce,
+cotton-wood, a species of ash, and some alder. After
+being so long accustomed to the dreary nakedness of
+the country above, the change is as grateful to the
+eye as it is useful in supplying us with fuel.</p>
+
+<p>The ponds in the low grounds on each side of the
+river are resorted to by vast quantities of fowls, such
+as swans, geese, brants, cranes, storks, white gulls,
+cormorants, and plover. The river is wide, and <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_169" id="Page_169">[Pg 169]</a></span>contains
+a great number of sea-otters. In the evening,
+the hunters brought in game for a sumptuous supper,
+which we shared with the Indians, great numbers of
+whom spent the night with us. During the night,
+the tide rose eighteen inches near our camp.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">A LARGE VILLAGE.&mdash;COLUMBIA VALLEY.</p>
+
+<p>Nov. 4.&mdash;Next day, we landed on the left bank of
+the river, at a village of twenty-five houses. All of
+these were thatched with straw, and built of bark,
+except one, which was about fifty feet long, built of
+boards, in the form of those higher up the river; from
+which it differed, however, in being completely above
+ground, and covered with broad split boards. This
+village contains about two hundred men of the Skilloot
+nation, who seem well provided with canoes, of
+which there were fifty-two (some of them very large)
+drawn up in front of the village.</p>
+
+<p>On landing, we found an Indian from up the river,
+who had been with us some days ago, and now invited
+us into a house, of which he appeared to own a
+part. Here he treated us with a root, round in shape,
+about the size of a small Irish potato, which they call
+<i>wappatoo</i>. It is the common arrowhead, or <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_170" id="Page_170">[Pg 170]</a></span>sagittifolia,
+so much esteemed by the Chinese, and, when
+roasted in the embers till it becomes soft, has an
+agreeable taste, and is a very good substitute for
+bread.</p>
+
+<p>Here the ridge of low mountains running north-west
+and south-east crosses the river, and forms the
+western boundary of the plain through which we
+have just passed.<a name="FNanchor_3_3" id="FNanchor_3_3"></a><a href="#Footnote_3_3" class="fnanchor">[3]</a> This great plain, or valley, is
+about sixty miles wide in a straight line; while on
+the right and left it extends to a great distance. It
+is a fertile and delightful country, shaded by thick
+groves of tall timber, watered by small ponds, and
+lying on both sides of the river. The soil is rich,
+and capable of any species of culture; but, in the
+present condition of the Indians, its chief production
+is the wappatoo-root, which grows spontaneously and
+exclusively in this region. Sheltered as it is on both
+sides, the temperature is much milder than that of
+the surrounding country. Through its whole extent,
+it is inhabited by numerous tribes of Indians, who
+either reside in it permanently, or visit its waters
+in quest of fish and wappatoo-roots. We gave it the
+name of the Columbia Valley.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_171" id="Page_171">[Pg 171]</a></span>COFFIN ROCK.</p>
+
+<p>Among some interesting islands of basalt, there is
+one called Coffin Rock, situated in the middle of the
+river, rising ten or fifteen feet above high-freshet
+water. It is almost entirely covered with canoes, in
+which the dead are deposited, which gives it its
+name. In the section of country from Wappatoo
+Island to the Pacific Ocean, the Indians, instead of
+committing their dead to the earth, deposit them in
+canoes; and these are placed in such situations as are
+most secure from beasts of prey, upon such precipices
+as this island, upon branches of trees, or upon scaffolds
+made for the purpose. The bodies of the dead
+are covered with mats, and split planks are placed
+over them. The head of the canoe is a little raised,
+and at the foot there is a hole made for water to
+escape.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THEY REACH THE OCEAN.</p>
+
+<p>Next day we passed the mouth of a large river, a
+hundred and fifty yards wide, called by the Indians
+Cowalitz. A beautiful, extensive plain now presented
+itself; but, at the distance of a few miles, the hills
+again closed in upon the river, so that we could not
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_172" id="Page_172">[Pg 172]</a></span>for several miles find a place sufficiently level to fix
+our camp upon for the night.</p>
+
+<p>Thursday, Nov. 7.&mdash;The morning was rainy, and the
+fog so thick, that we could not see across the river.
+We proceeded down the river, with an Indian for our
+pilot, till, after making about twenty miles, the fog
+cleared off, and we enjoyed the delightful prospect
+of the <span class="smcap">Ocean</span>, the object of all our labors, the reward
+of all our endurance. This cheering view exhilarated
+the spirits of all the party, who listened with delight
+to the distant roar of the breakers.</p>
+
+<p>For ten days after our arrival at the coast, we were
+harassed by almost incessant rain. On the 12th, a
+violent gale of wind arose, accompanied with thunder,
+lightning, and hail. The waves were driven with
+fury against the rocks and trees, which had till then
+afforded us a partial defence. Cold and wet; our
+clothes and bedding rotten as well as wet; the canoes,
+our only means of escape from the place, at the
+mercy of the waves,&mdash;we were, however, fortunate
+enough to enjoy good health.</p>
+
+<p>Saturday, Nov. 16.&mdash;The morning was clear and
+beautiful. We put out our baggage to dry, and sent
+several of the party to hunt. The camp was in full
+view of the ocean. The wind was strong from the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_173" id="Page_173">[Pg 173]</a></span>south-west, and the waves very high; yet the Indians
+were passing up and down the bay in canoes, and
+several of them encamped near us. The hunters
+brought in two deer, a crane, some geese and ducks,
+and several brant. The tide rises at this place eight
+feet six inches, and rolls over the beach in great
+waves.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">AN EXCURSION DOWN THE BAY.</p>
+
+<p>Capt. Clarke started on Monday, 18th November, on
+an excursion by land down the bay, accompanied by
+eleven men. The country is low, open, and marshy,
+partially covered with high pine and a thick undergrowth.
+At the distance of about fifteen miles they
+reached the cape, which forms the northern boundary
+of the river's mouth, called Cape Disappointment, so
+named by Capt. Meares, after a fruitless search for
+the river. It is an elevated circular knob, rising with
+a steep ascent a hundred and fifty feet or more above
+the water, covered with thick timber on the inner
+side, but open and grassy in the exposure next the
+sea. The opposite point of the bay is a very low
+ground, about ten miles distant, called, by Capt. Gray,
+Point Adams.</p>
+
+<p>The water for a great distance off the mouth of the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_174" id="Page_174">[Pg 174]</a></span>river appears very shallow; and within the mouth,
+nearest to Point Adams, there is a large sand-bar,
+almost covered at high tide. We could not ascertain
+the direction of the deepest channel; for the waves
+break with tremendous force across the bay.</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Parker speaks more fully of this peculiarity of
+the river:&mdash;</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>"A difficulty of such a nature as is not easily overcome
+exists in regard to the navigation of this river; which is, the
+sand-bar at its entrance. It is about five miles, across the bar,
+from Cape Disappointment out to sea. In no part of that distance
+is the water upon the bar over eight fathoms deep, and in
+one place only five, and the channel only about half a mile in
+width. So wide and open is the ocean, that there is always a
+heavy swell: and, when the wind is above a gentle breeze, there
+are breakers quite across the bar; so that there is no passing it,
+except when the wind and tide are both favorable. Outside the
+bar, there is no anchorage; and there have been instances, in
+the winter season, of ships lying off and on thirty days, waiting
+for an opportunity to pass: and a good pilot is always needed.
+High, and in most parts perpendicular, basaltic rocks line the
+shores."</p></div>
+
+<p>The following is Theodore Winthrop's description
+of the Columbia, taken from his "Canoe and Saddle:"&mdash;</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>"A wall of terrible breakers marks the mouth of the Columbia,&mdash;Achilles
+of rivers.</p>
+
+<p>"Other mighty streams may swim feebly away seaward, may
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_175" id="Page_175">[Pg 175]</a></span>sink into foul marshes, may trickle through the ditches of an
+oozy delta, may scatter among sand-bars the currents that once
+moved majestic and united; but to this heroic flood was destined
+a short life and a glorious one,&mdash;a life all one strong,
+victorious struggle, from the mountains to the sea. It has no
+infancy: two great branches collect its waters up and down
+the continent. They join, and the Columbia is born&mdash;to full
+manhood. It rushes forward jubilant through its magnificent
+chasm, and leaps to its death in the Pacific."</p></div>
+
+<h4>FOOTNOTE:</h4>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p class="noin"><a name="Footnote_3_3" id="Footnote_3_3"></a><a href="#FNanchor_3_3"><span class="label">[3]</span></a> Since called the Coast range.</p></div>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_176" id="Page_176">[Pg 176]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XIII.</h2>
+
+<h3>WINTER-QUARTERS.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>November, 1805.&mdash;Having now examined the
+coast, it becomes necessary to decide on the
+spot for our winter-quarters. We must rely chiefly
+for subsistence upon our arms, and be guided in the
+choice of our residence by the supply of game which
+any particular spot may offer. The Indians say that
+the country on the opposite side of the river is better
+supplied with elk,&mdash;an animal much larger, and more
+easily killed, than the deer, with flesh more nutritive,
+and a skin better fitted for clothing. The neighborhood
+of the sea is, moreover, recommended by the facility
+of supplying ourselves with salt, and the hope
+of meeting some of the trading-vessels, which are expected
+about three months hence, from which we
+may procure a fresh supply of trinkets for our journey
+homewards. These considerations induced us to
+determine on visiting the opposite side of the bay;
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_177" id="Page_177">[Pg 177]</a></span>and, if there was an appearance of plenty of game, to
+establish ourselves there for the winter.</p>
+
+<p>Monday, 25th November, we set out; but, as the
+wind was too high to suffer us to cross the river, we
+kept near the shore, watching for a favorable change.
+On leaving our camp, seven Clatsops in a canoe accompanied
+us, but, after going a few miles, left us,
+and steered straight across through immense, high
+waves, leaving us in admiration at the dexterity with
+which they threw aside each wave as it threatened to
+come over their canoe.</p>
+
+<p>Next day, with a more favorable wind, we began
+to cross the river. We passed between some low,
+marshy islands, and reached the south side of the Columbia,
+and landed at a village of nine large houses.
+Soon after we landed, three Indians came down from
+the village with wappatoo-roots, which we purchased
+with fish-hooks.</p>
+
+<p>We proceeded along the shore till we came to a
+remarkable knob of land projecting about a mile and
+a half into the bay, about four miles round, while the
+neck of land which unites it to the main is not more
+than fifty yards across. We went round this projection,
+which we named Point William; but the waves
+then became so high, that we could not venture any
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_178" id="Page_178">[Pg 178]</a></span>farther, and therefore landed on a beautiful shore of
+pebbles of various colors, and encamped near an old
+Indian hut on the isthmus.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">DISCOMFORTS.</p>
+
+<p>Nov. 27.&mdash;It rained hard all next day, and the
+next, attended with a high wind from the south-west.
+It was impossible to proceed on so rough a sea. We
+therefore sent several men to hunt, and the rest of
+us remained during the day in a situation the most
+cheerless and uncomfortable. On this little neck of
+land, we are exposed, with a miserable covering
+which does not deserve the name of a shelter, to the
+violence of the winds. All our bedding and stores
+are completely wet, our clothes rotting with constant
+exposure, and no food except the dried fish brought
+from the falls, to which we are again reduced. The
+hunters all returned hungry, and drenched with rain;
+having seen neither deer nor elk, and the swans and
+brants too shy to be approached. At noon, the wind
+shifted to the north-west, and blew with such fury,
+that many trees were blown down near us. The gale
+lasted with short intervals during the whole night;
+but towards morning the wind lulled, though the rain
+continued, and the waves were still high.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_179" id="Page_179">[Pg 179]</a></span>30th.&mdash;The hunters met with no better success
+this day and the next, and the weather continued
+rainy. But on Monday, 2d December, one of the
+hunters killed an elk at the distance of six miles
+from the camp, and a canoe was sent to bring it.
+This was the first elk we had killed on the west side
+of the Rocky Mountains; and, condemned as we have
+been to the dried fish, it forms a most acceptable food.</p>
+
+<p>The rain continued, with brief interruptions, during
+the whole month of December. There were occasional
+falls of snow, but no frost or ice.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">WINTER-QUARTERS.</p>
+
+<p>Capt. Lewis returned from an excursion down the
+bay, having left two of his men to guard six elks and
+five deer which the party had shot. He had examined
+the coast, and found a river a short distance
+below, on which we might encamp for the winter,
+with a sufficiency of elk for our subsistence within
+reach. This information was very satisfactory, and
+we decided on going thither as soon as we could
+move from the point; but it rained all night and the
+following day.</p>
+
+<p>Saturday, 7th December, 1805, was fair. We therefore
+loaded our canoes, and proceeded: but the tide
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_180" id="Page_180">[Pg 180]</a></span>was against us, and the waves very high; so that we
+were obliged to proceed slowly and cautiously. We
+at length turned a point, and found ourselves in a
+deep bay. Here we landed for breakfast, and were
+joined by a party sent out three days ago to look for
+the six elk. After breakfast, we coasted round the
+bay, which is about four miles across, and receives
+two rivers. We called it Meriwether's Bay, from the
+Christian name of Capt. Lewis, who was, no doubt,
+the first white man who surveyed it. On reaching
+the south side of the bay, we ascended one of the
+rivers for three miles to the first point of highland, on
+its western bank, and formed our camp in a thick
+grove of lofty pines about two hundred yards from
+the water, and thirty feet above the level of the high
+tides.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE CLATSOPS AT HOME.</p>
+
+<p>Capt. Clarke started on an expedition to the seashore,
+to fix upon a place for the salt-works. He took
+six men with him; but three of them left in pursuit
+of a herd of elk. He met three Indians loaded with
+fresh salmon, which they had taken, and were returning
+to their village, whither they invited him to accompany
+them. He agreed; and they brought out a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_181" id="Page_181">[Pg 181]</a></span>canoe hid along the bank of a creek. Capt. Clarke
+and his party got on board, and in a short time were
+landed at the village, consisting of twelve houses,
+inhabited by twelve families of Clatsops. These
+houses were on the south exposure of a hill, and
+sunk about four feet deep into the ground; the walls,
+roof, and gable-ends being formed of split-pine boards;
+the descent through a small door down a ladder.
+There were two fires in the middle of the room, and
+the beds disposed round the walls, two or three feet
+from the floor, so as to leave room under them for
+their bags, baskets, and household articles. The floor
+was covered with mats.</p>
+
+<p>Capt. Clarke was received with much attention.
+As soon as he entered, clean mats were spread, and
+fish, berries, and roots set before him on small, neat
+platters of rushes. After he had eaten, the men of
+the other houses came and smoked with him. They
+appeared much neater in their persons than Indians
+generally are.</p>
+
+<p>Towards evening, it began to rain and blow violently;
+and Capt. Clarke therefore determined to
+remain during the night. When they thought his
+appetite had returned, an old woman presented him,
+in a bowl made of light-colored horn, a kind of sirup,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_182" id="Page_182">[Pg 182]</a></span>pleasant to the taste, made from a species of berry
+common in this country, about the size of a cherry,
+called by the Indians <i>shelwel</i>. Of these berries a
+bread is also prepared, which, being boiled with
+roots, forms a soup, which was served in neat
+wooden trenchers. This, with some cockles, was his
+repast.</p>
+
+<p>The men of the village now collected, and began to
+gamble. The most common game was one in which
+one of the company was banker, and played against
+all the rest. He had a piece of bone about the size
+of a large bean; and, having agreed with any one as
+to the value of the stake, he would pass the bone
+with great dexterity from one hand to the other,
+singing at the same time to divert the attention of
+his adversary. Then, holding up his closed hands,
+his antagonist was challenged to say in which of
+them the bone was, and lost or won as he pointed to
+the right or wrong hand.</p>
+
+<p>To this game of hazard they abandon themselves
+with great ardor. Sometimes every thing they possess
+is sacrificed to it; and this evening several of
+the Indians lost all the beads which they had with
+them.</p>
+
+<p>This lasted for three hours; when, Capt. Clarke <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_183" id="Page_183">[Pg 183]</a></span>appearing
+disposed to sleep, the man who had been
+most attentive, and whose name was Cuskalah, spread
+two new mats by the fire; and, ordering his wife to
+retire to her own bed, the rest of the company dispersed
+at the same time. Capt. Clarke then lay
+down, and slept as well as the fleas would permit
+him.</p>
+
+<p>Next morning was cloudy, with some rain. He
+walked on the seashore, and observed the Indians
+walking up and down, and examining the shore. He
+was at a loss to understand their object till one of
+them explained that they were in search of fish,
+which are thrown on shore by the tide; adding, in
+English, "Sturgeon is good." There is every reason
+to suppose that these Clatsops depend for their subsistence
+during the winter chiefly on the fish thus
+casually thrown on the coast.</p>
+
+<p>After amusing himself for some time on the beach,
+Capt. Clarke returned toward the village. One of
+the Indians asked him to shoot a duck which he
+pointed out. He did so; and, having accidentally
+shot off its head, the bird was brought to the village,
+and all the Indians came round in astonishment.
+They examined the duck, the musket, and the very
+small bullet (a hundred to the pound); and then <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_184" id="Page_184">[Pg 184]</a></span>exclaimed
+in their language, "Good musket: don't
+understand this kind of musket."</p>
+
+<p>They now placed before him their best roots, fish,
+and sirup; after which he bought some berry-bread
+and a few roots in exchange for fish-hooks, and then
+set out to return by the same route by which he
+came. He was accompanied by Cuskalah and his
+brother part of the way, and proceeded to the camp
+through a heavy rain. The party had been occupied
+during his absence in cutting down trees and in
+hunting.</p>
+
+<p>Next day, two of our hunters returned with the
+pleasing intelligence of their having killed eighteen
+elk about six miles off. Our huts begin to rise; for,
+though it rains all day, we continue our labors,
+and are glad to find that the beautiful balsam-pine
+splits into excellent boards more than two feet in
+width.</p>
+
+<p>Dec. 15.&mdash;Capt. Clarke, with sixteen men, set out
+in three canoes to get the elk which were killed.
+After landing as near the spot as possible, the men
+were despatched in small parties to bring in the
+game; each man returning with a quarter of an
+animal. It was accomplished with much labor and
+suffering; for the rain fell incessantly.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_185" id="Page_185">[Pg 185]</a></span>THE FORT COMPLETED.</p>
+
+<p>We now had the meat-house covered, and all our
+game carefully hung up in small pieces. Two days
+after, we covered in four huts. Five men were sent
+out to hunt, and five others despatched to the seaside,
+each with a large kettle, in order to begin the
+manufacture of salt. The rest of the men were employed
+in making pickets and gates for our fort.</p>
+
+<p>Dec. 31.&mdash;As if it were impossible to have twenty-four
+hours of pleasant weather, the sky last evening
+clouded up, and the rain began, and continued
+through the day. In the morning, there came down
+two canoes,&mdash;one from the Wahkiacum village; the
+other contained three men and a squaw of the Skilloot
+nation. They brought wappatoo and shanatac
+roots, dried fish, mats made of flags and rushes,
+dressed elk-skins, and tobacco, for which, particularly
+the skins, they asked an extravagant price. We
+purchased some wappatoo and a little tobacco, very
+much like that we had seen among the Shoshonees,
+put up in small, neat bags made of rushes. These
+we obtained in exchange for a few articles, among
+which fish-hooks are the most esteemed. One of the
+Skilloots brought a gun which wanted some repair;
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_186" id="Page_186">[Pg 186]</a></span>and, when we had put it in order, we received from
+him a present of about a peck of wappatoo. We then
+gave him a piece of sheepskin and blue cloth to
+cover the lock, and he very thankfully offered a further
+present of roots. There is an obvious superiority
+of these Skilloots over the Wahkiacums, who
+are intrusive, thievish, and impertinent. Our new
+regulations, however, and the appearance of the sentinel,
+have improved the behavior of all our Indian
+visitors. They left the fort before sunset, even without
+being ordered.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_187" id="Page_187">[Pg 187]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XIV.</h2>
+
+<h3>A NEW YEAR.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>We were awaked at an early hour by the discharge
+of a volley of small-arms to salute the
+new year. This is the only way of doing honor to
+the day which our situation admits; for our only
+dainties are boiled elk and wappatoo, enlivened by
+draughts of water.</p>
+
+<p>Next day, we were visited by the chief, Comowool,
+and six Clatsops. Besides roots and berries, they
+brought for sale three dogs. Having been so long
+accustomed to live on the flesh of dogs, the most of
+us have acquired a fondness for it; and any objection
+to it is overcome by reflecting, that, while we subsisted
+on that food, we were fatter, stronger, and in
+better health, than at any period since leaving the
+buffalo country, east of the mountains.</p>
+
+<p>The Indians also brought with them some whale's
+blubber, which they obtained, they told us, from their
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_188" id="Page_188">[Pg 188]</a></span>neighbors who live on the sea-coast, near one of
+whose villages a whale has recently been thrown and
+stranded. It was white, and not unlike the fat of
+pork, though of a more porous and spongy texture;
+and, on being cooked, was found to be tender and
+palatable, in flavor resembling the flesh of the beaver.</p>
+
+<p>Two of the five men who were despatched to make
+salt returned. They had formed an establishment
+about fifteen miles south-west of our fort, near some
+scattered houses of the Clatsops, where they erected
+a comfortable camp, and had killed a stock of provisions.
+They brought with them a gallon of the salt
+of their manufacture, which was white, fine, and very
+good. It proves to be a most agreeable addition to
+our food; and, as they can make three or four quarts
+a day, we have a prospect of a plentiful supply.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE WHALE.</p>
+
+<p>The appearance of the whale seemed to be a matter
+of importance to all the neighboring Indians; and in
+hopes that we might be able to procure some of it for
+ourselves, or at least purchase some from the Indians,
+a small parcel of merchandise was prepared, and a
+party of men got in readiness to set out in the morning.
+As soon as this resolution was known, <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_189" id="Page_189">[Pg 189]</a></span>Chaboneau
+and his wife requested that they might be permitted
+to accompany us. The poor woman urged
+very earnestly that she had travelled a great way
+with us to see the great water, yet she had never
+been down to the coast; and, now that this monstrous
+fish also was to be seen, it seemed hard that she
+should not be permitted to see either the ocean or
+the whale. So reasonable a request could not be
+denied: they were therefore suffered to accompany
+Capt. Clarke, who next day, after an early breakfast,
+set out with twelve men in two canoes.</p>
+
+<p>He proceeded down the river on which we are encamped
+into Meriwether Bay; from whence he passed
+up a creek three miles to some high, open land, where
+he found a road. He there left the canoes, and followed
+the path over deep marshes to a pond about a
+mile long. Here they saw a herd of elk; and the men
+were divided into small parties, and hunted them till
+after dark. Three of the elk were wounded; but
+night prevented our taking more than one, which
+was brought to the camp, and cooked with some
+sticks of pine which had drifted down the creeks.
+The weather was beautiful, the sky clear, and the
+moon shone brightly,&mdash;a circumstance the more
+agreeable, as this is the first fair evening we have
+enjoyed for two months.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_190" id="Page_190">[Pg 190]</a></span>Thursday, Jan. 2.&mdash;There was a frost this morning.
+We rose early, and taking eight pounds of
+flesh, which was all that remained of the elk, proceeded
+up the south fork of the creek. At the distance
+of two miles we found a pine-tree, which had
+been felled by one of our salt-makers, on which we
+crossed the deepest part of the creek, and waded
+through the rest. We then went over an open, ridgy
+prairie, three-quarters of a mile to the sea-beach; after
+following which for three miles, we came to the mouth
+of a beautiful river, with a bold, rapid current, eighty-five
+yards wide, and three feet deep in its shallowest
+crossings. On its north-east side are the remains of
+an old village of Clatsops, inhabited by only a single
+family, who appeared miserably poor and dirty. We
+gave the man two fish-hooks to ferry the party over
+the river, which, from the tribe on its banks, we called
+Clatsop River. The creek which we had passed on a
+tree approaches this river within about a hundred
+yards, and, by means of a portage, supplies a communication
+with the villages near Point Adams.</p>
+
+<p>After going on for two miles, we found the salt-makers
+encamped near four houses of Clatsops and
+Killimucks, who, though poor and dirty, seemed kind
+and well-disposed. We persuaded a young Indian, by
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_191" id="Page_191">[Pg 191]</a></span>the present of a file and a promise of some other articles,
+to guide us to the spot where the whale lay. He
+led us for two and a half miles over the round, slippery
+stones at the foot of a high hill projecting into
+the sea, and then, suddenly stopping, and uttering the
+word "peshack," or bad, explained by signs that we
+could no longer follow the coast, but must cross the
+mountain. This threatened to be a most laborious
+undertaking; for the side was nearly perpendicular,
+and the top lost in clouds. He, however, followed an
+Indian path, which wound along, and favored the ascent
+as much as possible; but it was so steep, that, at
+one place, we were forced to draw ourselves up for
+about a hundred feet by means of bushes and roots.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">CLARKE'S POINT OF VIEW.</p>
+
+<p>At length, after two hours' labor, we reached the
+top of the mountain, where we looked down with
+astonishment on the height of ten or twelve hundred
+feet which we had ascended. We were here met
+by fourteen Indians loaded with oil and blubber, the
+spoils of the whale, which they were carrying in
+very heavy burdens over this rough mountain. On
+leaving them, we proceeded over a bad road till
+night, when we encamped on a small run. We were
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_192" id="Page_192">[Pg 192]</a></span>all much fatigued: but the weather was pleasant; and,
+for the first time since our arrival here, an entire day
+has passed without rain.</p>
+
+<p>In the morning we set out early, and proceeded
+to the top of the mountain, the highest point of
+which is an open spot facing the ocean. It is situated
+about thirty miles south-east of Cape Disappointment,
+and projects nearly two and a half miles into the
+sea. Here one of the most delightful views imaginable
+presents itself. Immediately in front is the ocean,
+which breaks with fury on the coast, from the rocks
+of Cape Disappointment as far as the eye can discern
+to the north-west, and against the highlands and irregular
+piles of rock which diversify the shore to the
+south-east. To this boisterous scene, the Columbia,
+with its tributary waters, widening into bays as it
+approaches the ocean, and studded on both sides with
+the Chinook and Clatsop villages, forms a charming
+contrast; while immediately beneath our feet are
+stretched rich prairies, enlivened by three beautiful
+streams, which conduct the eye to small lakes at the
+foot of the hills. We stopped to enjoy the romantic
+view from this place, which we distinguished by the
+name of Clarke's Point of View, and then followed
+our guide down the mountain.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_193" id="Page_193">[Pg 193]</a></span>THE WHALE.</p>
+
+<p>The descent was steep and dangerous. In many
+places, the hillsides, which are formed principally of
+yellow clay, have been loosened by the late rains, and
+are slipping into the sea in large masses of fifty and
+a hundred acres. In other parts, the path crosses
+the rugged, perpendicular, basaltic rocks which overhang
+the sea, into which a false step would have precipitated
+us.</p>
+
+<p>The mountains are covered with a very thick
+growth of timber, chiefly pine and fir; some trees
+of which, perfectly sound and solid, rise to the height
+of two hundred and ten feet, and are from eight to
+twelve in diameter. Intermixed is the white cedar,
+or arbor-vit&aelig;, and some trees of black alder, two or
+three feet thick, and sixty or seventy in height. At
+length we reached the sea-level, and continued for
+two miles along the sand-beach, and soon after
+reached the place where the waves had thrown the
+whale on shore. The animal had been placed between
+two villages of Killimucks; and such had been
+their industry, that there now remained nothing but
+the skeleton, which we found to be a hundred and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_194" id="Page_194">[Pg 194]</a></span>five feet in length. Capt. Clarke named the place
+Ecola, or Whale Creek.</p>
+
+<p>The natives were busied in boiling the blubber in
+a large square trough of wood by means of heated
+stones, preserving the oil thus extracted in bladders
+and the entrails of the whale. The refuse pieces of
+the blubber, which still contained a portion of oil, were
+hung up in large flitches, and, when wanted for use,
+were warmed on a wooden spit before the fire, and
+eaten, either alone, or with roots of the rush and
+shanatac. The Indians, though they had great quantities,
+parted with it very reluctantly, at such high
+prices, that our whole stock of merchandise was exhausted
+in the purchase of about three hundred
+pounds of blubber and a few gallons of oil.</p>
+
+<p>Next morning was fine, the wind from the north-east;
+and, having divided our stock of the blubber,
+we began at sunrise to retrace our steps in order to
+reach our encampment, which we called Fort Clatsop,
+thirty-five miles distant, with as little delay as possible.
+We met several parties of Indians on their way
+to trade for blubber and oil with the Killimucks: we
+also overtook a party returning from the village, and
+could not but regard with astonishment the heavy
+loads which the women carry over these fatiguing
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_195" id="Page_195">[Pg 195]</a></span>and dangerous paths. As one of the women was
+descending a steep part of the mountain, her load
+slipped from her back; and she stood holding it by a
+strap with one hand, and with the other supporting
+herself by a bush. Capt. Clarke, being near her, undertook
+to replace the load, and found it almost as
+much as he could lift, and above one hundred pounds
+in weight. Loaded as they were, they kept pace with
+us till we reached the salt-makers' camp, where we
+passed the night, while they continued their route.</p>
+
+<p>Next day, we proceeded across Clatsop River to
+the place where we had left our canoes, and, as the
+tide was coming in, immediately embarked for the
+fort, at which place we arrived about ten o'clock at
+night.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">DREWYER, THE HUNTER.</p>
+
+<p>Jan. 12, 1806.&mdash;Two hunters had been despatched
+in the morning; and one of them, Drewyer, had, before
+evening, killed seven elks. We should scarcely be
+able to subsist, were it not for the exertions of this
+excellent hunter. The game is scarce; and none is
+now to be seen except elk, which, to almost all the
+men, are very difficult to be procured. But Drewyer,
+who is the offspring of a Canadian Frenchman and an
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_196" id="Page_196">[Pg 196]</a></span>Indian woman, has passed his life in the woods, and
+unites in a wonderful degree the dexterous aim of the
+frontier huntsman with the sagacity of the Indian in
+pursuing the faintest tracks through the forest. All
+our men have indeed become so expert with the rifle,
+that, when there is game of any kind, we are almost
+certain of procuring it.</p>
+
+<p>Monday, Jan. 13.&mdash;Capt. Lewis took all the men who
+could be spared, and brought in the seven elk, which
+they found untouched by the wolves. The last of the
+candles which we brought with us being exhausted,
+we now began to make others of elk-tallow. We also
+employed ourselves in jerking the meat of the elk.
+We have three of the canoes drawn up out of the
+reach of the water, and the other secured by a strong
+cord, so as to be ready for use if wanted.</p>
+
+<p>Jan. 16.&mdash;To-day we finished curing our meat;
+and having now a plentiful supply of elk and salt, and
+our houses dry and comfortable, we wait patiently for
+the moment of resuming our journey.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_197" id="Page_197">[Pg 197]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XV.</h2>
+
+<h3>WINTER LIFE.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>Jan. 18, 1806.&mdash;We are all occupied in dressing
+skins, and preparing clothes for our journey
+homewards. This morning, we sent out two parties
+of hunters in different directions. We were visited
+by three Clatsops, who came merely for the purpose
+of smoking and conversing with us.</p>
+
+<p>Jan. 21.&mdash;Two of the hunters came back with
+three elks, which form a timely addition to our stock
+of provision. The Indian visitors left us at twelve
+o'clock.</p>
+
+<p>The Clatsops and other nations have visited us
+with great freedom. Having acquired much of their
+language, we are enabled, with the assistance of gestures,
+to hold conversations with great ease. We
+find them inquisitive and loquacious; by no means
+deficient in acuteness. They are generally cheerful,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_198" id="Page_198">[Pg 198]</a></span>but seldom gay. Every thing they see excites their
+attention and inquiries.</p>
+
+<p>Their treatment of women and old men depends
+very much on the usefulness of these classes. Thus,
+among the Clatsops and Chinooks, who live upon
+fish and roots, which the women are equally expert
+with the men in procuring, the women have a rank
+and influence far greater than they have among the
+hunting tribes. On many subjects their judgments
+and opinions are respected; and, in matters of trade,
+their advice is generally asked and followed. So
+with the old men: when one is unable to pursue the
+chase, his counsels may compensate for his want of
+activity; but in the next state of infirmity, when he
+can no longer travel from camp to camp as the tribe
+roams about for subsistence, he is found to be a burden.
+In this condition they are abandoned among
+the Sioux and other hunting-tribes of the Missouri.
+As the tribe are setting out for some new excursion
+where the old man is unable to follow, his children or
+nearest relations place before him a piece of meat
+and some water; and telling him that he has lived
+long enough, that it is now time for him to go home
+to his relations, who can take better care of him than
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_199" id="Page_199">[Pg 199]</a></span>his friends on earth, they leave him without remorse
+to perish, when his little supply is exhausted.</p>
+
+<p>Though this is doubtless true as a general rule,
+yet, in the villages of the Minnetarees and Ricaras,
+we saw no want of kindness to old men: on the contrary,
+probably because in villages the more abundant
+means of subsistence renders such cruelty unnecessary,
+the old people appeared to be treated with attention;
+and some of their feasts, particularly the
+buffalo-dances, were intended chiefly as an occasion
+of contribution for the old and infirm.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">FLATHEAD INDIANS.</p>
+
+<p>The custom of flattening the head by artificial
+pressure during infancy prevails among all the nations
+we have seen west of the Rocky Mountains.
+To the east of that barrier the fashion is so perfectly
+unused, that they designate the western Indians, of
+whatever tribe, by the common name of Flatheads.
+The practice is universal among the Killimucks, Clatsops,
+Chinooks, and Cathlamahs,&mdash;the four nations
+with whom we have had most intercourse. Soon
+after the birth of her child, the mother places it in
+the compressing-frame, where it is kept for ten or
+twelve months. The operation is so gradual, that it
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_200" id="Page_200">[Pg 200]</a></span>is not attended with pain. The heads of the children,
+when they are released from the bandage, are not
+more than two inches thick about the upper edge
+of the forehead: nor, with all its efforts, can nature
+ever restore their shape; the heads of grown
+persons being often in a straight line from the tip of
+the nose to the top of the forehead.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">TEMPERANCE.&mdash;GAMBLING.</p>
+
+<p>Their houses usually contain several families, consisting
+of parents, sons and daughters, daughters-in-law
+and grand-children, among whom the provisions
+are in common, and harmony seldom interrupted.
+As these families gradually expand into tribes,
+or nations, the paternal authority is represented by
+the chief of each association. The chieftainship is
+not hereditary: the chief's ability to render service
+to his neighbors, and the popularity which follows it,
+is the foundation of his authority, which does not
+extend beyond the measure of his personal influence.</p>
+
+<p>The harmony of their private life is protected by
+their ignorance of spirituous liquors. Although the
+tribes near the coast have had so much intercourse
+with the whites, they do not appear to possess any
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_201" id="Page_201">[Pg 201]</a></span>knowledge of those dangerous luxuries; at least,
+they have never inquired of us for them. Indeed,
+we have not observed any liquor of an intoxicating
+quality used among any Indians west of the Rocky
+Mountains; the universal beverage being pure water.
+They, however, almost intoxicate themselves by smoking
+tobacco, of which they are excessively fond. But
+the common vice of all these people is an attachment
+to games of chance, which they pursue with a ruinous
+avidity. The game of the pebble has already
+been described. Another game is something like the
+play of ninepins. Two pins are placed on the floor,
+about the distance of a foot from each other, and a
+small hole made in the earth behind them. The players
+then go about ten feet from the hole, into which
+they try to roll a small piece resembling the men
+used at checkers. If they succeed in putting it into
+the hole, they win the stake. If the piece rolls between
+the pins, but does not go into the hole, nothing
+is won or lost; but the wager is lost if the checker
+rolls outside the pins. Entire days are wasted at
+these games, which are often continued through the
+night round the blaze of their fires, till the last
+article of clothing or the last blue bead is lost and
+won.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_202" id="Page_202">[Pg 202]</a></span>TREES.</p>
+
+<p>The whole neighborhood of the coast is supplied
+with great quantities of excellent timber. The predominant
+growth is the fir, of which we have seen
+several species. The first species grows to an immense
+size, and is very commonly twenty-seven feet
+in circumference, six feet above the earth's surface.
+They rise to the height of two hundred and thirty
+feet, and one hundred and twenty of that height
+without a limb. We have often found them thirty-six
+feet in circumference. One of our party measured
+one, and found it to be forty-two feet in circumference
+at a point beyond the reach of an ordinary
+man. This tree was perfectly sound; and, at a
+moderate calculation, its height may be estimated at
+three hundred feet.</p>
+
+<p>The second is a much more common species, and
+constitutes at least one-half of the timber in this
+neighborhood. It resembles the spruce, rising from
+one hundred and sixty to one hundred and eighty
+feet; and is from four to six feet in diameter, straight,
+round, and regularly tapering.</p>
+
+<p>The stem of the black alder arrives at a great size.
+It is sometimes found growing to the height of sixty
+or seventy feet, and is from two to four in diameter.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_203" id="Page_203">[Pg 203]</a></span>There is a tree, common on the Columbia River,
+much resembling the ash, and another resembling
+the white maple, though much smaller.</p>
+
+<p>The undergrowth consists of honeysuckle, alder,
+whortleberry, a plant like the mountain-holly, green
+brier, and fern.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">ANIMALS.</p>
+
+<p>The beaver of this country is large and fat: the
+flesh is very palatable, and, at our table, was a real
+luxury. On the 7th of January, our hunter found a
+beaver in his trap, of which he made a bait for taking
+others. This bait will entice the beaver to the trap
+as far as he can smell it; and this may be fairly stated
+to be at the distance of a mile, as their sense of
+smelling is very acute.</p>
+
+<p>The sea-otter resides only on the sea-coast or in
+the neighborhood of the salt water. When fully
+grown, he attains to the size of a large mastiff dog.
+The ears, which are not an inch in length, are thick,
+pointed, fleshy, and covered with short hair; the tail
+is ten inches long, thick at the point of insertion, and
+partially covered with a deep fur on the upper side;
+the legs are very short, covered with fur, and the
+feet with short hair. The body of this animal is
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_204" id="Page_204">[Pg 204]</a></span>long, and of the same thickness throughout. From
+the extremity of the tail to the nose, they measure
+five feet. The color is a uniform dark brown, and
+when in good condition, and in season, perfectly
+black. This animal is unrivalled for the beauty, richness,
+and softness of his fur. The inner part of the
+fur, when opened, is lighter than the surface in its
+natural position. There are some black and shining
+hairs intermixed with the fur, which are rather
+longer, and add much to its beauty.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">HORSES AND DOGS.</p>
+
+<p>The horse is confined chiefly to the nations inhabiting
+the great plains of the Columbia, extending
+from latitude forty to fifty north, and occupying the
+tract of country lying between the Rocky Mountains
+and a range of mountains which crosses the Columbia
+River about the great falls. In this region they
+are very numerous.</p>
+
+<p>They appear to be of an excellent race, lofty, well
+formed, active, and enduring. Many of them appear
+like fine English coursers. Some of them are pied,
+with large spots of white irregularly scattered, and
+intermixed with a dark-brown bay. The greater
+part, however, are of a uniform color, marked with
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_205" id="Page_205">[Pg 205]</a></span>stars, and white feet. The natives suffer them to run
+at large in the plains, the grass of which affords them
+their only winter subsistence; their masters taking
+no trouble to lay in a winter's store for them. They
+will, nevertheless, unless much exercised, fatten on
+the dry grass afforded by the plains during the winter.
+The plains are rarely moistened by rain, and the
+grass is consequently short and thin.</p>
+
+<p>Whether the horse was originally a native of this
+country or not, the soil and climate appear to be perfectly
+well adapted to his nature. Horses are said to
+be found wild in many parts of this country.</p>
+
+<p>The dog is small, about the size of an ordinary cur.
+He is usually party-colored; black, white, brown, and
+brindle being the colors most predominant. The
+head is long, the nose pointed, the eyes small, the
+ears erect and pointed like those of the wolf. The
+hair is short and smooth, excepting on the tail, where
+it is long and straight, like that of the ordinary cur-dog.
+The natives never eat the flesh of this animal,
+and he appears to be in no other way serviceable to
+them but in hunting the elk. To us, on the contrary,
+it has now become a favorite food; for it is found to
+be a strong, healthy diet, preferable to lean deer or
+elk, and much superior to horse-flesh in any state.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_206" id="Page_206">[Pg 206]</a></span>BURROWING SQUIRREL.</p>
+
+<p>There are several species of squirrels not different
+from those found in the Atlantic States. There is
+also a species of squirrel, evidently distinct, which
+we denominate the burrowing squirrel. He measures
+one foot five inches in length, of which the tail comprises
+two and a half inches only. The neck and
+legs are short; the ears are likewise short, obtusely
+pointed, and lie close to the head. The eyes are of a
+moderate size, the pupil black, and the iris of a dark,
+sooty brown. The teeth, and indeed the whole contour,
+resemble those of the squirrel.</p>
+
+<p>These animals associate in large companies, occupying
+with their burrows sometimes two hundred
+acres of land. The burrows are separate, and each
+contains ten or twelve of these inhabitants. There
+is a little mound in front of the hole, formed of the
+earth thrown out of the burrow; and frequently there
+are three or four distinct holes, forming one burrow,
+with their entrances around the base of a mound.
+These mounds, about two feet in height and four in
+diameter, are occupied as watch-towers by the inhabitants
+of these little communities. The squirrels are
+irregularly distributed about the tract they thus <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_207" id="Page_207">[Pg 207]</a></span>occupy,&mdash;ten,
+twenty, or thirty yards apart. When
+any person approaches, they make a shrill whistling
+sound, somewhat resembling "tweet, tweet, tweet;"
+the signal for their party to take the alarm, and to
+retire into their intrenchments. They feed on the
+grass of their village, the limits of which they never
+venture to exceed. As soon as the frost commences,
+they shut themselves up in their caverns, and continue
+until the spring opens.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">BIRDS.</p>
+
+<p><span class="smcap">The Grouse, or Prairie-Hen.</span>&mdash;This is peculiarly
+the inhabitant of the great plains of the Columbia,
+but does not differ from those of the upper portion
+of the Missouri. In the winter season, this bird is
+booted to the first joint of the toes. The toes are
+curiously bordered on their lower edges with narrow,
+hard scales, which are placed very close to each
+other, and extend horizontally about one-eighth of
+an inch on each side of the toes, adding much to the
+broadness of the feet,&mdash;a security which Nature has
+furnished them for passing over the snow with more
+ease,&mdash;and, what is very remarkable, in the summer
+season these scales drop from the feet. The color
+of this bird is a mixture of dark brown, reddish, and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_208" id="Page_208">[Pg 208]</a></span>yellowish brown, with white confusedly mixed. The
+reddish-brown prevails most on the upper parts of
+the body, wings, and tail; and the white, under the
+belly and the lower parts of the breast and tail.
+They associate in large flocks in autumn and winter;
+and, even in summer, are seen in companies of five or
+six. They feed on grass, insects, leaves of various
+shrubs in the plains, and the seeds of several species
+of plants which grow in richer soils. In winter, their
+food consists of the buds of the willow and cottonwood,
+and native berries.</p>
+
+<p>The cock of the plains is found on the plains of
+the Columbia in great abundance. The beak is large,
+short, covered, and convex; the upper exceeding the
+lower chap. The nostrils are large, and the back
+black. The color is a uniform mixture of a dark-brown,
+resembling the dove, and a reddish or yellowish
+brown, with some small black specks. The habits
+of this bird resemble those of the grouse, excepting
+that his food is the leaf and buds of the pulpy-leaved
+thorn. The flesh is dark, and only tolerable in point
+of flavor.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">HORNED FROG.</p>
+
+<p>The horned lizard, or horned frog, called, for what
+reason we never could learn, the prairie buffalo, is
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_209" id="Page_209">[Pg 209]</a></span>a native of these plains as well as of those of the
+Missouri. The color is generally brown, intermixed
+with yellowish spots. The animal is covered with
+minute scales, interspersed with small horny points,
+or prickles, on the upper surface of the body. The
+belly and throat resemble those of the frog, and are
+of a light yellowish-brown. The edge of the belly
+is likewise beset with small horny projections. The
+eye is small and dark. Above and behind the eyes
+there are several bony projections, which resemble
+horns sprouting from the head.</p>
+
+<p>These animals are found in greatest numbers in
+the sandy, open plains, and appear most abundant
+after a shower of rain. They are sometimes found
+basking in the sunshine, but generally conceal themselves
+in little holes of the earth. This may account
+for their appearance in such numbers after rain, as
+their holes may thus be rendered untenantable.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_210" id="Page_210">[Pg 210]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XVI.</h2>
+
+<h3>THE RETURN.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>March, 1806.&mdash;Many reasons had inclined us
+to remain at Fort Clatsop till the 1st of April.
+Besides the want of fuel in the Columbian plains, and
+the impracticability of crossing the mountains before
+the beginning of June, we were anxious to see some
+of the foreign traders, from whom, by our ample letters
+of credit, we might recruit our exhausted stores
+of merchandise. About the middle of March, however,
+we became seriously alarmed for the want of
+food. The elk, our chief dependence, had at length
+deserted its usual haunts in our neighborhood, and retreated
+to the mountains. We were too poor to purchase
+food from the Indians; so that we were sometimes
+reduced, notwithstanding all the exertions of
+our hunters, to a single day's provision in advance.
+The men too, whom the constant rains and confinement
+had rendered unhealthy, might, we hoped, be
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_211" id="Page_211">[Pg 211]</a></span>benefited by leaving the coast, and resuming the exercise
+of travelling. We therefore determined to
+leave Fort Clatsop, ascend the river slowly, consume
+the month of March in the woody country, where we
+hoped to find subsistence, and in this way reach the
+plains about the 1st of April, before which time it
+will be impossible to cross them.</p>
+
+<p>During the winter, we have been very industrious
+in dressing skins; so that we now have a sufficient
+quantity of clothing, besides between three and four
+hundred pairs of moccasons. But the whole stock of
+goods on which we are to depend for the purchase
+of horses or of food, during the long journey of four
+thousand miles, is so much diminished, that it might
+all be tied in two handkerchiefs. We therefore feel
+that our chief dependence must be on our guns,
+which, fortunately, are all in good order, as we took
+the precaution of bringing a number of extra locks,
+and one of our men proved to be an excellent gunsmith.
+The powder had been secured in leaden canisters;
+and, though on many occasions they had been
+under water, it remained perfectly dry: and we now
+found ourselves in possession of one hundred and
+forty pounds of powder, and twice that weight of
+lead,&mdash;a stock quite sufficient for the route homewards.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_212" id="Page_212">[Pg 212]</a></span>We were now ready to leave Fort Clatsop; but the
+rain prevented us for several days from calking the
+canoes, and we were forced to wait for calm weather
+before we could attempt to pass Point William, which
+projects about a mile and a half into the sea, forming,
+as it were, the dividing-line between the river and
+the ocean; for the water below is salt, while that
+above is fresh.</p>
+
+<p>On March 23, at one o'clock in the afternoon, we
+took a final leave of Fort Clatsop. We doubled
+Point William without any injury, and at six o'clock
+reached the mouth of a small creek, where we found
+our hunters. They had been fortunate enough to
+kill two elks, which were brought in, and served for
+breakfast next morning.</p>
+
+<p>Next day, we were overtaken by two Wahkiacums,
+who brought two dogs, for which they wanted us to
+give them some tobacco; but, as we had very little
+of that article left, they were obliged to go away
+disappointed. We received at the same time an
+agreeable supply of three eagles and a large goose,
+brought in by the hunters.</p>
+
+<p>We passed the entrance of Cowalitz River, seventy
+miles from our winter camp. This stream enters the
+Columbia from the north; is one hundred and fifty
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_213" id="Page_213">[Pg 213]</a></span>yards wide; deep and navigable, as the Indians assert,
+for a considerable distance; and probably waters
+the country west and north of the Cascade Mountains,
+which cross the Columbia between the great
+falls and rapids. During the day, we passed a number
+of fishing-camps on both sides of the river, and
+were constantly attended by small parties of Skilloots,
+who behaved in the most orderly manner, and
+from whom we purchased as much fish and roots as
+we wanted, on moderate terms. The night continued
+as the day had been,&mdash;cold, wet, and disagreeable;
+which is the general character of the weather in this
+region at this season.</p>
+
+<p>March 29.&mdash;At an early hour, we resumed our
+route, and halted for breakfast at the upper end of an
+island where is properly the commencement of the
+great Columbian Valley. We landed at a village of
+fourteen large wooden houses. The people received
+us kindly, and spread before us wappatoo and anchovies;
+but, as soon as we had finished enjoying this
+hospitality (if it deserves that name), they began to
+ask us for presents. They were, however, perfectly
+satisfied with the small articles which we distributed
+according to custom, and equally pleased with our
+purchasing some wappatoo, twelve dogs, and two <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_214" id="Page_214">[Pg 214]</a></span>sea-otter
+skins. We also gave the chief a small medal,
+which he soon transferred to his wife.</p>
+
+<p>April 1.&mdash;We met a number of canoes filled with
+families descending the river. These people told us
+that they lived at the Great Rapids, but that a
+scarcity of provisions there had induced them to
+come down in hopes of finding subsistence in this
+fertile valley. All those who lived at the rapids, as
+well as the nations above them, they said, were in
+much distress for want of food, having consumed
+their winter store of dried fish, and not expecting
+the return of the salmon before the next full moon,
+which will be on the 2d of May.</p>
+
+<p>This intelligence was disagreeable and embarrassing.
+From the falls to the Chopunnish nation, the
+plains afford no deer, elk, or antelope, on which we
+can rely for subsistence. The horses are very poor
+at this season; and the dogs must be in the same
+condition, if their food, the fish, have failed. On the
+other hand, it is obviously inexpedient to wait for
+the return of the salmon, since, in that case, we may
+not reach the Missouri before the ice will prevent our
+navigating it. We therefore decided to remain here
+only till we collect meat enough to last us till we
+reach the Chopunnish nation, with whom we left our
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_215" id="Page_215">[Pg 215]</a></span>horses on our downward journey, trusting that we
+shall find the animals safe, and have them faithfully
+returned to us; for, without them, the passage of the
+mountains will be almost impracticable.</p>
+
+<p>April 2, 1806.&mdash;Several canoes arrived to visit us;
+and among the party were two young men who belonged
+to a nation, which, they said, resides at the falls
+of a large river which empties itself into the south
+side of the Columbia, a few miles below us; and they
+drew a map of the country with a coal on a mat. In
+order to verify this information, Capt. Clarke persuaded
+one of the young men, by the present of a
+burning-glass, to accompany him to the river, in
+search of which he immediately set out with a canoe
+and seven of our men.</p>
+
+<p>In the evening, Capt. Clarke returned from his
+excursion. After descending about twenty miles, he
+entered the mouth of a large river, which was concealed,
+by three small islands opposite its entrance,
+from those who pass up or down the Columbia. This
+river, which the Indians call Multnomah, from a nation
+of the same name residing near it on Wappatoo
+Island, enters the Columbia one hundred and forty
+miles above the mouth of the latter river. The current
+of the Multnomah, which is also called Willamett,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_216" id="Page_216">[Pg 216]</a></span>is as gentle as that of the Columbia; and it appears to
+possess water enough for the largest ship, since, on
+sounding with a line of five fathoms, they could find
+no bottom.</p>
+
+<p>Capt. Clarke ascended the river to the village of
+his guide. He found here a building two hundred
+and twenty-six feet in front, entirely above ground,
+and all under one roof; otherwise it would seem more
+like a range of buildings, as it is divided into seven
+distinct apartments, each thirty feet square. The
+roof is formed of rafters, with round poles laid on
+them longitudinally. The whole is covered with a
+double row of the bark of the white cedar, secured
+by splinters of dried fir, inserted through it at regular
+distances. In this manner, the roof is made light,
+strong, and durable.</p>
+
+<p>In the house were several old people of both
+sexes, who were treated with much respect, and still
+seemed healthy, though most of them were perfectly
+blind.</p>
+
+<p>On inquiring the cause of the decline of their village,
+which was shown pretty clearly by the remains
+of several deserted buildings, an old man, father of
+the guide, and a person of some distinction, brought
+forward a woman very much marked with the small-pox,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_217" id="Page_217">[Pg 217]</a></span>and said, that, when a girl, she was near dying
+with the disorder which had left those marks, and
+that the inhabitants of the houses now in ruins had
+fallen victims to the same disease.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">WAPPATOO ISLAND AND ROOT.</p>
+
+<p>Wappatoo Island is a large extent of country lying
+between the Multnomah River and an arm of the Columbia.
+The island is about twenty miles long, and
+varies in breadth from five to ten miles. The land is
+high, and extremely fertile, and on most parts is supplied
+with a heavy growth of cottonwood, ash, and
+willow. But the chief wealth of this island consists
+of the numerous ponds in the interior, abounding with
+the common arrowhead (<i>Sagittaria sagittifolia</i>), to
+the root of which is attached a bulb growing beneath
+it, in the mud. This bulb, to which the Indians give
+the name of <i>wappatoo</i>, is the great article of food,
+and almost the staple article of commerce, on the
+Columbia. It is never out of season; so that, at all
+times of the year, the valley is frequented by the
+neighboring Indians who come to gather it. It is
+collected chiefly by the women, who employ for the
+purpose canoes from ten to fourteen feet in length,
+about two feet wide, and nine inches deep, tapering
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_218" id="Page_218">[Pg 218]</a></span>from the middle, where they are about twenty inches
+wide. They are sufficient to contain a single person
+and several bushels of roots; yet so light, that a woman
+can carry one with ease. She takes one of these canoes
+into a pond where the water is as high as the
+breast, and, by means of her toes, separates from the
+root this bulb, which, on being freed from the mud,
+rises immediately to the surface of the water, and is
+thrown into the canoe. In this manner, these patient
+females remain in the water for several hours, even
+in the depth of winter. This plant is found through
+the whole extent of the valley in which we now are,
+but does not grow on the Columbia farther eastward.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">SCENERY OF THE RIVER AND SHORES.</p>
+
+<p>Above the junction of the Multnomah River, we
+passed along under high, steep, and rocky sides of
+the mountains, which here close in on each side of
+the river, forming stupendous precipices, covered
+with the fir and white cedar. Down these heights
+frequently descend the most beautiful cascades,&mdash;one
+of which, a large stream, throws itself over a perpendicular
+rock, three hundred feet above the water;
+while other smaller streams precipitate themselves
+from a still greater elevation, and, separating into a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_219" id="Page_219">[Pg 219]</a></span>mist, again collect, and form a second cascade before
+they reach the bottom of the rocks.</p>
+
+<p>The hills on both sides of the river are about two
+hundred and fifty feet high, generally abrupt and
+craggy, and in many places presenting a perpendicular
+face of black, hard, basaltic rock. From the top
+of these hills, the country extends itself, in level
+plains, to a very great distance.</p>
+
+<p>To one remarkable elevation we gave the name of
+Beacon Rock. It stands on the north side of the
+river, insulated from the hills. The northern side
+has a partial growth of fir or pine. To the south, it
+rises in an unbroken precipice to the height of seven
+hundred feet, where it terminates in a sharp point,
+and may be seen at the distance of twenty miles.
+This rock may be considered as the point where tidewater
+commences.</p>
+
+<p>April 19.&mdash;We formed our camp at the foot of the
+Long Narrows, a little above a settlement of Skilloots.
+Their dwellings were formed by sticks set in the
+ground, and covered with mats and straw, and so
+large, that each was the residence of several families.</p>
+
+<p>The whole village was filled with rejoicing at having
+caught a salmon, which was considered as the
+harbinger of vast quantities that would arrive in a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_220" id="Page_220">[Pg 220]</a></span>few days. In the belief that it would hasten their
+coming, the Indians, according to their custom,
+dressed the fish, and cut it into small pieces, one
+of which was given to every child in the village;
+and, in the good humor excited by this occurrence,
+they parted, though reluctantly, with four horses,
+for which we gave them two kettles, reserving to
+ourselves only one.</p>
+
+<p>We resumed our route, and soon after halted on a
+hill, from the top of which we had a commanding
+view of the range of mountains in which Mount
+Hood stands, and which continued south as far as
+the eye could reach; their summits being covered
+with snow. Mount Hood bore south thirty degrees
+west; and another snowy summit, which we have
+called Mount Jefferson, south ten degrees west.</p>
+
+<p>Capt. Clarke crossed the river, with nine men
+and a large part of the merchandise, to purchase,
+if possible, twelve horses to transport our baggage,
+and some pounded fish, as a reserve, on the passage
+across the mountains. He succeeded in purchasing
+only four horses, and those at double the price
+that had been paid to the Shoshonees.</p>
+
+<p>April 20.&mdash;As it was much for our interest to preserve
+the good will of these people, we passed over
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_221" id="Page_221">[Pg 221]</a></span>several small thefts which they had committed; but
+this morning we learned that six tomahawks and a
+knife had been stolen during the night. We addressed
+ourselves to the chief, who seemed angry
+with his people; but we did not recover the articles:
+and soon afterwards two of our spoons were missing.
+We therefore ordered them all from the camp. They
+left us in ill-humor, and we therefore kept on our
+guard against any insult.</p>
+
+<p>April 22.&mdash;We began our march at seven o'clock.
+We had just reached the top of a hill near the village,
+when the load of one of the horses turned; and the
+animal, taking fright at a robe which still adhered to
+him, ran furiously toward the village. Just as he
+came there, the robe fell, and an Indian made way
+with it. The horse was soon caught; but the robe
+was missing, and the Indians denied having seen it.
+These repeated acts of knavery had quite exhausted
+our patience; and Capt. Lewis set out for the village,
+determined to make them deliver up the robe, or to
+burn their houses to the ground. This retaliation
+was happily rendered unnecessary; for on his way
+he met two of our men, who had found the robe in
+one of the huts, hid behind some baggage.</p>
+
+<p>April 24.&mdash;The Indians had promised to take our
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_222" id="Page_222">[Pg 222]</a></span>canoes in exchange for horses; but, when they found
+that we were resolved on travelling by land, they refused
+giving us any thing for them, in hopes that we
+would be forced to leave them. Disgusted at this
+conduct, we determined rather to cut them in pieces
+than suffer these people to possess them; and actually
+began to do so, when they consented to give us several
+strands of beads for each canoe.</p>
+
+<p>We had now a sufficient number of horses to carry
+our baggage, and therefore proceeded wholly by land.
+Passing between the hills and the northern shore of
+the river, we had a difficult and fatiguing march over
+a road alternately sandy and rocky.</p>
+
+<p>The country through which we have passed for
+several days is of uniform character. The hills on
+both sides of the river are about two hundred and
+fifty feet high, in many places presenting a perpendicular
+face of black, solid rock. From the top of
+these hills, the country extends, in level plains, to a
+very great distance, and, though not as fertile as
+land near the falls, produces an abundant supply of
+low grass, which is an excellent food for horses. The
+grass must indeed be unusually nutritious: for even
+at this season of the year, after wintering on the dry
+grass of the plains, and being used with greater <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_223" id="Page_223">[Pg 223]</a></span>severity
+than is usual among the whites, many of the
+horses were perfectly fat; nor had we seen a single
+one that was really poor.</p>
+
+<p>Having proceeded thirty-one miles, we halted for
+the night not far from some houses of the Walla-wallas.
+Soon after stopping, we were joined by seven
+of that tribe, among whom we recognized a chief by
+the name of Yellept, who had visited us in October
+last, when we gave him a medal.</p>
+
+<p>He appeared very much pleased at seeing us again,
+and invited us to remain at his village three or four
+days, during which he would supply us with such
+food as they had, and furnish us with horses for our
+journey. After the cold, inhospitable treatment we
+had lately received, this kind offer was peculiarly
+acceptable. After having made a hasty meal, we accompanied
+him to his village. Immediately on our
+arrival, Yellept, who proved to be a man of much
+influence, collected the inhabitants, and after having
+made an harangue to them, the object of which was to
+induce them to treat us hospitably, set them an example
+by bringing himself an armful of wood, and a platter
+containing three roasted mullets. They immediately
+followed the example by furnishing us with
+an abundance of the only sort of fuel they use,&mdash;the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_224" id="Page_224">[Pg 224]</a></span>stems of shrubs growing in the plains. We then purchased
+four dogs, on which we supped heartily, having
+been on short allowance for two days previously.</p>
+
+<p>We learned from these people, that, opposite to
+their village, there was a route which led to the
+mouth of the Kooskooskee; that the road was good,
+and passed over a level country well supplied with
+water and grass; and that we should meet with
+plenty of deer and antelope. We knew that a road
+in that direction would shorten our route eighty
+miles; and we concluded to adopt this route.</p>
+
+<p>Fortunately there was among these Walla-wallas a
+prisoner belonging to a tribe of the Shoshonee Indians.
+Our Shoshonee woman, Sacajawea, though
+she belonged to another tribe, spoke the same language
+as this prisoner; and by their means we were
+enabled to explain ourselves to the Indians, and to
+answer all their inquiries with respect to ourselves
+and the object of our journey. Our conversation
+inspired them with such confidence, that they soon
+brought several sick persons for whom they requested
+our assistance. We splintered the broken
+arm of one, gave some relief to another whose knee
+was contracted by rheumatism, and administered
+what we thought would be useful for ulcers and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_225" id="Page_225">[Pg 225]</a></span>eruptions of the skin on various parts of the body,
+which are very common disorders among them. But
+our most valuable medicine was eye-water, which we
+distributed, and which, indeed, they very much required;
+for complaints of the eyes, occasioned by
+living so much on the water, and aggravated by
+the fine sand of the plains, were universal among
+them.</p>
+
+<p>We were by no means dissatisfied at this new
+resource for obtaining subsistence, as the Indians
+would give us no provisions without merchandise,
+and our stock was very much reduced. We carefully
+abstained from giving them any thing but harmless
+medicines; and our prescriptions might be useful,
+and were therefore entitled to some remuneration.</p>
+
+<p>May 5.&mdash;Almost the only instance of rudeness we
+encountered in our whole trip occurred here. We
+made our dinner on two dogs and a small quantity of
+roots. While we were eating, an Indian standing by,
+and looking with great derision at our eating dog's-flesh,
+threw a half-starved puppy almost into Capt.
+Lewis's plate, laughing heartily at the humor of it.
+Capt. Lewis took up the animal, and flung it back
+with great force into the fellow's face, and, seizing
+his tomahawk, threatened to cut him down if he
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_226" id="Page_226">[Pg 226]</a></span>dared to repeat such insolence. He went off, apparently
+much mortified; and we continued our dog-repast
+very quietly.</p>
+
+<p>Here we met our old Chopunnish guide and his
+family; and soon afterward one of our horses, which
+had been separated from the others in the charge of
+Twisted-hair, was caught, and restored to us.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE WALLA-WALLA.</p>
+
+<p>We reached (May 1) a branch of the Walla-walla River.
+The hills of this creek are generally abrupt
+and rocky; but the narrow bottom bordering the
+stream is very fertile, and both possess twenty
+times as much timber as the Columbia itself. Indeed,
+we now find, for the first time since leaving
+Fort Clatsop, an abundance of firewood. The growth
+consists of cotton-wood, birch, the crimson haw, willow,
+choke-cherry, yellow currants, gooseberry, honeysuckle,
+rose-bushes, sumac, together with some corn-grass
+and rushes.</p>
+
+<p>The advantage of a comfortable fire induced us, as
+the night was come, to halt at this place. We were
+soon supplied by Drewyer with a beaver and an
+otter; of which we took only a part of the beaver,
+and gave the rest to the Indians. The otter is a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_227" id="Page_227">[Pg 227]</a></span>favorite food, though much inferior, in our estimation,
+to the dog, which they will not eat. The horse, too,
+is seldom eaten, and never except when absolute
+necessity compels. This fastidiousness does not, however,
+seem to proceed so much from any dislike to
+the food as from attachment to the animal; for many
+of them eat very freely of the horse-beef we give
+them.</p>
+
+<p>There is very little difference in the general face
+of the country here from that of the plains on the
+Missouri, except that the latter are enlivened by
+vast herds of buffaloes, elks, and other animals, which
+are wanting here. Over these wide bottoms we continued,
+till, at the distance of twenty-six miles from
+our last encampment, we halted for the night.</p>
+
+<p>We had scarcely encamped, when three young
+men from the Walla-walla village came in with a
+steel-trap, which we had inadvertently left behind,
+and which they had come a whole day's journey
+on purpose to restore. This act of integrity was
+the more pleasing because it corresponds perfectly
+with the general behavior of the Walla-wallas, among
+whom we had lost carelessly several knives, which
+were always returned as soon as found. We may,
+indeed, justly affirm, that, of all the Indians whom we
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_228" id="Page_228">[Pg 228]</a></span>have met, the Walla-wallas were the most hospitable,
+honest, and sincere.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">TWISTED-HAIR.</p>
+
+<p>On Wednesday, the 7th of May, we reached the
+Kooskooskee, and found it much more navigable than
+when we descended it last year. The water was
+risen, and covered the rocks and shoals. Here we
+found the chief, named Twisted-hair, in whose charge
+we had left our horses in our outward journey. We
+had suspicions that our horses, and especially our saddles,
+might not be easily recoverable after our long
+absence. The Twisted-hair was invited to come, and
+smoke with us. He accepted the invitation, and, as
+we smoked our pipes over the fire, informed us, that,
+according to his promise, he had collected the horses,
+and taken charge of them; but another chief, the
+Broken-arm, becoming jealous of him because the
+horses were confided to his care, was constantly quarrelling
+with him. At length, being an old man, and
+unwilling to live in perpetual disputes, he had given
+up the care of the horses, which had consequently
+become scattered. The greater part of them were,
+however, still in this neighborhood. He added, that
+on the rise of the river, in the spring, the earth had
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_229" id="Page_229">[Pg 229]</a></span>fallen from the door of the <i>cache</i>, and exposed the
+saddles, some of which had probably been lost; but,
+as soon as he was acquainted with the situation of
+them, he had had them buried in another place, where
+they were now. He promised that he would, on the
+morrow, send his young men, and collect such of the
+horses as were in the neighborhood. He kept his
+word. Next day, the Indians brought in twenty-one
+of the horses, the greater part of which were in excellent
+order; and the Twisted-hair restored about
+half the saddles we had left in the <i>cache</i>, and some
+powder and lead which were buried at the same
+place.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_230" id="Page_230">[Pg 230]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XVII.</h2>
+
+<h3>THE ROCKY MOUNTAINS.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>May 17.&mdash;The country along the Rocky Mountains,
+for several hundred miles in length and
+fifty in width, is a high level plain; in all its parts
+extremely fertile, and in many places covered with a
+growth of tall, long-leaved pine. Nearly the whole
+of this wide tract is covered with a profusion of
+grass and plants, which are at this time as high as
+the knee. Among these are a variety of esculent
+plants and roots, yielding a nutritious and agreeable
+food. The air is pure and dry; the climate as mild
+as that of the same latitudes in the Atlantic States,
+and must be equally healthy, since all the disorders
+which we have witnessed may fairly be imputed to
+other causes than the climate. Of course, the degrees
+of heat and cold obey the influence of situation.
+Thus the rains of the low grounds are snows
+in the high plains; and, while the sun shines with
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_231" id="Page_231">[Pg 231]</a></span>intense heat in the confined river-bottoms, the plains
+enjoy a much cooler air; and, at the foot of the mountains,
+the snows are even now many feet in depth.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">CROSSING THE MOUNTAINS.</p>
+
+<p>An attempt to cross the mountains in the early
+part of June failed on account of the snow, which
+still covered the track. It was plain we should have
+no chance of finding either grass or underwood for
+our horses. To proceed, therefore, would be to hazard
+the loss of our horses; in which case, if we should be
+so fortunate as to escape with our lives, we should
+be obliged to abandon our papers and collections.
+It was accordingly decided not to venture farther;
+to deposit here all the baggage and provisions for
+which we had no immediate use, and to return to
+some spot where we might live by hunting till the
+snow should have melted, or a guide be procured to
+conduct us. We submitted, June 17, to the mortification
+of retracing our steps three days' march.</p>
+
+<p>On the 24th June, having been so fortunate as to
+engage three Indians to go with us to the falls of the
+Missouri for the compensation of two guns, we set
+out on our second attempt to cross the mountains.
+On reaching the place where we had left our <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_232" id="Page_232">[Pg 232]</a></span>baggage,
+we found our deposit perfectly safe. It required
+two hours to arrange our baggage, and prepare
+a hasty meal; after which the guides urged us
+to set off, as we had a long ride to make before we
+could reach a spot where there was grass for our
+horses. We mounted, and followed their steps; sometimes
+crossed abruptly steep hills, and then wound
+along their sides, near tremendous precipices, where,
+had our horses slipped, we should have been irrecoverably
+lost. Our route lay along the ridges which
+separate the waters of the Kooskooskee and Chopunnish,
+and above the heads of all the streams; so that
+we met no running water. Late in the evening, we
+reached a spot where we encamped near a good
+spring of water. It was on the steep side of a mountain,
+with no wood, and a fair southern aspect, from
+which the snow seemed to have disappeared for about
+ten days, and an abundant growth of young grass, like
+greensward, had sprung up. There was also a species
+of grass not unlike flag, with a broad succulent leaf,
+which is confined to the upper parts of the mountains.
+It is a favorite food with the horses; but it
+was then either covered with snow, or just making
+its appearance.</p>
+
+<p>June 27.&mdash;We continued our route over the high
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_233" id="Page_233">[Pg 233]</a></span>and steep hills of the same great ridge. At eight
+miles' distance, we reached an eminence where the
+Indians have raised a conical mound of stone six or
+eight feet high. From this spot we have a commanding
+view of the surrounding mountains, which so
+completely enclose us, that, although we have once
+passed them, we should despair of ever escaping from
+them without the assistance of the Indians; but our
+guides traverse this trackless region with a kind of
+instinctive sagacity. They never hesitate; they are
+never embarrassed; yet so undeviating is their step,
+that, wherever the snow has disappeared for even a
+hundred paces, we find the summer road. With their
+aid, the snow is scarcely a disadvantage; for although
+we are often obliged to slide down, yet the fallen
+timber and the rocks, which are now covered up,
+were much more troublesome when we passed in the
+autumn.</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>NOTE. A later traveller through this region writes, "The mountains
+are indeed <i>rocky</i>. They are rocks heaped upon rocks,
+with no vegetation, excepting a few cedars growing out of the
+crevices near their base. Their tops are covered with perpetual
+snow. The main ridge of the mountains is of <i>gneiss</i> rock; yet,
+to-day, parallel ridges of a rock, nearly allied to <i>basalt</i>, have
+abounded. These ridges appear to be volcanic, forced up in
+<i>dikes</i> at different distances from each other, running from east-north-east
+to west-south-west. The strata are mostly vertical;
+but some are a little dipped to the south.</p>
+
+<p>"Our encampment was near a small stream which runs
+through a volcanic chasm, which is more than a hundred feet
+deep, with perpendicular sides. Here was a passage made for
+the <i>water</i> by <i>fire</i>."</p></div>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_234" id="Page_234">[Pg 234]</a></span>THE PARTY AGREE TO SEPARATE.</p>
+
+<p>July 3, 1806.&mdash;It was agreed here that the expedition
+should be divided, to unite again at the confluence
+of the Missouri and the Yellowstone. The
+separation took place near the point where Clarke's
+River is crossed by the forty-seventh parallel of latitude.
+Capt. Lewis, with nine men, was to cross the
+mountains in a direction as nearly due east as possible,
+expecting to find some tributary of the Missouri,
+by following which he might reach that river, and by
+it retrace his way homeward. Capt. Clarke, with the
+remainder of the party, was to seek the head waters
+of the Yellowstone, and follow that stream to the
+proposed place of re-union.</p>
+
+<p>In conformity with this arrangement, Capt. Lewis,
+under the guidance of friendly Indians, crossed the
+mountains by a route which led him, after travelling
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_235" id="Page_235">[Pg 235]</a></span>one hundred and four miles, to Medicine River, and
+by that river to the Missouri. He reached the falls
+of the Missouri on the 17th of July, and leaving
+there a portion of his party, under Sergt. Gass, to
+make preparations for transporting their baggage
+and canoes round the falls, set out, accompanied
+by Drewyer and the two brothers Fields, with six
+horses, to explore Maria's River, to ascertain its extent
+toward the north. From the 18th to the 26th,
+they were engaged in this exploration. On the eve
+of their return, an event occurred, which, being the
+only instance in which the expedition was engaged
+in any conflict with the Indians with loss of life,
+requires to be particularly related.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">CONFLICT WITH THE INDIANS.</p>
+
+<p>We were passing through a region frequented by
+the Minnetarees, a band of Indians noted for their
+thievish propensities and unfriendly dispositions.
+Capt. Lewis was therefore desirous to avoid meeting
+with them. Drewyer had been sent out for
+game, and Capt. Lewis ascended a hill to look over
+the country. Scarcely had he reached the top, when
+he saw, about a mile on his left, a collection of about
+thirty horses. By the aid of his spy-glass, he <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_236" id="Page_236">[Pg 236]</a></span>discovered
+that one-half of the horses were saddled, and
+that, on the eminence above the horses, several Indians
+were looking down towards the river, probably
+at Drewyer. This was a most unwelcome sight.
+Their probable numbers rendered any contest with
+them of doubtful issue. To attempt to escape would
+only invite pursuit; and our horses were so bad, that
+we must certainly be overtaken: besides which,
+Drewyer could not yet be aware that Indians were
+near; and, if we ran, he would most probably be sacrificed.
+We therefore determined to make the best of
+our situation, and advance towards them in a friendly
+manner. The flag which we had brought in case of
+such an emergency was therefore displayed, and we
+continued slowly our march towards them. Their
+whole attention was so engaged by Drewyer, that they
+did not immediately discover us. As soon as they did
+so, they appeared to be much alarmed, and ran about
+in confusion. When we came within a quarter of a
+mile, one of the Indians mounted, and rode towards
+us. When within a hundred paces of us, he halted;
+and Capt. Lewis, who had alighted to receive him,
+held out his hand, and beckoned him to approach:
+but he only looked at us, and then, without saying a
+word, returned to his companions.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_237" id="Page_237">[Pg 237]</a></span>The whole party now descended the hill, and rode
+towards us. As yet we saw only eight, but presumed
+that there must be more behind, as there were several
+more horses saddled. Capt. Lewis had with him
+but two men; and he told them his fears that these
+were Indians of the Minnetaree tribe, and that they
+would attempt to rob us, and advised them to be
+on the alert, should there appear any disposition to
+attack us.</p>
+
+<p>When the two parties came within a hundred yards
+of each other, all the Indians, except one, halted.
+Capt. Lewis therefore ordered his two men to halt,
+while he advanced, and, after shaking hands with the
+Indian, went on and did the same with the others in
+the rear, while the Indian himself shook hands with our
+two men. They all now came up; and, after alighting,
+the Indians asked to smoke with us. Capt. Lewis, who
+was very anxious for Drewyer's safety, told them that
+the man who had gone down the river had the pipe,
+and requested, that, as they had seen him, one of
+them would accompany R. Fields to bring him back.
+To this they assented; and Fields went with a young
+man in search of Drewyer, who returned with them.</p>
+
+<p>As it was growing late, Capt. Lewis proposed that
+they should encamp with us; for he was glad to see
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_238" id="Page_238">[Pg 238]</a></span>them, and had a great deal to say to them. They
+assented; and, being soon joined by Drewyer, the
+evening was spent in conversation with the Indians,
+in which Capt. Lewis endeavored to persuade them
+to cultivate peace with their neighbors. Finding
+them very fond of the pipe, Capt. Lewis, who was
+desirous of keeping a constant watch during the
+night, smoked with them to a late hour; and, as soon as
+they were all asleep, he woke R. Fields, and ordering
+him to rouse us all in case any Indian left the camp,
+as he feared they would attempt to steal our horses,
+he lay down by the side of Drewyer in the tent
+with the Indians, while the brothers Fields were
+stretched near the fire at the mouth of the tent.</p>
+
+<p>At sunrise, the Indians got up, and crowded round
+the fire, near which J. Fields, who was then on
+watch, had carelessly left his rifle, near the head of
+his brother, who was asleep. One of the Indians
+slipped behind him, and, unperceived, took his brother's
+and his own rifle; while at the same time two
+others seized those of Drewyer and Capt. Lewis. As
+soon as Fields turned round, he saw the Indian running
+off with the rifles; and, instantly calling his
+brother, they pursued him for fifty or sixty yards;
+and just as they overtook him, in the scuffle for the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_239" id="Page_239">[Pg 239]</a></span>rifles, R. Fields stabbed him through the heart with
+his knife. The Indian ran a few steps, and fell dead.
+They recovered their rifles, and ran back to the camp.</p>
+
+<p>The moment the fellow touched his gun, Drewyer,
+who was awake, jumped up, and wrested it from him.
+The noise awoke Capt. Lewis, who instantly started
+from the ground, and reached to seize his gun, but
+found it gone, and, turning about, saw the Indian
+running off with it. He followed, and called to him
+to lay down the gun; which he did. By this time,
+the rest of the Indians were endeavoring to drive off
+our horses; and Capt. Lewis ordered his men to follow
+them, and fire upon the thieves if they did not
+release our horses. The result was, that we recovered
+four of our horses, and as many of theirs which
+they had left behind; so that we were rather gainers
+by the contest. Besides the Indian killed by Fields,
+one other was badly wounded.</p>
+
+<p>We had no doubt but that we should be immediately
+pursued by a much larger party. Our only
+chance of safety was in rejoining our friends, who
+were many miles distant. We therefore pushed
+our horses as fast as we could; and, fortunately
+for us, the Indian horses proved very good. The
+plains were level, free from stones and <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_240" id="Page_240">[Pg 240]</a></span>prickly-pears,
+and in fine order for travelling over from the
+late rains. We commenced our ride in the early
+morning. At three o'clock, we had ridden, by estimate,
+sixty-three miles. We halted for an hour and a
+half to refresh our horses; then pursued our journey
+seventeen miles farther, when, as night came on, we
+killed a buffalo, and again stopped for two hours.
+The sky was now overclouded; but, as the moon
+gave light enough to show us the route, we continued
+for twenty miles farther, and then, exhausted
+with fatigue, halted at two in the morning. Next day,
+we rejoined the main body of our party in safety.</p>
+
+<p>Capt. Lewis with his companions pursued their
+way down the Missouri, passing those points already
+noticed in their ascent. Our narrative, therefore,
+will leave them here, and attend the course of Capt.
+Clarke and his party down the Yellowstone.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_241" id="Page_241">[Pg 241]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XVIII.</h2>
+
+<h3>CAPT. CLARKE'S ROUTE DOWN THE YELLOWSTONE.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>July 3, 1806.&mdash;The party under Capt. Clarke,
+consisting of fifteen men, with fifty horses, set
+out through the valley of Clarke's River, along the
+western side of which they rode in a southern direction.
+The valley is from ten to fifteen miles in width,
+and is diversified by a number of small open plains,
+abounding with grass and a variety of sweet-scented
+plants, and watered by numerous streams rushing
+from the western mountains. These mountains were
+covered with snow about one-fifth of the way from
+the top; and some snow was still to be seen in the
+hollows of the mountains to the eastward.</p>
+
+<p>July 7.&mdash;They reached Wisdom River, and stopped
+for dinner at a hot spring situated in the open plain.
+The bed of the spring is about fifteen yards in circumference,
+and composed of loose, hard, gritty
+stones, through which the water boils in large <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_242" id="Page_242">[Pg 242]</a></span>quantities.
+It is slightly impregnated with sulphur, and
+so hot, that a piece of meat, about the size of three fingers,
+was completely cooked in twenty-five minutes.</p>
+
+<p>July 8.&mdash;They arrived at Jefferson's River, where
+they had deposited their goods in the month of August
+the year before. They found every thing safe,
+though some of the goods were a little damp, and
+one of the canoes had a hole in it. They had now
+crossed from Traveller's-Rest Creek to the head of Jefferson's
+River, which seems to form the best and shortest
+route over the mountains during almost the whole
+distance of one hundred and sixty-four miles. It is,
+in fact, an excellent road; and, by cutting down a few
+trees, it might be rendered a good route for wagons,
+with the exception of about four miles over one of
+the mountains, which would require a little levelling.</p>
+
+<p>July 10.&mdash;The boats were now loaded, and Capt.
+Clarke divided his men into two bands. Sergt. Ordway,
+with nine men, in six canoes, was to descend
+the river; while Capt. Clarke, with the remaining
+ten, the wife and child of Chaboneau, and fifty horses,
+were to proceed by land to the Yellowstone. The
+latter party set out at five in the afternoon from
+the forks of the Missouri, in a direction nearly east.
+The plain was intersected by several great roads
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_243" id="Page_243">[Pg 243]</a></span>leading to a gap in the mountain about twenty miles
+distant, in a direction east-north-east; but the Indian
+woman, who was acquainted with the country, recommended
+another gap more to the south, through which
+Capt. Clarke determined to proceed.</p>
+
+<p>They started early the next morning, and, pursuing
+the route recommended by the squaw, encamped in
+the evening at the entrance of the gap mentioned by
+her. Through this gap they passed next day, and,
+at the distance of six miles, reached the top of the
+dividing ridge which separates the waters of the Missouri
+from those of the Yellowstone. Nine miles
+from the summit, they reached the Yellowstone itself,
+about a mile and a half below where it issues from
+the Rocky Mountains. The distance from the head
+of the Missouri to this place is forty-eight miles, the
+greater part of which is through a level plain. They
+halted for three hours to rest their horses, and then
+pursued the Buffalo Road along the banks of the
+river.</p>
+
+<p>Although but just emerging from a high, snowy
+mountain, the Yellowstone is here a bold, rapid, and
+deep stream, one hundred and twenty yards in width.
+They continued their course along the river till the
+23d, when the party embarked on board of two <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_244" id="Page_244">[Pg 244]</a></span>canoes,
+each of which was twenty-eight feet long, sixteen
+or eighteen inches deep, and from sixteen to
+twenty-four inches wide. Sergt. Prior, with two men,
+was directed to take the horses to the Mandans for
+safe keeping until the re-union of the expedition.</p>
+
+<p>July 24.&mdash;At eight o'clock, Capt. Clarke and the
+remainder of his party embarked, and proceeded very
+steadily down the river. They passed the mouths of
+several large rivers emptying into the Yellowstone;
+one of which was called the Big-horn, from the numbers
+of that remarkable species of sheep seen in its
+neighborhood. Next day, Capt. Clarke landed to examine
+a curious rock, situated in an extensive bottom
+on the right, about two hundred and fifty paces from
+the shore. It is nearly two hundred paces in circumference,
+two hundred feet high, and accessible only from
+the north-east; the other sides consisting of perpendicular
+cliffs, of a light-colored, gritty stone. The
+soil on the summit is five or six feet deep, of a good
+quality, and covered with short grass. From this
+height, the eye ranges over a wide extent of variegated
+country. On the south-west are the Rocky
+Mountains, covered with snow; on the north, a lower
+range, called the Little Wolf Mountains. The low
+grounds of the river extend nearly six miles to the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_245" id="Page_245">[Pg 245]</a></span>southward, when they rise into plains, reaching to
+the mountains. The north side of the river is bounded
+by jutting, romantic cliffs, beyond which the plains
+are open and extensive, and the whole country enlivened
+by herds of buffaloes, elks, and wolves. After
+enjoying the prospect from this rock, to which Capt.
+Clarke gave the name of Pompey's Pillar, he descended,
+and continued his route. At the distance
+of six or seven miles, he stopped to secure two bighorns,
+which had been shot from the boat, and, while
+on shore, saw in the face of the cliff, about twenty
+feet above the water, a fragment of the rib of a fish,
+three feet long, and nearly three inches round, embedded
+in the rock itself.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">BEAVERS, BUFFALOES, MOSQUITOES.</p>
+
+<p>The beavers were in great numbers along the
+banks of the river, and through the night were flapping
+their tails in the water round the boats.</p>
+
+<p>Aug. 1.&mdash;The buffaloes appeared in vast numbers.
+A herd happened to be on their way across the river.
+Such was the multitude of these animals, that although
+the river, including an island over which
+they passed, was a mile in width, the herd stretched,
+as thick as they could swim, completely from one
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_246" id="Page_246">[Pg 246]</a></span>side to the other. Our party, descending the river,
+was obliged to stop for an hour to let the procession
+pass. We consoled ourselves for the delay by killing
+four of the herd, and then proceeded, till, at the distance
+of forty-five miles, two other herds of buffaloes,
+as numerous as the first, crossed the river in like
+manner.</p>
+
+<p>Aug. 4.&mdash;The camp became absolutely uninhabitable,
+in consequence of the multitude of mosquitoes.
+The men could not work in preparing skins for clothing,
+nor hunt in the low grounds: in short, there was
+no mode of escape, except by going on the sand bars
+in the river, where, if the wind should blow, the
+insects do not venture. But when there is no wind,
+and particularly at night, when the men have no covering
+except their worn-out blankets, the pain they
+inflict is scarcely to be endured.</p>
+
+<p>On one occasion, Capt. Clarke went on shore, and
+ascended a hill after one of the bighorns; but the
+mosquitoes were in such multitudes, that he could not
+keep them from the barrel of his rifle long enough to
+take aim.</p>
+
+<p>This annoyance continued, till, on the 11th of September,
+they write, "We are no longer troubled with
+mosquitoes, which do not seem to frequent this part
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_247" id="Page_247">[Pg 247]</a></span>of the river; and, after having been persecuted with
+them during the whole route from the falls, it is a
+most happy exemption. Their noise was very agreeably
+exchanged for that of the wolves, which were
+howling in various directions all round us."</p>
+
+<p>Aug. 12, 1806.&mdash;The party continued to descend
+the river. One of their canoes had, by accident, a
+small hole made in it; and they halted for the purpose
+of covering it with a piece of elk-skin. While there,
+about noon, they were overjoyed at seeing the boats
+of Capt. Lewis's party heave in sight. The whole
+expedition being now happily re-united, at about
+three o'clock all embarked on board the boats; but
+as the wind was high, accompanied with rain, we did
+not proceed far before we halted for the night.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THEY PART WITH SOME OF THEIR COMPANIONS.</p>
+
+<p>On the 14th August, having now reached a part of
+the river where we occasionally met the boats of adventurous
+traders ascending the river, Capt. Lewis
+was applied to by one of the men, Colter, who was
+desirous of joining two trappers, who proposed to
+him to accompany them, and share their profits. The
+offer was an advantageous one; and as he had always
+performed his duty, and his services might be <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_248" id="Page_248">[Pg 248]</a></span>dispensed
+with, Capt. Lewis consented to his going, provided
+none of the rest would ask or expect a similar
+indulgence. To this they cheerfully answered, that
+they wished Colter every success, and would not
+apply for a discharge before we reached St. Louis.
+We therefore supplied him, as did his comrades also,
+with powder and lead, and a variety of articles which
+might be useful to him; and he left us the next day.</p>
+
+<p>The example of this man shows how easily men
+may be weaned from the habits of civilized life, and
+brought to relish the manners of the woods. This
+hunter had now been absent many years from his
+country, and might naturally be presumed to have
+some desire to return to his native seats; yet, just at
+the moment when he is approaching the frontiers, he
+is tempted by a hunting-scheme to go back to the
+solitude of the woods.</p>
+
+<p>A few days after this, Chaboneau, with his wife
+and child, concluded to follow us no longer, as he
+could be no longer useful to us. We offered to take
+him with us to the United States; but he said that he
+had there no acquaintance, and preferred remaining
+among the Indians. This man has been very serviceable
+to us, and his wife particularly so, among
+the Shoshonees. She has borne with a patience truly
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_249" id="Page_249">[Pg 249]</a></span>admirable the fatigues of our long journey, encumbered
+with the charge of an infant, which is now
+only nineteen months old. We paid him his wages,
+amounting to five hundred dollars and thirty-three
+cents, including the price of a horse and a lodge purchased
+of him, and pursued our journey without him.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THEY REACH HOME.</p>
+
+<p>Sept. 8, 1806.&mdash;We reached Council Bluffs, and
+stopped for a short time to examine the situation of
+the place, and were confirmed in our belief that it
+would be a very eligible spot for a trading establishment.<a name="FNanchor_4_4" id="FNanchor_4_4"></a><a href="#Footnote_4_4" class="fnanchor">[4]</a>
+Being anxious to reach the junction of the
+Platte River, we plied our oars so well, that by night
+we had made seventy-eight miles, and landed at our
+old encampment, on the ascent, twelve miles above
+that river. We had here occasion to remark the
+wonderful evaporation from the Missouri. The river
+does not appear to contain more water, nor is its
+channel wider, than at the distance of one thousand
+miles nearer its source, although within that space
+it receives about twenty rivers (some of them of
+considerable width), and a great number of smaller
+streams.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_250" id="Page_250">[Pg 250]</a></span>A few days more brought us to the mouth of the
+Kansas River. About a mile below it, we landed to
+view the country. The low grounds are delightful,
+the whole country exhibiting a rich appearance; but
+the weather was oppressively warm. Descending as
+we had done from a high, open country, between the
+latitudes of forty-six and forty-nine degrees, to the
+wooded plains in thirty-eight and thirty-nine degrees,
+the heat would have been intolerable, had it not been
+for the constant winds from the south and the south-west.</p>
+
+<p>On the 20th September, we reached the mouth of
+Osage River. A few miles lower down, we saw on
+the banks some cows feeding; and the whole party
+involuntarily raised a shout of joy at the sight of this
+evidence of civilization and domestic life.</p>
+
+<p>We soon after reached the little French village of
+La Charette, which we saluted with a discharge of
+four guns and three hearty cheers. We landed, and
+were received with kindness by the inhabitants, as
+well as by some traders who were on their way to
+traffic with the Osages. They were all surprised and
+pleased at our arrival; for they had long since abandoned
+all hopes of ever seeing us return.</p>
+
+<p>The third day after this,&mdash;viz., on Tuesday, the 23d
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_251" id="Page_251">[Pg 251]</a></span>of September, 1806,&mdash;we arrived at St. Louis, and,
+having fired a salute, went on shore, and received
+the heartiest and most hospitable welcome from the
+whole village.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">CONCLUSION.</p>
+
+<p>The successful termination of the expedition was a
+source of surprise and delight to the whole country.
+The humblest of its citizens had taken a lively interest
+in the issue of this journey, and looked forward
+with impatience for the information it would furnish.
+Their anxieties, too, for the safety of the party, had
+been kept in a state of excitement by lugubrious
+rumors, circulated from time to time on uncertain
+authorities, and uncontradicted by letters or other
+direct information, from the time when the party left
+the Mandan towns, on their ascent up the river, in
+1804, until their actual return to St. Louis.</p>
+
+<p>The courage, perseverance, and discretion displayed
+by the commanders, and the fidelity and
+obedience of the men, were the theme of general
+approbation, and received the favorable notice of
+Government. A donation of lands was made to each
+member of the party; Capt. Lewis was appointed
+Governor of Louisiana, which, at that time, embraced
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_252" id="Page_252">[Pg 252]</a></span>the whole country west of the Mississippi, within the
+boundaries of the United States; and Capt. Clarke
+was made Superintendent of Indian Affairs.</p>
+
+<p>It was not until some years after, however, that
+the world was put in possession of the detailed history
+of the expedition. Capt. Lewis, in the midst of
+other cares, devoted what time he could to the preparation
+of his journals for publication, and, in 1809, was
+on his way to Philadelphia for that purpose, but, at
+a village in Tennessee, was taken ill, and prevented
+from proceeding. Here the energetic mind, which
+had encountered so unfalteringly the perils and sufferings
+of the desert, gave way. Constitutional despondency
+overcame him: it is probable he lost his
+reason; for, in a rash moment, he applied a pistol to
+his head, and destroyed his life. His journals were
+published under the charge of Paul Allen of Philadelphia.</p>
+
+<h4>FOOTNOTE:</h4>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p class="noin"><a name="Footnote_4_4" id="Footnote_4_4"></a><a href="#FNanchor_4_4"><span class="label">[4]</span></a> Now the site of Omaha City.</p></div>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_253" id="Page_253">[Pg 253]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>ELDORADO.</h2>
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_254" id="Page_254">[Pg 254]</a></span>
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_255" id="Page_255">[Pg 255]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>ELDORADO</h2>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER I.</h2>
+
+<h3>THE DISCOVERY.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>What is meant by Eldorado? Is there such a
+country? and, if there be, where is it? The
+name literally means "The Golden Country," and
+was given to an unknown region in South America
+by the Spaniards, who had heard from the Indians
+marvellous tales of such a land lying in the interior
+of the continent, where gold and precious stones
+were as common as rocks and pebbles in other countries,
+and to be had for the trouble of picking them
+up. It was also a land of spices and aromatic gums.
+The first notion of this favored region was communicated
+by an Indian chief to Gonzalo Pizarro, brother
+of the conqueror of Peru, whose imagination was captivated
+by the account, and his ambition fired with a
+desire to add this, which promised to be the most <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_256" id="Page_256">[Pg 256]</a></span>brilliant
+of all, to the discoveries and conquests of his
+countrymen. He found no difficulty in awakening a
+kindred enthusiasm in the bosoms of his followers.
+In a short time, he mustered three hundred and fifty
+Spaniards, and four thousand Indians. One hundred
+and fifty of his company were mounted. The Indians
+were to carry the baggage and provisions, and perform
+the labors of the expedition.</p>
+
+<p>A glance at the map of South America will give
+us a clear idea of the scene of the expedition. The
+River Amazon, the largest river of the globe, rises in
+the highest ranges of the Andes, and flows from west
+to east through nearly the whole breadth of the continent.
+Pizarro's expedition started in the year 1540
+from Quito, near the sources of the great river, and,
+marching east, soon became entangled in the deep
+and intricate passes of the mountains. As they rose
+into the more elevated regions, the icy winds that
+swept down the sides of the Cordilleras benumbed
+their limbs, and many of the natives found a wintry
+grave in the wilderness. On descending the eastern
+slope, the climate changed; and, as they came to a
+lower level, the fierce cold was succeeded by a suffocating
+heat, while tempests of thunder and lightning
+poured on them with scarcely any intermission day
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_257" id="Page_257">[Pg 257]</a></span>or night. For more than six weeks, the deluge continued
+unabated; and the forlorn wanderers, wet, and
+weary with incessant toil, were scarcely able to drag
+their limbs along the soil, broken up as it was, and
+saturated with the moisture. After months of toilsome
+travel, they reached the region where grew the
+spice-trees. Their produce resembled the cinnamon
+of the East in taste, but was of inferior quality. They
+saw the trees bearing the precious bark spreading out
+into broad forests; yet, however valuable it might be
+for future commerce, it was of but little worth to them.
+But, from the savages whom they occasionally met,
+they learned, that at ten days' distance was a rich
+and fruitful land, abounding with gold, and inhabited
+by populous nations. The Spaniards were so convinced
+of the existence of such a country, that if the
+natives, on being questioned, professed their ignorance
+of it, they were supposed to be desirous of
+concealing the fact, and were put to the most horrible
+tortures, and even burnt alive, to compel them to
+confess. It is no wonder, therefore, if they told, in
+many instances, such stories as the Spaniards wished
+to hear, which would also have the effect of ridding
+their own territories of their troublesome guests by
+inducing them to advance farther. Pizarro had <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_258" id="Page_258">[Pg 258]</a></span>already
+reached the limit originally proposed for the
+expedition; but these accounts induced him to continue
+on.</p>
+
+<p>As they advanced, the country spread out into
+broad plains, terminated by forests, which seemed to
+stretch on every side as far as the eye could reach.
+The wood was thickly matted with creepers and
+climbing plants, and at every step of the way they
+had to hew open a passage with their axes; while
+their garments, rotting from the effects of the drenching
+rains, caught in every bush, and hung about them
+in shreds. Their provisions failed, and they had only
+for sustenance such herbs and roots as they could
+gather in the forest, and such wild animals as, with
+their inadequate means, they could capture.</p>
+
+<p>At length they came to a broad expanse of water,
+from whence flowed a stream,&mdash;one of those which
+discharge their waters into the great River Amazon.
+The sight gladdened their hearts, as they hoped to
+find a safer and more practicable route by keeping
+along its banks. After following the stream a considerable
+distance, the party came within hearing of
+a rushing noise, that seemed like thunder issuing
+from the bowels of the earth. The river tumbled
+along over rapids with frightful velocity, and then
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_259" id="Page_259">[Pg 259]</a></span>discharged itself in a magnificent cataract, which
+they describe as twelve hundred feet high. Doubtless
+this estimate must be taken with some allowance
+for the excited feelings of the Spaniards, keenly alive
+to impressions of the sublime and the terrible.</p>
+
+<p>For some distance above and below the falls, the
+bed of the river contracted; so that its width did not
+exceed twenty feet. They determined to cross, in
+hopes of finding a country that might afford them
+better sustenance. A frail bridge was constructed
+by throwing trunks of trees across the chasm, where
+the cliffs, as if split asunder by some convulsion of
+Nature, descended sheer down a perpendicular depth
+of several hundred feet. Over this airy causeway,
+the men and horses succeeded in effecting their passage;
+though one Spaniard, made giddy by heedlessly
+looking down, lost his footing, and fell into the boiling
+surges below. They gained little by the exchange.
+The country wore the same unpromising aspect: the
+Indians whom they occasionally met in the pathless
+wilderness were fierce and unfriendly, and the Spaniards
+were engaged in perpetual conflict with them.
+From these they learned that a fruitful country was
+to be found down the river, at the distance of only a
+few days' journey; and the Spaniards held on their
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_260" id="Page_260">[Pg 260]</a></span>weary way, still hoping, and still deceived, as the
+promised land flitted before them, like the rainbow,
+receding as they advanced.</p>
+
+<p>At length, spent with toil and suffering, Pizarro
+resolved to construct a bark large enough to transport
+the weaker part of his company and his baggage.
+The forests furnished him with timber; the
+shoes of the horses, which had died on the road, or
+been slaughtered for food, were converted into nails;
+gum, distilled from the trees, took the place of pitch;
+and the tattered garments of the soldiers served for
+oakum. At the end of two months, the vessel was
+ready, and the command given to Francisco Orellana.
+The troops now moved forward through the wilderness,
+following the course of the river; the vessel
+carrying the feebler soldiers. Every scrap of provisions
+had long since been consumed. The last of
+their horses had been devoured; and they greedily
+fed upon toads, serpents, and even insects, which that
+country, teeming with the lower forms of animal life,
+abundantly supplied.</p>
+
+<p>The natives still told of a rich district, inhabited by
+a populous nation. It was, as usual, at the distance of
+several days' journey; and Pizarro resolved to halt
+where he was, and send Orellana down in his <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_261" id="Page_261">[Pg 261]</a></span>brigantine
+to procure a stock of provisions, with which he
+might return, and put the main body in condition to
+resume their march. Orellana, with fifty of the adventurers,
+pushed off into the middle of the river,
+where the stream ran swiftly; and his bark, taken
+by the current, shot forward as with the speed of an
+arrow, and was soon out of sight.</p>
+
+<p>Days and weeks passed away, yet the vessel did
+not return; and no speck was to be seen on the
+waters as the Spaniards strained their eyes to the
+farthest point, till the banks closed in, and shut
+the view. Detachments were sent out, and, though
+absent several days, came back without intelligence
+of their comrades. Weary of suspense, Pizarro determined
+to continue their march down the river,
+which they did, with incredible suffering, for two
+months longer, till their doubts were dispelled by
+the appearance of a white man, wandering, half naked,
+in the woods, in whose famine-stricken countenance
+they recognized the features of one of their countrymen.
+Orellana had passed swiftly down the river to
+the point of its confluence with the Amazon, where
+he had been led to expect that he should find supplies
+for the wants of himself and his companions,
+but found none. Nor was it possible to return as he
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_262" id="Page_262">[Pg 262]</a></span>had come, and make head against the current of the
+river. In this dilemma, a thought flashed across his
+mind: it was, to leave the party under Pizarro to
+their fate, and to pursue his course down the great
+river on which he had entered; to explore Eldorado
+for himself, and make the best of his way home to
+Spain to claim the glory and reward of discovery.
+His reckless companions readily consented to this
+course, with the exception of the individual whom
+Pizarro found; and him, when he remonstrated, they
+put ashore, and left to shift for himself.</p>
+
+<p>Pizarro and his party, deserted in the wilderness,
+unable to advance farther, had no alternative but to
+remain, or retrace their miserable way to Quito, the
+place they had started from more than a year before.
+They chose the latter, and commenced their return
+march with heavy hearts. They took a more northerly
+route than that by which they had approached
+the Amazon; and, though it was attended with fewer
+difficulties, they experienced yet greater distresses,
+from their greater inability to overcome them. Their
+only food was such scanty fare as they could pick up
+in the forest, or happily meet with in some forsaken
+Indian settlement, or wring by violence from the
+natives. Some sickened and sank down by the way,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_263" id="Page_263">[Pg 263]</a></span>and perished where they fell; for there was none to
+help them. Intense misery had made them selfish;
+and many a poor wretch was abandoned to his fate, to
+die alone in the wilderness, or, more probably, to be
+devoured, while living, by the wild animals which
+roamed over it.</p>
+
+<p>It took them a year to measure back their way to
+Quito; and the miseries they had endured were testified
+to by their appearance when they arrived, in
+sadly reduced numbers, at the place of their starting.
+Their horses gone, their arms broken and rusted, the
+skins of wild animals their only clothes, their long
+and matted locks streaming wildly down their shoulders,
+their faces blackened by the tropical sun, their
+bodies wasted by famine and disfigured by scars, it
+seemed as if the charnel-house had given up its dead,
+as, with unsteady step, they crept slowly onwards.
+More than half of the four thousand Indians who had
+accompanied the expedition had perished; and of the
+Spaniards, only eighty, and many of these irretrievably
+broken in constitution, found their way back to
+Quito.</p>
+
+<p>Meanwhile, Orellana glided down the stream, which
+then was nameless and unknown, but which has since
+been called by his name, though it is more generally
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_264" id="Page_264">[Pg 264]</a></span>known by a name derived from a story which Orellana
+told, in his account of his voyage, of a nation of Amazons
+inhabiting its banks. But an account of Orellana's
+adventures must be reserved for our next
+chapter.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_265" id="Page_265">[Pg 265]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER II.</h2>
+
+<h3>ORELLANA DESCENDS THE RIVER.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>When Orellana, in his ill-appointed bark, and
+with his crew enfeebled by famine, had
+reached the junction of the River Napo with the Amazon,
+and found no sources of supply which he had
+been led to expect, he had no difficulty in satisfying
+his companions that their only chance of preservation
+was in continuing their descent of the river, and leaving
+the party under Pizarro to their fate. He then
+formally renounced the commission which Pizarro had
+given him, and received the command anew from the
+election of his men, that so he might make discoveries
+for himself, and not, holding a deputed authority,
+in the name of another. It was upon the last day of
+December, 1541, that this voyage was begun,&mdash;one of
+the most adventurous that has ever been undertaken.
+The little stock of provisions with which they had
+parted from the army was already exhausted, and they
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_266" id="Page_266">[Pg 266]</a></span>boiled their leathern girdles and the leather of their
+shoes with such herbs as seemed most likely to be
+nourishing and harmless; for it was only by experiment
+that they were able to distinguish the wholesome
+from the poisonous. On the 8th of January,
+being reduced almost to the last extremity with hunger,
+they heard before daylight an Indian drum,&mdash;a
+joyful sound; for be the natives what they would,
+friendly or hostile, this they knew, that it must be
+their own fault now if they should die of hunger. At
+daybreak, being eagerly upon the lookout, they perceived
+four canoes, which put back upon seeing the
+brigantine; and presently they saw a village where
+a great body of the natives were assembled, and appeared
+ready to defend it. The Spaniards were too
+hungry to negotiate. Orellana bade them land in
+good order, and stand by each other. They attacked
+the Indians like men who were famishing, and fought
+for food, put them speedily to the rout, and found an
+immediate supply. While they were enjoying the
+fruits of their victory, the Indians came near them,
+more to gratify curiosity than resentment. Orellana
+spoke to them in some Indian language which they
+partly understood. Some of them took courage, and
+approached him. He gave them a few European
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_267" id="Page_267">[Pg 267]</a></span>trifles, and asked for their chief, who came without
+hesitation, was well pleased with the presents which
+were given him, and offered them any thing which it
+was in his power to supply. Provisions were requested;
+and presently peacocks, partridges, fish, and
+other things, were brought in great abundance. The
+next day, thirteen chiefs came to see the strangers.
+They were gayly adorned with feathers and gold, and
+had plates of gold upon the breast. Orellana received
+them courteously, required them to acknowledge
+obedience to the crown of Castile, took advantage as
+usual of their ignorance to affirm that they consented,
+and took possession of their country in the emperor's
+name.</p>
+
+<p>Such is Orellana's own account of this first interview.
+It was his object to create a high idea of the
+riches of the provinces which he had discovered. It
+is not probable that these tribes had any gold; for
+later discoveries showed that none of the tribes on the
+Amazon were so far advanced as to use it. It was
+here that they heard the first accounts of the rich and
+powerful nation composed wholly of women, whom,
+in recollection of the female warriors of classic antiquity,
+they called the Amazons. Here the Spaniards
+built a better brigantine than the frail one in which
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_268" id="Page_268">[Pg 268]</a></span>they were embarked. All fell to work, Orellana being
+the first at any exertion that was required. They
+calked it with cotton; the natives supplied pitch;
+and in thirty-five days the vessel was launched. On
+the 24th of April, they once more embarked. For
+eighty leagues, the banks were peopled with friendly
+tribes; then the course of the river lay between desert
+mountains, and they were fain to feed upon herbs
+and parched corn, not even finding a place where
+they could fish.</p>
+
+<p>Thus far they seem to have found the natives
+friendly, or not actively hostile; but, as they descended,
+they came to a populous province, belonging to a
+chief called Omagua, if, as is conjectured, that is not
+rather the name of the tribe itself than of their chief.
+One morning, a fleet of canoes was seen advancing
+with hostile demonstrations. The Indians carried
+shields made of the skins of the alligator. They came
+on with beat of tambour and with war-cries, threatening
+to devour the strangers. The Spaniards brought
+their two vessels close together, that they might aid
+one another in the defence. But, when they came to
+use their powder, it was damp, and they had nothing
+but their cross-bows to trust to; and, plying these as
+well as they could, they continued to fall down the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_269" id="Page_269">[Pg 269]</a></span>stream, fighting as they went. Presently they came
+to an Indian town. Half the Spaniards landed to
+attack it, leaving their companions to maintain the
+fight upon the water.</p>
+
+<p>They won the town, and loaded themselves with
+provisions; but eighteen of the party were wounded,
+and one killed. They had neither surgeon nor any
+remedy for the wounded. Nothing could be done for
+them except "psalming;" that is, repeating some
+verses of the psalms over the wound. This mode of
+treatment was not unusual; and, as it was less absurd
+than the methods which were ordinarily in use at that
+day, it is no wonder if it proved more successful.</p>
+
+<p>For two days and two nights after this, they were
+constantly annoyed by the canoes of the natives following,
+and endeavoring to board them. But the
+Spaniards had now dried some powder; and one of
+them, getting a steady mark at the chief of the Indians,
+shot him in the breast. His people gathered
+round him; and, while they were thus occupied, the
+brigantines shot ahead.</p>
+
+<p>Thus they proceeded with alternate good and evil
+fortune, now finding the Indians friendly, and supplies
+of provisions abundant; and then encountering hostile
+tribes which assailed them with all their power, or
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_270" id="Page_270">[Pg 270]</a></span>long regions of unpeopled country, where they were
+reduced to the utmost straits for want of food. Six
+months had now been consumed on their voyage, and
+as yet no appearance of Eldorado; though, if their accounts
+may be trusted, they several times came upon
+populous places, which had many streets, all opening
+upon the river, and apparently leading to some
+greater city in the interior. On the 22d of June, on
+turning an angle of the river, they saw the country
+far before them, and great numbers of people collected,
+seemingly with hostile intentions. Orellana
+offered them trinkets, at which they scoffed; but he
+persisted in making towards the shore to get food,
+either by persuasion or force. A shower of arrows
+was discharged from the shore, which wounded five
+of the crew. They nevertheless landed, and, after a
+hot contest, repulsed the natives, killing some seven
+or eight of them. The historian of the voyage, who
+was one of the adventurers, affirms that ten or twelve
+Amazons fought at the head of these people, who
+were their subjects, and fought desperately; because
+any one who fled in battle would be beaten to death
+by these female tyrants. He describes the women
+as very tall and large-limbed, white of complexion, the
+hair long, platted, and banded round the head. It is
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_271" id="Page_271">[Pg 271]</a></span>amusing to observe how this story was magnified by
+later narrators, who learned it only by tradition. It
+is stated in these late accounts that Orellana fought
+on this occasion with a great army of women.</p>
+
+<p>Of a prisoner whom they took, Orellana asked questions
+about Eldorado and the Amazons, and got, as
+usual, such answers as he expected. This may partly
+be set down to the score of self-deception, and partly
+to the fact that they conversed with these people by
+signs, and by means of the few words of their language
+which the Spaniards knew, or supposed they
+knew, the meaning of. He learned from the prisoner
+that the country was subject to women, who lived
+after the manner of the Amazons of the ancients, and
+who possessed gold and silver in abundance. There
+were in their dominions fine temples of the sun, all
+covered with plates of gold. Their houses were of
+stone, and their cities walled. We can hardly doubt
+that the desire to tempt adventurers to join him in
+his subsequent expedition to conquer and colonize
+those countries had its effect in magnifying these
+marvels.</p>
+
+<p>Shortly after this, the Spaniards thought they perceived
+the <i>tide</i>. After another day's voyage, they
+came to some inhabited islands, and, to their infinite
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_272" id="Page_272">[Pg 272]</a></span>joy, saw that they had not been mistaken; for the
+marks of the tide here were certain. Here they lost
+another of their party in a skirmish with the natives.
+From this place the country was low; and they could
+never venture to land, except upon the islands, among
+which they sailed, as they supposed, about two hundred
+leagues; the tide coming up with great force.
+One day the smaller vessel struck upon a snag, which
+stove in one of her planks, and she filled. They, however,
+landed to seek for provisions; but the inhabitants
+attacked them with such force, that they were
+forced to retire; and, when they came to their vessels,
+they found that the tide had left the only serviceable
+one dry. Orellana ordered half his men to fight, and
+the other half to thrust the vessel into the water:
+that done, they righted the old brigantine, and fastened
+in a new plank, all which was completed in three
+hours, by which time the Indians were weary of fighting,
+and left them in peace. The next day they found
+a desert place, where Orellana halted to repair both
+vessels. This took them eighteen days, during which
+they suffered much from hunger.</p>
+
+<p>As they drew near the sea, they halted again for
+fourteen days, to prepare for their sea-voyage; made
+cordage of herbs; and sewed the cloaks, on which they
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_273" id="Page_273">[Pg 273]</a></span>slept, into sails. On the 8th of August, they proceeded
+again, anchoring with stones when the tide
+turned, though it sometimes came in such strength as
+to drag these miserable anchors. Here the natives
+were happily of a milder mood than those whom they
+had lately dealt with. From them they procured
+roots and Indian corn; and, having laid in what store
+they could, they made ready to enter upon the sea in
+these frail vessels, with their miserable tackling, and
+with insufficient food, without pilot, compass, or any
+knowledge of the coast.</p>
+
+<p>It was on the 26th of August that they sailed out
+of the river, passing between two islands, which were
+about four leagues asunder. The whole length of the
+voyage from the place where they had embarked to
+the sea they computed at eighteen hundred leagues.
+Thus far their weather had been always favorable,
+and it did not fail them now. They kept along the
+coast to the northward, just at safe distance. The
+two brigantines parted company in the night. They
+in the larger one got into the Gulf of Paria, from
+whence all their labor at the oar for seven days could
+not extricate them. During this time, they lived upon
+a sort of plum called "nogos," being the only food
+they could find. At length they were whirled
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_274" id="Page_274">[Pg 274]</a></span>through those tremendous channels which Columbus
+called the "Dragon's mouths," and, September the
+11th, not knowing where they were, reached the
+Island of Cubagua, where they found a colony of their
+countrymen. The old brigantine had arrived at the
+same place two days before them. Here they were
+received with the welcome which their wonderful
+adventure deserved; and from hence Orellana proceeded
+to Spain, to give the king an account of his
+discoveries in person.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_275" id="Page_275">[Pg 275]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER III.</h2>
+
+<h3>ORELLANA'S ADVENTURE CONTINUED.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>Orellana arrived safe in Spain, and was favorably
+received. His act of insubordination in
+leaving his commander was forgotten in the success
+of his achievement; for it had been successful, even
+if the naked facts only had been told, inasmuch as it
+was the first event which led to any certain knowledge
+of the immense regions that stretch eastward
+from the Andes to the ocean, besides being in itself
+one of the most brilliant adventures of that remarkable
+age. But Orellana's accounts went far beyond
+these limits, and confirming all previous tales of the
+wonderful Eldorado, with its temples roofed with
+gold, and its mountains composed of precious stones,
+drew to his standard numerous followers. Every
+thing promised fairly. The king granted him a commission
+to conquer the countries which he had explored.
+He raised funds for the expedition, and even
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_276" id="Page_276">[Pg 276]</a></span>found a wife who was willing to accompany him in
+May, 1544, he set sail with four ships and four hundred
+men.</p>
+
+<p>But the tide of Orellana's fortune had turned. He
+stopped three months at Teneriffe, and two at the
+Cape de Verde, where ninety-eight of his people died,
+and fifty were invalided. The expedition proceeded
+with three ships, and met with contrary winds, which
+detained them till their water was exhausted; and, had
+it not been for heavy rains, all must have perished.
+One ship put back in this distress, with seventy men
+and eleven horses on board, and was never heard of
+after. The remaining two reached the river. Having
+ascended about a hundred leagues, they stopped
+to build a brigantine. Provisions were scarce here,
+and fifty-seven more of his party died. These men
+were not, like his former comrades, seasoned to the
+climate, and habituated to the difficulties of the new
+world. One ship was broken up here for the materials:
+the other met with an accident, and became
+unserviceable; and they cut her up, and made a bark
+of the timbers.</p>
+
+<p>Orellana meanwhile, in the brigantine, was endeavoring
+to discover the main branch of the river, which
+it had been easy to keep when carried down by the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_277" id="Page_277">[Pg 277]</a></span>stream, but which he now sought in vain for thirty
+days among a labyrinth of channels. When he returned
+from this fruitless search, he was ill, and told
+his people that he would go back to Point St. Juan;
+and there he ordered them to seek him when they
+had got the bark ready. But he found his sickness
+increase upon him, and determined to abandon the
+expedition, and return to Europe. While he was
+seeking provisions for the voyage, the Indians killed
+seventeen of his men. What with vexation and disorder,
+he died in the river. This sealed the fate of
+the expedition. The survivors made no further exertions
+to reach Eldorado, but returned to their own
+country as they could. Such was the fate of Orellana,
+who, as a discoverer, surpassed all his countrymen;
+and though, as a conqueror, he was unfortunate,
+yet neither is he chargeable with any of those atrocities
+toward the unhappy natives which have left such
+a stain on the glories of Cortes and Pizarro.</p>
+
+<p>The next attempt we read of to discover Eldorado
+was made a few years after, under Hernando de Ribera,
+by ascending the La Plata, or River of Paraguay.
+He sailed in a brigantine with eighty men,
+and encountered no hostility from the natives. They
+confirmed the stories of the Amazons with their
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_278" id="Page_278">[Pg 278]</a></span>golden city. "How could they get at them?" was
+the next question: "by land, or by water?"&mdash;"Only
+by land," was the reply. "But it was a two-months'
+journey; and to reach them now would be impossible,
+because the country was inundated." The Spaniards
+made light of this obstacle, but asked for Indians
+to carry their baggage. The chief gave Ribera
+twenty for himself, and five for each of his men; and
+these desperate adventurers set off on their march
+over a flooded country.</p>
+
+<p>Eight days they travelled through water up to
+their knees, and sometimes up to their middle. By
+slinging their hammocks to trees, and by this means
+only, could they find dry positions for the night.
+Before they could make a fire to dress their food,
+they were obliged to raise a rude scaffolding; and
+this was unavoidably so insecure, that frequently the
+fire burned through, and food and all fell into the
+water. They reached another tribe, and were told
+that the Amazons' country was still nine days farther
+on; and then still another tribe, who told them it
+would take a month to reach them. Perhaps they
+would still have advanced; but here an insuperable
+obstacle met them. The locusts for two successive
+years had devoured every thing before them, and no
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_279" id="Page_279">[Pg 279]</a></span>food was to be had. The Spaniards had no alternative
+but to march back. On their way, they were reduced
+to great distress for want of food; and from
+this cause, and travelling so long half under water,
+the greater number fell sick, and many died. Of
+eighty men who accompanied Ribera upon this dreadful
+march, only thirty recovered from its effects.</p>
+
+<p>This expedition added a few items to the story of
+Eldorado. Ribera declares under oath that the natives
+told him of a nation of women, governed by a
+woman, and so warlike as to be dreaded by all their
+neighbors. They possessed plenty of white and yellow
+metal: their seats, and all the utensils in their
+houses, were made of them. They lived on a large
+island, which was in a huge lake, which they called
+the "Mansion of the Sun," because the sun sank into
+it. The only way of accounting for these stories is,
+that the Spaniards furnished, in the shape of questions,
+the information which they fancied they received
+in reply; the Indians assenting to what they
+understood but imperfectly, or not at all.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">MARTINEZ.</p>
+
+<p>Another expedition, not long after Orellana's, was
+that conducted by Don Diego Ordaz, of which Sir
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_280" id="Page_280">[Pg 280]</a></span>Walter Raleigh, in his "History of Guiana," gives an
+account. The expedition failed; Ordaz being slain
+in a mutiny of his men, and those who went with him
+being scattered. The only noticeable result was in
+the adventures of one Martinez, an officer of Ordaz,
+who had charge of the ammunition. We tell the
+story in the language of Sir Walter, slightly modernized:&mdash;</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>"It chanced, that while Ordaz, with his army, rested at the
+port of Morequito, by some negligence the whole store of powder
+provided for the service was set on fire; and Martinez, having
+the chief charge thereof, was condemned by the general to
+be executed forthwith. Martinez, being much favored by the
+soldiers, had all means possible employed to save his life; but it
+could not be obtained in other way but this,&mdash;that he should
+be set into a canoe alone, without any food, and so turned loose
+into the great river. But it pleased God that the canoe was carried
+down the stream, and that certain of the Guianians met it the
+same evening: and, not having at any time seen any European,
+they carried Martinez into the land to be wondered at; and so
+from town to town until he came to the great city of Manoa,
+the seat and residence of Inga, the emperor. The emperor,
+when he beheld him, knew him to be a Christian of those who
+had conquered the neighboring country of Peru, and caused
+him to be lodged in his palace, and well entertained. He lived
+seven months in Manoa, but was not suffered to wander into
+the country anywhere. He was also brought thither all the
+way blindfolded by the Indians, until he came to the entrance
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_281" id="Page_281">[Pg 281]</a></span>of Manoa itself. He avowed at his death that he entered the
+city at noon, and then they uncovered his face; and that he
+travelled all that day till night through the city, ere he came to
+the palace of Inga.</p>
+
+<p>"After Martinez had lived seven months in Manoa, and began
+to understand the language of the country, Inga asked him
+whether he desired to return to his own country, or would willingly
+abide with him. Martinez, not desirous to stay, obtained
+permission of Inga to depart, who sent with him some Guianians
+to conduct him to the river of Orinoco, with as much gold as
+they could carry, which he gave to Martinez at his departure.
+But, when he arrived at the river's side, the natives, being at
+that time at war with Inga, robbed him and his Guianians of all
+his treasure, save only two bottles made of gourds, which were
+filled with beads of gold, which those people thought to contain
+his drink or food, with which he was at liberty to depart. So,
+in a canoe, he passed down by the river to Trinidad, and from
+thence to Porto Rico, where he died. In the time of his extreme
+sickness, and when he was without hope of life, receiving
+the sacrament at the hands of his confessor, he delivered this
+relation of his travels, and also called for his calabazas, or
+gourds of gold beads, which he gave to the church and the
+friars, to be prayed for.</p>
+
+<p>"This Martinez was the one who christened the city of Manoa
+by the name 'Eldorado,' and upon this occasion. At the times
+of their solemn feasts, when the emperor carouses with his captains,
+tributaries, and governors, the manner is thus: All those
+that pledge him are first stripped naked, and their bodies
+anointed all over with a kind of white balsam very precious.
+When they are anointed all over, certain servants of the <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_282" id="Page_282">[Pg 282]</a></span>emperor,
+having prepared gold made into fine powder, blow it
+through hollow canes upon their naked bodies until they be all
+shining from the head to the foot. Upon this sight, and for the
+abundance of gold which he saw in the city, the images of gold
+in their temples, the plates, armors, and shields of gold which
+they use in the wars, he called it Eldorado."</p></div>
+
+<p>Such is Sir Walter's narrative of one of the traditions
+which fired his enthusiasm to undertake the
+conquest of Eldorado. He asserts that he read it
+in "The Chancery of Saint Juan de Porto Rico," of
+which Berrio had a copy. It is pretty plainly tinctured
+with fable, but probably had an historical foundation.</p>
+
+<p>After this, a good many years elapsed before any
+other expedition of note was fitted out in search of
+Eldorado. But the story grew, notwithstanding. An
+imaginary kingdom was shaped out. It was governed
+by a potentate who was called the Great Paytiti,
+sometimes the Great Moxu, sometimes the Enim, or
+Great Par&aacute;. An impostor at Lima affirmed that he
+had been in his capital, the city of Manoa, where not
+fewer than three thousand workmen were employed
+in the silversmiths' street. He even produced a map
+of the country, in which he had marked a hill of gold,
+another of silver, and a third of salt. The columns
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_283" id="Page_283">[Pg 283]</a></span>of the palace were described as of porphyry and alabaster,
+the galleries of ebony and cedar: the throne
+was of ivory, and the ascent to it by steps of gold.
+The palace was built of white stone. At the entrance
+were two towers, and between them a column
+twenty-five feet in height. On its top was a large
+silver moon; and two living lions were fastened to its
+base with chains of gold. Having passed by these
+keepers, you came into a quadrangle planted with
+trees, and watered by a silver fountain, which spouted
+through four golden pipes. The gate of the palace
+was of copper, and its bolt was received in the solid
+rock. Within, a golden sun was placed upon an altar
+of silver; and four lamps were kept burning before it
+day and night.</p>
+
+<p>It may surprise us that tales so palpably false as
+these should have deceived any, to such an extent
+as to lead them to get up costly and hazardous expeditions
+to go in search of the wonder; but we must
+remember, that what the Spaniards had already realized
+and demonstrated to the world in their conquests
+of Mexico and Peru was hardly less astonishing
+than these accounts. It is therefore no wonder
+that multitudes should be found willing to admit so
+much of the marvels of Eldorado as to see in them
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_284" id="Page_284">[Pg 284]</a></span>a sufficient inducement to justify the search; and
+others less credulous were perhaps willing to avail
+themselves of the credulity of the multitude to accomplish
+plans of conquest and ambition for themselves.
+Of the latter class, we may imagine the
+celebrated Sir Walter Raleigh to be one, who, at this
+time, undertook an expedition for the discovery and
+conquest of Eldorado.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_285" id="Page_285">[Pg 285]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER IV.</h2>
+
+<h3>SIR WALTER RALEIGH.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>Walter Raleigh was born in the year 1552
+in Devonshire, England, and received a good
+education, completed by a residence of two years at
+the University of Oxford. At the age of seventeen,
+he joined a volunteer corps of English to serve in
+France in aid of the Protestant cause. Afterwards
+he served five years in the Netherlands. In 1576, he
+accompanied his half-brother, Sir Humphrey Gilbert,
+on an expedition to colonize some part of North America;
+which expedition was unsuccessful. We next
+find him commanding a company of the royal troops
+in Ireland during the rebellion raised by the Earl of
+Desmond. In consequence of some serious differences
+which arose between him and his superior officer,
+he found it necessary to repair to court to justify
+himself. It was at this time that an incident occurred
+which recommended him to the notice of Queen <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_286" id="Page_286">[Pg 286]</a></span>Elizabeth,
+and was the foundation of his fortunes. Raleigh
+stood in the crowd one day where the queen passed
+on foot; and when she came to a spot of muddy
+ground, and hesitated for a moment where to step,
+he sprang forward, and, throwing from his shoulders
+his handsome cloak ("his clothes being then," says a
+quaint old writer, "a considerable part of his estate"),
+he spread it over the mud, so that the queen passed
+over dry-shod, doubtless giving an approving look to
+the handsome and quick-witted young officer. There
+is another story which is not less probable, because
+it is not less in character with both the parties. Finding
+some hopes of the queen's favor glancing on him,
+he wrote, on a window where it was likely to meet
+her eye,&mdash;</p>
+
+<p class="cen">
+"Fain would I climb, but that I fear to fall."<br />
+</p>
+
+<p>And her majesty, espying it, wrote underneath,&mdash;</p>
+
+<p class="cen">
+"If thy heart fail thee, wherefore climb at all?"<br />
+</p>
+
+<p>His progress in the queen's favor was enhanced by
+his demeanor when the matter in dispute between
+him and his superior officer was brought before the
+privy council, and each party was called upon to plead
+his own cause. "What advantage he had in the case
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_287" id="Page_287">[Pg 287]</a></span>in controversy," says a contemporary writer, "I know
+not; but he had much the better in the manner of telling
+his tale." The result was, that he became a man
+of "no slight mark;" "he had gotten the queen's
+ear in a trice;" "she took him for a kind of oracle,"
+and "loved to hear his reasons to her demands,"
+or, in more modern phrase, "his replies to her questions."</p>
+
+<p>The reign of Queen Elizabeth has been called the
+heroic age of England. And, let us remember, the
+England of that day is ours as much as theirs who
+still bear the name of Englishmen. The men whose
+gallant deeds we now record were our ancestors, and
+their glory is our inheritance.</p>
+
+<p>The Reformation in religion had awakened all the
+energies of the human mind. It had roused against
+England formidable enemies, among which Spain was
+the most powerful and the most intensely hostile.
+She fitted out the famous Armada to invade England;
+and England, on her part, sent various expeditions to
+annoy the Spaniards in their lately acquired possessions
+in South America. These expeditions were
+generally got up by private adventurers; the queen
+and her great nobles often taking a share in them.
+When there was nominal peace with Spain, such <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_288" id="Page_288">[Pg 288]</a></span>enterprises
+were professedly for discovery and colonization,
+though the adventurers could not always keep
+their hands off a rich prize of Spanish property that
+fell in their way; but, for the last fifteen years of
+Elizabeth's reign, there was open war between the
+two powers: and then these expeditions had for their
+first object the annoyance of Spain, and discovery and
+colonization for their second.</p>
+
+<p>We find Raleigh, after fortune began to smile upon
+him, engaged in a second expedition, with Sir Humphrey
+Gilbert, for discovery and colonization in
+America. He furnished, from his own means, a ship
+called "The Raleigh," on board of which he embarked;
+but when a few days out, a contagious disease breaking
+out among the crew, he put back into port, and
+relinquished the expedition. Sir Humphrey, with
+the rest of the squadron, consisting of five vessels,
+reached Newfoundland without accident, took possession
+of the island, and left a colony there. He then
+set out exploring along the American coast to the
+south, he himself doing all the work in his little ten-ton
+cutter; the service being too dangerous for the
+larger vessels to venture on. He spent the summer
+in this labor till toward the end of August, when, in
+a violent storm, one of the larger vessels, "The <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_289" id="Page_289">[Pg 289]</a></span>Delight,"
+was lost with all her crew. "The Golden
+Hind" and "Squirrel" were now left alone of the five
+ships. Their provisions were running short, and the
+season far advanced; and Sir Humphrey reluctantly
+concluded to lay his course for home. He still continued
+in the small vessel, though vehemently urged by
+his friends to remove to the larger one. "I will not
+forsake my little company, going homeward," said he,
+"with whom I have passed so many storms and perils."
+On the 9th of September, the weather was rough, and
+the cutter was with difficulty kept afloat, struggling
+with the violence of the waves. When the vessels
+came within hearing distance, Sir Humphrey cried
+out to his companions in "The Hind," "Be of good
+courage: we are as near to heaven by sea as by land."
+"That night, at about twelve o'clock," writes the historian
+of the voyage, who was himself one of the adventurers,
+"the cutter being ahead of us in 'The Golden
+Hind,' suddenly her lights were out, and the watch
+cried, 'The general is cast away!' which was too
+true." So perished a Christian hero. It was a fine
+end for a mortal man. Let us not call it sad or tragic,
+but heroic and sublime.</p>
+
+<p>Raleigh, not discouraged by the ill success of this
+expedition, shortly after obtained letters-patent for
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_290" id="Page_290">[Pg 290]</a></span>another enterprise of the same kind, on the same
+terms as had been granted to Sir Humphrey. Two
+barks were sent to explore some undiscovered part
+of America north of Florida, and look out for a favorable
+situation for the proposed colony. This expedition
+landed on Roanoke Island, near the mouth of
+Albemarle Sound. Having taken formal possession
+of the country for the Queen of England and her servant
+Sir Walter Raleigh, they returned, and gave so
+favorable an account of the country, that her Majesty
+allowed it to be called Virginia, after herself, a virgin
+queen. The next year, Raleigh sent out a second
+expedition, and left a colony of a hundred men, which
+was the first colony planted by Englishmen on the
+continent of America. Soon after, Raleigh sent a
+third expedition with a hundred and fifty colonists;
+but having now expended forty thousand pounds upon
+these attempts, and being unable to persist further, or
+weary of waiting so long for profitable returns, he
+assigned over his patent to a company of merchants,
+and withdrew from further prosecution of the enterprise.</p>
+
+<p>The years which followed were the busiest of Raleigh's
+adventurous life. He bore a distinguished
+part in the defeat of the Spanish Armada; and, in the
+triumphant procession to return thanks at St. Paul's
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_291" id="Page_291">[Pg 291]</a></span>for that great deliverance, he was conspicuous as commander
+of the queen's guard. He was a member of
+Parliament, yet engaged personally in two naval expeditions
+against the Spaniards, from which he reaped
+honor, but no profit; and was at the height of favor
+with the queen. But, during his absence at sea, the
+queen discovered that an intrigue existed between
+Raleigh and one of the maids of honor, which was an
+offence particularly displeasing to Elizabeth, who
+loved to fancy that all her handsome young courtiers
+were too much attached to herself to be capable of
+loving any other object. Raleigh, on his return, was
+committed a prisoner to the Tower, and, on being released
+after a short confinement, retired to his estate
+in Dorsetshire. It was during this retirement that
+he formed his scheme for the discovery and conquest
+of Eldorado. It had long been a subject of meditation
+to Raleigh, who declares in the dedication of his "History
+of Guiana," published after his return, that "many
+years since, he had knowledge, by relation, of that
+mighty, rich, and beautiful empire of Guiana, and of
+that great and golden city which the Spaniards call
+Eldorado, and the naturals Manoa."&mdash;"It is not possible,"
+says one of the historians of these events, "<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_292" id="Page_292">[Pg 292]</a></span>that
+Raleigh could have believed the existence of such a
+kingdom. Credulity was not the vice of his nature;
+but, having formed the project of colonizing Guiana,
+he employed these fables as baits for vulgar cupidity."
+Other writers judge him more favorably. It
+is probably true that he believed in the existence of
+such a country as Eldorado; but we can hardly suppose
+that he put faith in all the marvellous details
+which accompanied the main fact in popular narration.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_293" id="Page_293">[Pg 293]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER V.</h2>
+
+<h3>RALEIGH'S FIRST EXPEDITION.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>As the attempts of Pizarro and Orellana were
+made by the route of the river of the Amazons,
+and that of Ribera by the river of Paraguay,
+Raleigh's approach was by the Orinoco, a river second
+in size only to the Amazons, and which flows in a
+course somewhat parallel to that, and some five or
+ten degrees farther to the north. The region of
+country where this river discharges itself into the
+Atlantic was nominally in possession of the Spaniards,
+though they had but one settlement in what
+was called the province of Guiana,&mdash;the town of St.
+Joseph, then recently founded; and another on the
+island of Trinidad, which lies nearly opposite the
+mouth of the river. Raleigh, arriving at Trinidad,
+stopped some days to procure such intelligence as
+the Spaniards resident there could afford him respecting
+Guiana. He then proceeded to the main
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_294" id="Page_294">[Pg 294]</a></span>land, destroyed the town which the Spaniards had
+lately built there, and took the governor, Berrio, on
+board his own ship. He used his prisoner well, and
+"gathered from him," he says, "as much of Guiana
+as he knew." Berrio seems to have conversed willingly
+upon his own adventures in exploring the country,
+having no suspicion of Raleigh's views. He
+discouraged Raleigh's attempts to penetrate into the
+country, telling him that he would find the river
+unnavigable for his ships, and the nations hostile.
+These representations had little weight with Raleigh,
+as he attributed them to a very natural wish on Berrio's
+part to keep off foreigners from his province;
+but, on trying to find the entrance to the river, he
+discovered Berrio's account to be true, so far as related
+to the difficulties of the navigation. After a
+thorough search for a practicable entrance, he gave
+up all hopes of passing in any large vessel, and resolved
+to go with the boats. He took in his largest
+boat, with himself, sixty men, including his cousin,
+his nephew, and principal officers. Another boat carried
+twenty, and two others ten each. "We had no
+other means," he says in his account afterward published,
+"but to carry victual for a month in the same,
+and also to lodge therein as we could, and to boil and
+dress our meat."</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_295" id="Page_295">[Pg 295]</a></span>The Orinoco, at nearly forty leagues from the sea,
+forms, like the Nile, a kind of fan, strewed over with
+a multitude of little islands, that divide it into numerous
+branches and channels, and force it to discharge
+itself through this labyrinth into the sea by an infinity
+of mouths, occupying an extent of more than
+sixty leagues. "The Indians who inhabit those
+islands," says Raleigh, "in the summer, have houses
+upon the ground, as in other places; in the winter
+they dwell upon the trees, where they build very
+artificial towns and villages: for, between May and
+September, the river rises to thirty feet upright, and
+then are those islands overflowed twenty feet high
+above the level of the ground; and for this cause
+they are enforced to live in this manner. They use
+the tops of palmitos for bread; and kill deer, fish, and
+porks for the rest of their sustenance." Raleigh's
+account is confirmed by later travellers. Humboldt
+says, "The navigator, in proceeding along the
+channels of the delta of the Orinoco at night, sees
+with surprise the summits of the palm-trees illuminated
+by large fires. These are the habitations
+of the Guaraons, which are suspended from the
+trees. These tribes hang up mats in the air,
+which they fill with earth, and kindle, on a layer
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_296" id="Page_296">[Pg 296]</a></span>of moist clay, the fire necessary for their household
+wants."</p>
+
+<p>Passing up with the flood, and anchoring during the
+ebb, Raleigh and his companions went on, till on the
+third day their galley grounded, and stuck so fast,
+that they feared their discovery must end there, and
+they be left to inhabit, like rooks upon trees, with
+these nations; but on the morrow, after casting out
+all her ballast, with tugging and hauling to and fro,
+they got her afloat. After four days more, they got
+beyond the influence of the tide, and were forced to
+row against a violent current, till they began to despair;
+the weather being excessively hot, and the
+river bordered with high trees, that kept away the
+air. Their provisions began to fail them; but some
+relief they found by shooting birds of all colors,&mdash;carnation,
+crimson, orange, purple, and of all
+other sorts, both simple and mixed. An old Indian
+whom they had pressed into their service was a faithful
+guide to them, and brought them to an Indian village,
+where they got a supply of bread, fish, and fowl.
+They were thus encouraged to persevere, and next
+day captured two canoes laden with bread, "and
+divers baskets of roots, which were excellent meat."
+Probably these roots were no other than potatoes;
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_297" id="Page_297">[Pg 297]</a></span>for the mountains of Quito, to which Sir Walter was
+now approaching, were the native country of the potato,
+and the region from whence it was first introduced
+into Europe. The Spaniards and Portuguese
+introduced it earlier than the English; but to Raleigh
+belongs the credit of making it known to his countrymen.
+The story is, that Sir Walter, on his return
+home, had some of the roots planted in his garden at
+Youghal, in Ireland, and that his gardener was sadly
+disappointed in autumn on tasting the apples of the
+"fine American fruit," and proceeded to root up the
+"useless weeds," when he discovered the tubers.</p>
+
+<p>Raleigh treated the natives with humanity, and, in
+turn, received friendly treatment from them. The
+chiefs told him fine stories about the gold-mines; but,
+unfortunately, the gold was not to be had without
+labor, and the adventurers were in no condition to
+undertake mining operations. What they wanted was
+to find a region like Mexico or Peru, only richer,
+where gold might be found, not in the rocks or the
+bowels of the earth, but in possession of the natives,
+in the form of barbaric ornaments that they would
+freely barter for European articles, or images of their
+gods, such as Christians might seize and carry away
+with an approving conscience.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_298" id="Page_298">[Pg 298]</a></span>Thus far, their search for such a region had been
+unsuccessful, and their only hope was of reaching it
+by farther explorations. But the river was rising
+daily, and the current flowed with such rapidity, that
+they saw clearly, if it went on to increase as it had
+done for some time past, it must soon debar all farther
+progress.</p>
+
+<p>Raleigh found by talking with the chiefs that they
+were all hostile to the Spaniards, and willing enough
+to promise him their aid in driving them out of the
+country. He accordingly told them that he was sent
+by a great and virtuous queen to deliver them from
+the tyranny of the Spaniards. He also learned that
+the Indians with whom he was conversing were an
+oppressed race, having been conquered by a nation
+who dwelt beyond the mountains,&mdash;a nation who wore
+large coats, and hats of crimson color, and whose
+houses had many rooms, one over the other. They
+were called the Eperumei; and against them all the
+other tribes would gladly combine, for they were the
+general oppressors. Moreover, the country of these
+Eperumei abounded in gold and all other good things.</p>
+
+<p>He continued to make daily efforts to ascend the
+river, and to explore the tributary streams, but found
+his progress debarred in some quarters by the rapid
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_299" id="Page_299">[Pg 299]</a></span>current of the swollen streams, and in others by falls
+in the rivers. The falls of one of the tributaries of
+the Orinoco, the Caroli, he describes as "a wonderful
+breach of waters, running in three parts; and there
+appeared some ten or twelve over-falls in sight, every
+one as high over the other as a church-tower." He
+was informed that the lake from which the river
+issued was above a day's journey for one of their
+canoes to cross, which he computed at about forty
+miles; that many rivers fall into it, and great store
+of grains of gold was found in those rivers. On one
+of these rivers, he was told, a nation of people dwell
+"whose heads appear not above their shoulders;"
+which, he says, "though it may be thought a mere
+fable, yet, for my own part, I am resolved it is true,
+because every child in those provinces affirm the
+same. They are reported to have their eyes in their
+shoulders, and their mouths in the middle of their
+breasts, and that a long train of hair growth backward
+between their shoulders." Raleigh adds, "It
+was not my chance to hear of them till I was come
+away. If I had but spoken one word of it while I was
+there, I might have brought one of them with me to
+put the matter out of doubt." It might have been
+more satisfactory for the philosophers if he had done
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_300" id="Page_300">[Pg 300]</a></span>so; but his word was quite enough for the poets.
+One of that class, and the greatest of all, William
+Shakspeare, was, at that very time, writing plays for
+the gratification of Raleigh's gracious mistress and
+her subjects, and eagerly availed himself of this new-discovered
+tribe to introduce one of them in his play
+of "The Tempest," under the name of Caliban. He also
+makes Othello tell the gentle Desdemona "of most
+disastrous chances, and of the cannibals that each
+other eat; the Anthropophagi, and men whose heads
+do grow beneath their shoulders." Nor are these
+the only instances in which we think we trace the
+influence of the romantic adventurer on the susceptible
+poet. The name of the divinity whom Caliban
+calls "my dam's God Setebos" occurs in Raleigh's
+narrative as the name of an Indian tribe; and Trinculo's
+plan of taking Caliban to England to make a
+show of him seems borrowed from this hint of Raleigh's.
+In his days of prosperity, Raleigh instituted
+a meeting of intellectual men at "The Mermaid," a
+celebrated tavern. To this club, Shakspeare, Beaumont,
+Fletcher, Jonson, Selden, Donne, and other distinguished
+literary men, were accustomed to repair;
+and here doubtless the adventures and discoveries of
+Sir Walter, set forth with that talent of which his
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_301" id="Page_301">[Pg 301]</a></span>writings furnish abundant proof, often engaged the
+listening group. Raleigh was then forty-eight, and
+Shakspeare thirty-six, years old. But, in justice to
+Raleigh, it should be added, that he did not invent
+these stories, and that later travellers and missionaries
+testify that such tales were current among the
+Indians, though as yet no specimen of the tribe has
+been seen by trustworthy narrators.</p>
+
+<p>Raleigh now found that he must bring his westward
+progress to a conclusion: "for no half-day passed but
+the river began to rage and overflow very fearfully;
+and the rains came down in terrible showers, and
+gusts in great abundance, and men began to cry out
+for want of shift; for no man had place to bestow any
+other apparel than that which he wore on his back,
+and that was thoroughly washed on his body for the
+most part ten times a day; and we had now been near
+a month, every day passing to the westward, farther
+from our ships." They turned back, therefore, and,
+passing down the stream, went, without labor and
+against the wind, little less than one hundred miles a
+day. They stopped occasionally, both for provisions,
+and for conference with the natives. In particular,
+one old chief, with whom he had conferred formerly
+on his ascent, gave him the confidential <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_302" id="Page_302">[Pg 302]</a></span>communication,
+that the attempt to attack the city of Manoa, at
+that time, was desperate; for neither the time of the
+year was favorable, nor had he nearly a sufficient
+force. He advised, that, forbearing any further attempts
+at that time, Raleigh should rest satisfied with
+the information he had gained, and return to his own
+country for a larger force, with which to come again
+the next year, and unite all the tribes which were
+hostile to the Eperumei, or people of Manoa, and by
+their aid make an easy conquest of them. The old
+chief added, that, for his part and his people's, they
+wanted no share of the spoils of gold or precious
+stones: they only wanted to be avenged on their enemies,
+and to rescue from them their women whom the
+Eperumei had carried away in their frequent incursions;
+"so that, whereas they were wont to have ten
+or twelve wives apiece, they were now enforced to
+content themselves with three or four."</p>
+
+<p>Raleigh met with no material misadventure in his
+way down the river; and, though a storm attacked
+them the same night, they anchored in the mouth of
+the river; so that, in spite of every shelter they could
+derive from the shores, the galley "had as much to
+do to live as could be, and there wanted little of her
+sinking, and all those in her:" yet next day they
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_303" id="Page_303">[Pg 303]</a></span>arrived safe at the Island of Trinidad, and found the
+ships at anchor, "than which," says Raleigh, "there
+was never to us a more joyful sight."</p>
+
+<p>Raleigh was not favorably received by the queen
+on his return, nor was he welcomed with any popular
+applause; for he had brought home no booty, and his
+account of the riches of the land into which he had
+led the way was received with suspicion. He published
+it under this boastful title: "The Discovery
+of the large, rich, and beautiful Empire of Guiana;
+with a relation of the great and Golden City of Manoa,
+which the Spaniards call Eldorado. Performed by
+Sir Walter Raleigh." In spite of all the great promises
+which he held out, the acknowledgment that he
+had made a losing voyage tended to abate that spirit
+of cupidity and enterprise which he wished to excite.</p>
+
+<p>Sir Walter's history of his expedition contains, besides
+the marvels already cited, numerous others, some
+of which have a basis of fact, others not. Of the former
+kind is his account of oysters growing on trees.
+He says, "We arrived at Trinidado the 22d of March,
+casting anchor at Port Curiapan. I left the ships, and
+kept by the shore in my barge, the better to understand
+the rivers, watering-places, and ports of the
+island. In the way, I passed divers little brooks of
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_304" id="Page_304">[Pg 304]</a></span>fresh water, and one salt river, that had store of oysters
+upon the branches of the trees. All their oysters
+grow upon those boughs and sprays, and not on
+the ground. The like is commonly seen in the West
+Indies and elsewhere."</p>
+
+<p>Upon this narrative, Sir Robert Schomburgh, a late
+explorer, has the following remark: "The first accounts
+brought to Europe, of oysters growing on trees,
+raised as great astonishment as the relation of Eldorado
+itself; and to those who were unacquainted with
+the fact that these mollusks select the branches of
+the tree, on which they fix themselves during high
+water, when the branches are immersed, it may certainly
+sound strange, that shells, which we know live
+in Europe on banks in the depths of the sea, should
+be found in the West Indies on the branches of trees.
+They attach themselves chiefly to the mangrove-tree,
+which grows along the shore of the sea, and rivers of
+brackish water, and covers immense tracts of coast;
+rooting and vegetating in a manner peculiar to itself,
+even as far as low-water mark. The water flowing
+off during ebb leaves the branches, with the oysters
+attached to them, high and dry."</p>
+
+<p>Respecting the Republic of Amazons, Sir Walter
+says, "I made inquiry among the most ancient and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_305" id="Page_305">[Pg 305]</a></span>best travelled of the Orenoqueponi; and I was very
+desirous to understand the truth of those warlike
+women, because of some it is believed, of others not.
+I will set down what hath been delivered me for
+truth of those women; and I spake with a cacique,
+or lord of people, who said that he had been in the
+river, and beyond it also. The nations of those women
+are on the south side of the river, in the province of
+Topago; and their chiefest strengths and retreats
+are in the islands of said river. They accompany
+with men but once in a year, and for the time of one
+month, which, I gather from their relation, to be in
+April. At that time, all the kings of the borders assemble,
+and the queens of the Amazons; and, after
+the queens have chosen, the rest cast lots for their
+valentines. This one month they feast, dance, and
+drink of their wines in abundance; and, the moon
+being done, they all depart to their own provinces.
+If a son be born, they return him to the father; if a
+daughter, they nourish it and retain it, all being desirous
+to increase their own sex and kind. They carry
+on wars, and are very blood-thirsty and cruel."</p>
+
+<p>Sir Robert Schomburgh, who explored these regions
+extensively between the years 1835 and
+1844, says, in reference to this subject, "The <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_306" id="Page_306">[Pg 306]</a></span>result
+of this fatiguing and perilous journey has only
+strengthened our conviction that this republic of
+women was one of those inventions, designed merely
+to enhance the wonders, of which the new world was
+regarded as the seat." It would, however, be unjust
+to condemn Raleigh's proneness to a belief in their
+existence, when we find that Condamine believed in
+them; that Humboldt hesitated to decide against
+them; and that even Southey, the learned historian
+of Brazil, makes this remark, "Had we never heard
+of the Amazons of antiquity, I should, without hesitation,
+believe in those of America. Their existence is
+not the less likely for that reason; and yet it must be
+admitted, that the probable truth is made to appear
+suspicious by its resemblance to a known fable."</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_307" id="Page_307">[Pg 307]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER VI.</h2>
+
+<h3>RALEIGH'S ADVENTURES CONTINUED.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>When Raleigh, on his first arrival, broke up the
+Spanish settlement in Trinidad, he took Berrio,
+the governor, prisoner, and carried him with him in
+his voyage up the river. Berrio seems to have borne
+his fate with good temper, and conciliated the good
+will of Raleigh; so that, when the expedition returned
+to the mouth of the river, he was set at liberty, and
+collected his little colony again. Berrio probably
+shared the same belief as Raleigh in the existence of
+the kingdom of Eldorado within the limits of his
+province, and was naturally desirous to avail himself
+of the respite which he gained by the termination of
+Raleigh's expedition, until it should return in greater
+force to penetrate to Eldorado, and take possession
+for himself and his countrymen. With these views,
+he sent an officer of his, Domingo de Vera, to Spain,
+to levy men; sending, according to Raleigh's account,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_308" id="Page_308">[Pg 308]</a></span>"divers images, as well of men as of beasts, birds, and
+fishes, cunningly wrought in gold," in hopes to persuade
+the king to yield him some further help. This
+agent was more successful than Raleigh in obtaining
+belief. He is described as a man of great ability, and
+little scrupulous as to truth. Having been favorably
+received by the government, he attracted notice by
+appearing in a singular dress, which, as he was of
+great stature, and rode always a great horse, drew all
+eyes, and made him generally known as the Indian
+chief of Eldorado and the rich lands. Some trinkets
+in gold he displayed, of Indian workmanship, and some
+emeralds, which he had brought from America, and
+promised stores of both; and, by the aid of influential
+persons, he obtained seventy thousand dollars at Madrid,
+and five thousand afterwards at Seville, authority
+to raise any number of adventurers (though Berrio
+had asked only for three hundred men), and five good
+ships to carry them out. Adventurers flocked to him
+in Toledo, La Mancha, and Estremadura. The expedition
+was beyond example popular. Twenty captains
+of infantry, who had served in Italy and Flanders,
+joined it. Not only those who had their fortunes to
+seek were deluded: men of good birth and expectations
+left all to engage in the conquest of <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_309" id="Page_309">[Pg 309]</a></span>Eldorado;
+and fathers of families gave up their employments,
+and sold their goods, and embarked with their wives
+and children. Solicitations and bribes were made use
+of by eager volunteers. The whole expedition consisted
+of more than two thousand persons.</p>
+
+<p>They reached Trinidad after a prosperous voyage,
+and took possession of the town. The little mischief
+which Raleigh had done had been easily repaired; for
+indeed there was little that he could do. The place
+did not contain thirty families, and the strangers were
+to find shelter as they could. Rations of biscuit and
+salt meat, pulse, or rice, were served out to them; but,
+to diminish the consumption as much as possible, detachments
+were sent off in canoes to the main land,
+where Berrio had founded the town of St. Thomas.
+Some flotillas effected their progress safely; but one,
+which consisted of six canoes, met with bad weather,
+and only three succeeded in entering the river, after
+throwing their cargoes overboard. The others made
+the nearest shore, where they were descried by the
+Caribs, a fierce tribe of natives, who slew them all,
+except a few women whom they carried away, and
+one soldier, who escaped to relate the fate of his companions.</p>
+
+<p>The city of St. Thomas contained at that time four
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_310" id="Page_310">[Pg 310]</a></span>hundred men, besides women and children. Berrio,
+to prepare the way for the discovery and conquest of
+Eldorado, sent out small parties of the new-comers
+under experienced persons, that they might be seasoned
+to the difficulties which they would have to undergo,
+and learn how to conduct themselves in their
+intercourse with the Indians. They were to spread
+the news that the king had sent out many Spaniards,
+and a large supply of axes, caps, hawk-bells, looking-glasses,
+combs, and such other articles of traffic as
+were in most request. They saw no appearance of
+those riches which Raleigh had heard of, nor of that
+plenty which he had found. The people with whom
+they met had but a scanty subsistence for themselves,
+and so little of gold or silver or any thing else to barter
+for the hatchets and trinkets of the Spaniards,
+that they were glad of the chance to labor as boatmen,
+or give their children, in exchange for them.</p>
+
+<p>Berrio was not discouraged by the result of these
+journeys. Like Raleigh, he was persuaded that the
+great and golden city stood on the banks of a great
+lake, from which the River Caroli issued, about twelve
+leagues east of the mouth whereof his town was
+placed. A force of eight hundred men was now
+ordered on the discovery. The command was given
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_311" id="Page_311">[Pg 311]</a></span>to Correa, an officer accustomed to Indian warfare.
+Three Franciscan monks, and a lay brother of the
+same order, accompanied the expedition. Having
+reached a spot where the country was somewhat
+elevated, and the temperature cooler than in the region
+they had passed, they hutted themselves on a
+sort of prairie, and halted there in the hope that rest
+might restore those who began to feel the effect of an
+unwholesome climate. The natives not only abstained
+from any acts of hostility, but supplied them with
+fruits, and a sort of cassava (tapioca). This they did
+in sure knowledge that disease would soon subdue
+these new-come Spaniards to their hands. It was not
+long before a malignant fever broke out among the
+adventurers, which carried off a third part of their
+number. One comfort only was left them: the friars
+continued every day to perform mass in a place where
+all the sufferers could hear it; and no person died
+without performing and receiving all the offices which
+the Romish Church has enjoined. Correa himself
+sank under the disease. He might possibly have escaped
+it, acclimated as he was, if he had not overtasked
+himself when food was to be sought from a
+distance, and carried heavy loads to spare those who
+were less equal to the labor: for now the crafty <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_312" id="Page_312">[Pg 312]</a></span>Indians
+no longer brought supplies, but left the weakened
+Spaniards to provide for themselves as they
+could; and when Correa was dead, of whom, as a man
+accustomed to Indian war, they stood in fear, they
+collected their forces, and fell upon the Spaniards,
+who apprehended no danger, and were most of them
+incapable of making any defence. The plan appears
+to have been concerted with a young Indian chief
+who accompanied the Spaniards under pretence of
+friendship; and the women whom the Indians brought
+with them to carry home the spoils of their enemies
+bore their part with stones and stakes in the easy
+slaughter. The Spaniards who escaped the first attack
+fled with all speed, some without weapons, and
+some without strength to use them. The friars were
+the last to fly. With the soldiers to protect them,
+they brought off their portable altar, two crosses, and
+a crucifix. No attempt at resistance was made, except
+when a fugitive fell by the way. The word then
+passed for one of the fathers: some soldiers stood
+with their muskets to protect him while he hastily
+confessed and absolved the poor wretch, whom his
+countrymen then commended to God, and left to the
+mercy of the Indians.</p>
+
+<p>In some places, the enemy set fire to the grass and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_313" id="Page_313">[Pg 313]</a></span>shrubbery, which in that climate grow with extreme
+luxuriance; by which means many of this miserable
+expedition perished. Not quite thirty out of the
+whole number got safe back to the town of St. Thomas.
+That place was in a deplorable state, suffering at once
+from a contagious disease and from a scarcity of provisions.
+To add to the distress, about a hundred persons
+more had just arrived from Trinidad. They
+came of necessity; for there were no longer supplies
+of food at Trinidad to sustain them. But they came
+with high-raised hopes, only repining at their ill luck
+in not having been in the first expedition, by which
+they supposed the first spoils of Eldorado had already
+been shared. They arrived like skeletons at a city of
+death. Not only were provisions scarce, but the supply
+of salt had altogether failed; and, without it, health
+in that climate cannot be preserved. To add to their
+misery, the shoes had all been consumed, and the
+country was infested by that insect (the chigua)
+which burrows in the feet, and attacks the flesh
+wherever the slightest wound gives it access. The
+torment occasioned by these insects was such, that
+the men willingly submitted to the only remedy they
+knew of, and had the sores cauterized with hot iron.</p>
+
+<p>Among those who had come from Spain to enter
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_314" id="Page_314">[Pg 314]</a></span>upon this land of promise, there was a "beata," or
+pious woman, who had been attached to a convent in
+Madrid, and accompanied a married daughter and her
+husband on this unhappy adventure, and devoted herself
+to the service of the sick. Some of the women,
+and she among them, looking upon the governor,
+Berrio, as the cause of their miseries, and thinking,
+that, as long as he lived, there was no hope of their
+escaping from this fatal place, resolved to murder
+him, and provided themselves with knives for the
+purpose. The indignation against him was so general,
+that they hesitated not to impart their design to
+one of the friars; and, luckily for Berrio, he interposed
+his influence to prevent it. One of the women who
+had sold her possessions in Spain to join the expedition
+made her way to the governor when the officers
+and friars were with him, and, emptying upon the
+ground before him a bag which contained one hundred
+and fifty doubloons, said, "Tyrant, take what is
+left, since you have brought us here to die." Berrio
+replied, with less of anger than of distress in his countenance,
+"I gave no orders to Domingo de Vera that
+he should bring more than three hundred men." He
+offered no opposition to the departure of such as
+would. Many who had strength or resolution enough
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_315" id="Page_315">[Pg 315]</a></span>trusted themselves to the river in such canoes as
+they could find, without boatmen or pilot, and endeavored
+to make their way back to Trinidad; some
+perishing by the hands of the natives, others by
+drowning, others by hunger, on the marshy shores
+which they reached. Vera soon died of a painful disease
+in Trinidad; and Berrio did not long survive
+him. Such was the issue of this great attempt for
+the conquest of the golden empire; "of which," says
+an old Spanish historian, "it may be said, that it was
+like Nebuchadnezzar's image, beginning in gold, but
+continuing through baser metal, till it ended in rude
+iron and base clay."</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_316" id="Page_316">[Pg 316]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER VII.</h2>
+
+<h3>RALEIGH'S SECOND EXPEDITION.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>Raleigh's first voyage disappointed every one
+but himself. He pretended to have obtained
+satisfactory evidence of the existence of Eldorado,
+and information of the place where it was; also proof
+of the existence of mines of gold; and to have conciliated
+the good will of the natives, and secured their
+co-operation with him in any future attempt. But he
+had brought home no gold; the shining stones which
+his followers had abundantly supplied themselves
+with were found to be worthless: and there was no
+evidence of the existence of a native sovereignty as
+far advanced in civilization and refinement as the
+Mexicans and Peruvians, the conquest of which
+would reflect as much glory upon the English name
+as the achievements of Cortez and Pizarro had reflected
+upon that of Spain. Raleigh's boastful representations,
+therefore, failed of effect. None of his
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_317" id="Page_317">[Pg 317]</a></span>countrymen were inclined to join with him in a further
+prosecution of the enterprise; and the subject
+was dropped for the time.</p>
+
+<p>Raleigh was soon restored to favor, and employed
+in the naval expeditions against Spain which took
+place at this time. He greatly distinguished himself
+on several occasions, and was in high favor with
+Queen Elizabeth till her death; but, with the accession
+of James, his fortunes fell. He was accused
+(whether justly or not is still doubtful) of being concerned
+in treasonable plots against the king, and was
+brought to trial, found guilty, condemned to death,
+and committed prisoner to the Tower to await the
+execution of his sentence.</p>
+
+<p>Raleigh, withdrawn from active labors by his imprisonment,
+was not idle. He turned to intellectual
+pursuits, and, with many minor pieces in prose and
+verse, executed his greatest work, "The History of
+the World,"&mdash;a project of such vast extent, that the
+bare idea of his undertaking it excites our admiration.
+As an author, he stands on an eminence as high as
+that which he obtained in other paths. Hume says,
+"He is the best model of our ancient style;" and Hallam
+confirms the judgment. His imprisonment lasted
+thirteen years. At the expiration of that time, he
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_318" id="Page_318">[Pg 318]</a></span>had influence to have his sentence so far remitted as
+to allow him to go on a second expedition in search
+of Eldorado. Twenty years had elapsed since the
+former expedition; and the present was of a magnitude
+more like a national enterprise than a private
+one. Sir Walter's own ship, "The Destiny," carried
+thirty-six guns and two hundred men. There were
+six other vessels, carrying from twenty-five guns to
+three each. Raleigh embarked all his means in this
+expedition. His eldest son commanded one of the
+ships; and eighty of his companions were gentlemen
+volunteers and adventurers, many of them his relations.</p>
+
+<p>Those who have thoughtfully considered Raleigh's
+career have seen reason to doubt whether he really
+believed the stories which he was so anxious to impress
+upon others. They have thought it more likely
+that his real object was to emulate the fame of Cortez
+and Pizarro; to dispossess Spain of some portion
+of her conquests in South America, and transfer
+them to his own country. This latter object was admissible
+at the time of his first expedition, because
+Spain and England were then at war; but was not
+so on the second, as the two nations were then at
+peace. But Raleigh had reason to think, that, if he
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_319" id="Page_319">[Pg 319]</a></span>could succeed in his object, there was no danger of
+his being called to very strict account respecting his
+measures.</p>
+
+<p>He arrived off the coast of Guiana on the 12th of
+November, 1617; having had a long and disastrous
+voyage. One ship had left him, and returned home;
+another had foundered; forty-two of his men had died;
+many were suffering from sickness, and himself among
+the number. But he found the Indians friendly, and
+not forgetful of his former visit. He writes to his
+wife, "To tell you that I might be here king of the
+country were a vanity; but my name hath still lived
+among them here. They feed me with fresh meat,
+and all that the country yields. All offer to obey
+me."</p>
+
+<p>Being too feeble from sickness to go himself, he
+sent forward an expedition, under Capt. Keymis, to
+enter the Orinoco, and take possession of the mines.
+Five companies of fifty men each, in five shallops,
+composed the expedition; Raleigh, with the remainder
+of his vessels, repairing to Trinidad to await the
+result.</p>
+
+<p>Since Raleigh's former expedition, the Spaniards
+had made a settlement upon the main land, and
+founded a town to which they gave the name of St.
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_320" id="Page_320">[Pg 320]</a></span>Thomas. The governor resided there, and there were
+in all about five hundred inhabitants. On the 12th
+of January, the English flotilla reached a part of the
+river twelve leagues from St. Thomas; and an Indian
+fisherman carried the alarm to that place. The governor,
+Palameque, mustered immediately the little
+force which he had at hand. This consisted of fifty-seven
+men only. Messengers were sent to summon
+those men who were at their farms, and two horsemen
+were sent out to watch the invaders' movements.</p>
+
+<p>At eleven in the forenoon, the vessels anchored
+about a league from the town. The men landed, and
+the scouts hastened back with the intelligence. A
+Spanish officer, with ten men, was placed in ambush
+near the city. As soon as he was informed of the
+direction which the English were taking, he cut a
+match-cord in pieces, which he lighted at dark, and
+placed at intervals, where they might deceive the invaders
+by presenting the appearance of a greater
+force. The first discharge was from two pieces of
+cannon against the boats. The Spaniard, with his
+little band, then opened his fire upon the troops, and
+kept it up from the bushes as he retired before them.
+This skirmishing continued about an hour and a half,
+till he had fallen back to the place where the <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_321" id="Page_321">[Pg 321]</a></span>governor
+and his people were drawn up, at the entrance
+of the city, to make a stand. It was now nine at
+night. Raleigh says, in his account of the action,
+that some of the English, at the first charge, began to
+pause and recoil shamefully; whereupon his son, not
+tarrying for any musketeers, ran up at the head of a
+company of pikemen, and received a shot wound.
+Pressing then upon a Spanish captain with his sword,
+the Spaniard, taking the small end of his musket in
+his hand, struck him on the head with the stock, and
+felled him. His last words were, "Lord, have mercy
+upon me, and prosper the enterprise!" and his death
+was instantly avenged by his sergeant, who thrust
+the Spaniard through with his halberd. In the heat
+of the fight, and in the confusion which the darkness
+occasioned, the Spanish commander was separated
+from his people, and slain. The Spaniards, however,
+had the advantage of knowing the ground; and, betaking
+themselves to the houses, they fired from them on
+the English, and killed many, till the assailants set
+fire to the houses; thus depriving themselves of that
+booty which was their main object. The English
+were now masters of the place; the remainder of the
+defendants, with the women and children, under the
+command of Grados, the officer who had deported
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_322" id="Page_322">[Pg 322]</a></span>himself so well in the first ambush, effecting their
+escape across the river. Grados stationed them at a
+place about ten miles distant from the town, where a
+few slight huts were erected for the women and children.</p>
+
+<p>The captors searched in vain for gold in the city;
+but they had an idea that there was a rich gold-mine
+a short distance up the river. Accordingly, two
+launches, with twenty or thirty men in each, were
+despatched up the Orinoco. They came to the mouth
+of the creek, which led to the place where Grados
+had hutted the women and children; and the largest
+of the launches was about to enter, when Grados,
+who had posted nine of the invalids in ambush there,
+with about as many Indian bowmen, fired upon them
+so unexpectedly, and with such good aim, that only
+one of the crew is said to have escaped unhurt. The
+other launch also suffered some loss. Three days after,
+three launches were sent to take vengeance for
+this defeat; but Grados had removed his charge some
+two leagues into the country, and these vessels went
+up the river about a hundred leagues, treating with
+the Indians, to whom they made presents and larger
+promises, and after eighteen or twenty days returned,
+having effected nothing of importance.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_323" id="Page_323">[Pg 323]</a></span>The English had now been four weeks in the city,
+annoyed by the Spaniards and Indians, and losing
+many of their men, cut off in their foraging excursions
+by ambushes. After the unsuccessful attempt to discover
+the mine, no further effort was made for that
+purpose; Keymis alleging in his excuse, that "the
+Spaniards, being gone off in a whole body, lay in the
+woods between the mine and us, and it was impossible,
+except they had been beaten out of the country,
+to pass up the woods and craggy hills without the
+loss of the commanders, without whom the rest would
+easily be cut to pieces." The English, accordingly,
+retreated from the city, setting fire to the few houses
+that remained, and promising the Indians, as they
+went, that they would return next year, and complete
+the destruction of the Spaniards.</p>
+
+<p>Raleigh was by no means satisfied with Keymis's
+excuses for his failure to discover the mine, and reproached
+him with so much severity, that Keymis,
+after the interview, retired to his cabin, and shot himself
+through the heart.</p>
+
+<p>When Raleigh arrived in England, he found that
+the tidings of his attack on the Spaniards, and the
+utter failure of his expedition, had reached there before
+him. The Spanish ambassador was clamorous
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_324" id="Page_324">[Pg 324]</a></span>for punishment on what he called a piratical proceeding;
+and the king and the nation, who might have
+pardoned a successful adventurer, had no indulgence
+to extend to one so much the reverse. Finding a
+proclamation had been issued for his arrest, Raleigh
+endeavored to escape to France, but was taken in the
+attempt, and committed close prisoner to the Tower.
+He was made a victim to court intrigue. The weak
+king, James, was then negotiating a Spanish match
+for his son, and, to gratify the King of Spain and his
+court, sacrificed one of the noblest of his subjects.
+Without being put on trial for his late transactions,
+Raleigh's old sentence, which had been suspended
+sixteen years, was revived against him; and on the
+29th of October, 1618, four months after his arrival,
+he was beheaded on the scaffold.</p>
+
+<p>The fate of Raleigh caused a great sensation at the
+time, and has not yet ceased to excite emotion. The
+poet Thomson, in his "Summer," finely alludes to the
+various circumstances of his history, which we have
+briefly recorded:&mdash;</p>
+
+<div style="margin-left: 25%; margin-right: 20%;"><p>
+<span style="margin-left: 9em;">"But who can speak</span><br />
+The numerous worthies of the 'Maiden reign'?<br />
+In Raleigh mark their every glory mixed,&mdash;<br />
+Raleigh, the scourge of Spain, whose breast with all<br />
+The sage, the patriot, and the hero, burned.<br />
+Nor sunk his vigor when a coward reign<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_325" id="Page_325">[Pg 325]</a></span>
+The warrior fettered, and at last resigned<br />
+To glut the vengeance of a vanquished foe:<br />
+Then, active still and unrestrained, his mind<br />
+Explored the vast extent of ages past,<br />
+And with his prison-hours enriched the world;<br />
+Yet found no times in all the long research<br />
+So glorious or so base as those he proved<br />
+In which he conquered and in which he bled."<br />
+</p></div>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_326" id="Page_326">[Pg 326]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER VIII.</h2>
+
+<h3>THE FRENCH PHILOSOPHERS.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>After so many abortive attempts to reach the
+Golden Empire, the ardor of research greatly
+abated. No expeditions, composed of considerable
+numbers, have since embarked in the enterprise; but
+from time to time, for the century succeeding Raleigh's
+last attempt, private expeditions were undertaken
+and encouraged by provincial governors; and
+several hundred persons perished miserably in those
+fruitless endeavors.</p>
+
+<p>The adventure we are now about to record was of
+an entirely different character in respect to its objects
+and the means employed; but it occupied the
+same field of action, and called into exercise the same
+qualities of courage and endurance.</p>
+
+<p>In 1735, the French Academy of Science made
+arrangements for sending out two commissions of
+learned men to different and distant parts of the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_327" id="Page_327">[Pg 327]</a></span>world to make measurements, with a view to determining
+the dimensions and figure of the earth. The
+great astronomer, Sir Isaac Newton, had deduced
+from theory, and ventured to maintain, that the earth
+was not a perfect globe, but a spheroid; that is, a
+globe flattened at the poles. For a long time after
+Newton's splendid discoveries in astronomy, a degree
+of national jealousy prevented the French philosophers
+from accepting his conclusions; and they were
+not displeased to find, when they could, facts opposed
+to them. Now, there were some supposed facts which
+were incompatible with this idea of Newton's, that
+the earth was flattened at the poles. The point was
+capable of being demonstrated by measurements, with
+instruments, on the surface; for, if his theory was true,
+a degree of latitude would be longer in the northern
+parts of the globe than in the regions about the equator.</p>
+
+<p>We must not allow our story to become a scientific
+essay; and yet we should like to give our readers, if
+we could, some idea of the principle on which this
+process, which is called the measurement of an arc of
+the meridian, was expected to show the magnitude
+and form of the earth. We all know that geographical
+latitude means the position of places north or
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_328" id="Page_328">[Pg 328]</a></span>south of the equator, and is determined by reference
+to the north or pole star. A person south of the
+equator would not see the pole-star at all. One at
+the equator, looking at the pole-star, would see it, if
+no intervening object prevented, in the horizon. Advancing
+northward, he would see it apparently rise,
+and advance toward him. As he proceeded, it would
+continue to rise. When he had traversed half the
+distance to the pole, he would see the pole-star about
+as we see it in Boston; that is, nearly midway between
+the horizon and the zenith: and, when he had reached
+the pole, he would see the pole-star directly over his
+head. Dividing the quarter circle which the star
+has moved through into ninety parts, we say, when
+the star has ascended one-ninetieth part, that the observer
+has travelled over one degree of latitude.
+When the observer has reached Boston, he has passed
+over somewhat more than forty-two degrees, and,
+when he has reached the north-pole, ninety degrees,
+of latitude. Thus we measure our latitude over the
+earth's surface by reference to a circle in the heavens;
+and, because the portions into which we divide
+that circle are equal, we infer that the portions of the
+earth's surface which correspond to them are equal.
+This would be true if the earth were a perfect globe:
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_329" id="Page_329">[Pg 329]</a></span>but if the earth be a spheroid, as Newton's theory
+requires it to be, it would <i>not</i> be true; for that portion
+of the earth's surface which is flattened will have
+less curvature than that which is not so, and less still
+than that portion which is protuberant. The degrees
+of least curvature will be longest, and those of greatest
+curvature shortest; that is, one would have to
+travel farther on the flattened part of the earth to
+see any difference in the position of the north-star
+than in those parts where the curvature is greater.
+So a degree of latitude near the pole, if determined
+by the position of the north-star, would be found, by
+actual measurement, to be longer than one similarly
+determined at the equator. It was to ascertain
+whether the fact was so that the two scientific expeditions
+were sent out.</p>
+
+<p>The party which was sent to the northern regions
+travelled over snow and ice, swamps and morasses,
+to the arctic circle, and fixed their station at Tornea,
+in Lapland. The frozen surface of the river afforded
+them a convenient level for fixing what is called by
+surveyors the base line. The cold was so intense,
+that the glass froze to the mouth when they drank,
+and the metallic measuring rod to the hand. In spite,
+however, of perils and discomforts, they persevered
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_330" id="Page_330">[Pg 330]</a></span>in their task, and brought back careful measurements
+of a degree in latitude 66&deg; north, to be compared with
+those made by the other party at the equator, whose
+movements we propose more particularly to follow.</p>
+
+<p>Before we take leave of the northern commissioners,
+however, we will mention another method they
+took of demonstrating the same fact. If the earth be
+depressed at the poles, it must follow that bodies will
+weigh heavier there, because they are nearer the
+centre of the earth. But how could they test this
+fact, when all weights would be increased alike,&mdash;the
+pound of feathers and the pound of lead? The question
+was settled by observing the oscillation of a pendulum.
+The observers near the pole found that the
+pendulum vibrated faster than usual, because, being
+nearer the centre of the earth, the attracting power
+was increased. To balance this, they had to lengthen
+the pendulum; and the extent to which they had to
+do this measured the difference between the earth's
+diameter at the poles, and that in the latitude from
+which they came.</p>
+
+<p>The commissioners who were sent to the equatorial
+regions were Messrs. Bouguer, La Condamine, and
+Godin, the last of whom was accompanied by his wife.
+Two Spanish officers, Messrs. Juan and De Ulloa,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_331" id="Page_331">[Pg 331]</a></span>joined the commission. The party arrived at Quito
+in June, 1736, about two hundred years after Gonzalo
+Pizarro started from the same place in his search for
+Eldorado. In the interval, the country had become
+nominally Christian. The city was the seat of a
+bishopric, an audience royal, and other courts of
+justice; contained many churches and convents, and
+two colleges. But the population was almost entirely
+composed of Indians, who lived in a manner but very
+little different from that of their ancestors at the time
+of the conquest. Cuen&ccedil;a was the place next in importance
+to the capital; and there, or in its neighborhood,
+the chief labors of the commission were transacted.
+They were conducted under difficulties as
+great as those of their colleagues in the frozen regions
+of the north, but of a different sort. The inhabitants
+of the country were jealous of the French commissioners,
+and supposed them to be either heretics or
+sorcerers, and to have come in search of gold-mines.
+Even persons connected with the administration employed
+themselves in stirring up the minds of the
+people, till at last, in a riotous assemblage at a bullfight,
+the surgeon of the French commissioners was
+killed. After tedious and troublesome legal proceedings,
+the perpetrators were let off with a nominal
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_332" id="Page_332">[Pg 332]</a></span>punishment. Notwithstanding every difficulty, the
+commissioners completed their work in a satisfactory
+manner, spending in all eight years in the task, including
+the voyages out and home.</p>
+
+<p>The commissioners who had made the northern
+measurements reported the length of the degree at
+66&deg; north latitude to be 57.422 toises; Messrs. Bouguer
+and La Condamine, the equatorial degree, 56.753
+toises; showing a difference of 669 toises, or 4,389&frac34;
+feet. The difference, as corrected by later measurements,
+is stated by recent authorities at 3,662 English
+feet; by which amount the polar degree exceeds the
+equatorial. Thus Newton's theory was confirmed.</p>
+
+<p>His scientific labors having been finished, La Condamine
+conceived the idea of returning home by way
+of the Amazon River; though difficulties attended the
+project, which we who live in a land of mighty rivers,
+traversed by steamboats, can hardly imagine. The
+only means of navigating the upper waters of the
+river was by rafts or canoes; the latter capable of
+containing but one or two persons, besides a crew of
+seven or eight boatmen. The only persons who were
+in the habit of passing up and down the river were
+the Jesuit missionaries, who made their periodical
+visits to their stations along its banks. A young
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_333" id="Page_333">[Pg 333]</a></span>Spanish gentleman, Don Pedro Maldonado, who at
+first eagerly caught at the idea of accompanying the
+French philosopher on his homeward route by way
+of the river, was almost discouraged by the dissuasives
+urged by his family and friends, and seemed inclined
+to withdraw from the enterprise; so dangerous
+was the untried route esteemed. It was, however,
+at length resolved that they should hazard the
+adventure; and a place of rendezvous was appointed
+at a village on the river. On the 4th of July, 1743,
+La Condamine commenced his descent of one of the
+streams which flow into the great river of the Amazons.
+The stream was too precipitous in its descent
+to be navigated by boats of any kind, and the only
+method used was by rafts. These are made of a
+light kind of wood, or rather cane, similar to the bamboo,
+the single pieces of which are fastened together
+by rushes, in such a manner, that they yield to every
+shock of moderate violence, and consequently are not
+subject to be separated even by the strongest. On
+such a conveyance, the French philosopher glided
+down the stream of the Chuchunga, occasionally stopping
+on its banks for a day or two at a time to allow
+the waters to abate, and admit of passing a dangerous
+rapid more safely; and sometimes getting fast on the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_334" id="Page_334">[Pg 334]</a></span>shallows, and requiring to be drawn off by ropes by
+the Indian boatmen. It was not till the 19th of July
+that he entered the main river at Laguna, where he
+found his friend Maldonado, who had been waiting
+for him some weeks.</p>
+
+<p>On the 23d of July, 1743, they embarked in two
+canoes of forty-two and forty-four feet long, each
+formed out of one single trunk of a tree, and each
+provided with a crew of eight rowers. They continued
+their course night and day, in hopes to reach,
+before their departure, the brigantines of the missionaries,
+in which they used to send once a year, to
+Par&aacute;, the cacao which they collected in their missions,
+and for which they got, in return, supplies of European
+articles of necessity.</p>
+
+<p>On the 25th of July, La Condamine and his companion
+passed the village of a tribe of Indians lately
+brought under subjection, and in all the wildness of
+savage life: on the 27th, they reached another more
+advanced in civilization, yet not so far as to have
+abandoned their savage practices of artificially flattening
+their heads, and elongating their ears. The
+1st of August, they landed at a missionary station,
+where they found numerous Indians assembled, and
+some tribes so entirely barbarous as to be destitute
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_335" id="Page_335">[Pg 335]</a></span>of clothing for either sex. "There are in the interior,"
+the narration goes on to say, "some tribes
+which devour the prisoners taken in war; but there
+are none such on the banks of the river."</p>
+
+<p>After leaving this station, they sailed day and
+night, equal to seven or eight days' journey, without
+seeing any habitation. On the 5th of August, they
+arrived at the first of the Portuguese missionary stations,
+where they procured larger and more commodious
+boats than those in which they had advanced
+hitherto. Here they began to see the first signs of
+the benefits of access to European sources of supply,
+by means of the vessel which went every year from
+Par&aacute; to Lisbon. They tarried six days at the last of
+the missionary stations, and again made a change of
+boats and of Indian crews. On the 28th August,
+being yet six hundred miles from the sea, they perceived
+the ebb and flow of the tide.</p>
+
+<p>On the 19th September, they arrived at Par&aacute;,
+which La Condamine describes as a great and beautiful
+city, built of stone, and enjoying a commerce with
+Lisbon, which made it flourishing and increasing.
+He observes, "It is, perhaps, the only European
+settlement where silver does not pass for money;
+the whole currency being cocoa." He adds in a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_336" id="Page_336">[Pg 336]</a></span>note, "Specie currency has been since introduced."</p>
+
+<p>The Portuguese authorities received the philosophers
+with all the civilities and hospitalities due to
+persons honored with the special protection and countenance
+of two great nations,&mdash;France and Spain. The
+cannon were fired; and the soldiers of the garrison,
+with the governor of the province at their head,
+turned out to receive them. The governor had received
+orders from the home government to pay all
+their expenses, and to furnish them every thing requisite
+for their comfort and assistance in their researches.
+La Condamine remained three months at
+Par&aacute;; and then, declining the urgent request of the
+governor to embark in a Portuguese vessel for home
+by way of Lisbon, he embarked in a boat rowed by
+twenty-two Indians, under the command of a Portuguese
+officer, to coast along the shores of the continent
+to the French colony of Cayenne.</p>
+
+<p>The city of Par&aacute; from whence he embarked is not
+situated upon the Amazon River, but upon what is
+called the River of Par&aacute;, which branches off from the
+Amazon near its mouth, and discharges itself into the
+sea at a distance of more than a hundred miles
+east of the Amazon. The intervening land is an
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_337" id="Page_337">[Pg 337]</a></span>island called Marajo, along the coast of which La Condamine
+and his party steered till they came to the
+place where the Amazon River discharges into the
+sea that vast bulk of waters which has been swelled
+by the contributions of numerous tributaries throughout
+a course of more than three thousand miles in
+length. It here meets the current which runs along
+the north-eastern coast of Brazil, and gives rise to
+that phenomenon which is called by the Indians Pororoca.
+The river and the current, having both great
+rapidity, and meeting nearly at right angles, come
+into contact with great violence, and raise a mountain
+of water to the height of one hundred and eighty
+feet. The shock is so dreadful, that it makes all the
+neighboring islands tremble; and fishermen and navigators
+fly from it in the utmost terror. The river
+and the ocean appear to contend for the empire of the
+waves: but they seem to come to a compromise;
+for the sea-current continues its way along the coast
+of Guiana to the Island of Trinidad, while the current
+of the river is still observable in the ocean at a distance
+of five hundred miles from the shore.</p>
+
+<p>La Condamine passed this place of meeting in
+safety by waiting for a favorable course of tides,
+crossing the Amazon at its mouth, steering north;
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_338" id="Page_338">[Pg 338]</a></span>and after many delays, caused by the timidity and
+bad seamanship of his Indian crew, arrived at last
+safe at Cayenne on the 26th February, 1744, having
+been eight months on his voyage, two of which were
+spent in his passage from Par&aacute;, a passage which he
+avers a French officer and crew, two years after him,
+accomplished in six days. La Condamine was received
+with all possible distinction at Cayenne, and
+in due time found passage home to France, where he
+arrived 25th February, 1745.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_339" id="Page_339">[Pg 339]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER IX.</h2>
+
+<h3>MADAME GODIN'S VOYAGE DOWN THE AMAZON.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>One of the French commissioners, M. Godin, had
+taken with him on his scientific errand to Peru
+his wife; a lady for whom we bespeak the kind interest
+of our readers, for her name deserves honorable mention
+among the early navigators of the Amazon. The
+labors of the commission occupied several years; and
+when, in the year 1742, those labors were happily
+brought to a conclusion, M. Godin was prevented, by
+circumstances relating to himself individually, from
+accompanying his colleagues in their return to France.
+His detention was protracted from year to year, till
+at last, in 1749, he repaired alone to the Island of
+Cayenne to prepare every thing necessary for the
+homeward voyage of himself and his wife.</p>
+
+<p>From Cayenne he wrote to Paris to the minister of
+marine, and requested that his government would
+procure for him the favorable interposition of the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_340" id="Page_340">[Pg 340]</a></span>court of Portugal to supply him with the means of
+ascending the River Amazon to bring away his wife
+from Peru, and descend the stream with her to the
+Island of Cayenne. Thirteen years had rolled by since
+their arrival in the country, when at last Madame
+Godin saw her earnest wish to return home likely to
+be gratified. All that time, she had lived apart from
+her husband; she in Peru, he in the French colony of
+Cayenne. At last, M. Godin had the pleasure to see
+the arrival of a galoot (a small vessel having from sixteen
+to twenty oars on a side, and well adapted for
+rapid progress), which had been fitted out by the
+order of the King of Portugal, and despatched to Cayenne
+for the purpose of taking him on his long-wished-for
+journey. He immediately embarked; but, before
+he could reach the mouth of the Amazon River, he was
+attacked by so severe an illness, that he saw himself
+compelled to stop at Oyapoc, a station between Cayenne
+and the mouth of the river, and there to remain,
+and to send one Tristan, whom he thought his friend,
+in lieu of himself, up the river to seek Madame Godin,
+and escort her to him. He intrusted to him also, besides
+the needful money, various articles of merchandise
+to dispose of to the best advantage. The
+instructions which he gave him were as follows:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_341" id="Page_341">[Pg 341]</a></span>The galiot had orders to convey him to Loreto
+about half-way up the Amazon River, the first Spanish
+settlement. From there he was to go to Laguna,
+another Spanish town about twelve miles farther up,
+and to give Mr. Godin's letter, addressed to his wife,
+in charge to a certain ecclesiastic of that place, to be
+forwarded to the place of her residence. He himself
+was to wait at Laguna the arrival of Madame Godin.</p>
+
+<p>The galiot sailed, and arrived safe at Loreto. But
+the faithless Tristan, instead of going himself to Laguna,
+or sending the letter there, contented himself
+with delivering the packet to a Spanish Jesuit, who
+was going to quite another region on some occasional
+purpose. Tristan himself, in the mean while, went
+round among the Portuguese settlements to sell his
+commodities. The result was, that M. Godin's letter,
+passing from hand to hand, failed to reach the place
+of its destination.</p>
+
+<p>Meanwhile, by what means we know not, a blind
+rumor of the purpose and object of the Portuguese
+vessel lying at Loreto reached Peru, and came at last,
+but without any distinctness, to the ears of Madame
+Godin. She learned through this rumor that a letter
+from her husband was on the way to her; but all her
+efforts to get possession of it were fruitless. At last,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_342" id="Page_342">[Pg 342]</a></span>she resolved to send a faithful negro servant, in company
+with an Indian, to the Amazon, to procure, if possible,
+more certain tidings. This faithful servant made
+his way boldly through all hinderances and difficulties
+which beset his journey, reached Loreto, talked with
+Tristan, and brought back intelligence that he, with
+the Portuguese vessel and all its equipments, were
+for her accommodation, and waited her orders.</p>
+
+<p>Now, then, Madame Godin determined to undertake
+this most perilous and difficult journey. She was
+staying at the time at Riobamba, about one hundred
+and twenty miles south of Quito, where she had a
+house of her own with garden and grounds. These,
+with all other things that she could not take with her,
+she sold on the best terms she could. Her father, M.
+Grandmaison, and her two brothers, who had been
+living with her in Peru, were ready to accompany her.
+The former set out beforehand to a place the other
+side of the Cordilleras to make arrangements for his
+daughter's journey on her way to the ship.</p>
+
+<p>Madame Godin received about this time a visit
+from a certain Mr. R., who gave himself out for a
+French physician, and asked permission to accompany
+her. He promised, moreover, to watch over her
+health, and to do all in his power to lighten the fatigues
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_343" id="Page_343">[Pg 343]</a></span>and discomforts of the arduous journey. She replied,
+that she had no authority over the vessel which was
+to carry her, and therefore could not answer for it
+that he could have a place in it. Mr. R., thereupon,
+applied to the brothers of Madame Godin; and they,
+thinking it very desirable that she should have a physician
+with her, persuaded their sister to consent to
+take him in her company.</p>
+
+<p>So, then, she started from Riobamba, which had been
+her home till this time, the 1st of October, 1749, in
+company of the above-named persons, her black man,
+and three Indian women. Thirty Indians, to carry
+her baggage, completed her company. Had the luckless
+lady known what calamities, sufferings, and disappointments
+awaited her, she would have trembled at
+the prospect, and doubted of the possibility of living
+through it all, and reaching the wished-for goal of her
+journey.</p>
+
+<p>The party went first across the mountains to Canelos,
+an Indian village, where they thought to embark
+on a little stream which discharges itself into the Amazon.
+The way thither was so wild and unbroken,
+that it was not even passable for mules, and must be
+travelled entirely on foot.</p>
+
+<p>M. Grandmaison, who had set out a whole month
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_344" id="Page_344">[Pg 344]</a></span>earlier, had stopped at Canelos no longer than was
+necessary to make needful preparations for his daughter
+and her attendants. Then he had immediately
+pushed on toward the vessel, to still keep in advance,
+and arrange matters for her convenience at the next
+station to which she would arrive. Hardly had he
+left Canelos, when the small-pox, a disease which in
+those regions is particularly fatal, broke out, and in
+one week swept off one-half of the inhabitants, and so
+alarmed the rest, that they deserted the place, and
+plunged into the wilderness. Consequently, when
+Madame Godin reached the place with her party, she
+found, to her dismay, only two Indians remaining,
+whom the fury of the plague had spared; and, moreover,
+not the slightest preparation either for her
+reception, or her furtherance on her journey. This
+was the first considerable mishap which befell her,
+and which might have served to forewarn her of the
+greater sufferings which she was to encounter.</p>
+
+<p>A second followed shortly after. The thirty Indians
+who thus far had carried the baggage, and had
+received their pay in advance, suddenly absconded,
+whether from fear of the epidemic, or that they
+fancied, having never seen a vessel except at a
+distance, that they were to be compelled to go on
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_345" id="Page_345">[Pg 345]</a></span>board one, and be carried away. There stood, then,
+the deserted and disappointed company, overwhelmed,
+and knowing not what course to take, or how to help
+themselves. The safest course would have been to
+leave all their baggage to its fate, and return back
+the way they came; but the longing of Madame Godin
+for her beloved husband, from whom she had now
+been separated so many years, gave her courage to
+bid defiance to all the hinderances which lay in her
+way, and even to attempt impossibilities.</p>
+
+<p>She set herself, therefore, to persuade the two Indians
+above mentioned to construct a boat, and, by
+means of it, to take her and her company to Andoas,
+another place about twelve days' journey distant.
+They willingly complied, receiving their pay in advance.
+The boat was got ready; and all the party
+embarked in it under the management of the two
+Indians.</p>
+
+<p>After they had run safely two days' journey down
+the stream, they drew up to the bank to pass the night
+on shore. Here the treacherous Indians took the opportunity,
+while the weary company slept, to run
+away; and, when the travellers awoke next morning,
+they were nowhere to be found. This was a new and
+unforeseen calamity, by which their future progress
+was rendered greatly more hazardous.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_346" id="Page_346">[Pg 346]</a></span>Without a knowledge of the stream or the country,
+and without a guide, they again got on board their
+boat, and pushed on. The first day went by without
+any misadventure. The second, they came up with a
+boat which lay near the shore, alongside of an Indian
+hut built of branches of trees. They found there an
+Indian, just recovered from the sickness, and prevailed
+on him, by presents, to embark with them to
+take the helm. But fate envied them this relief: for,
+the next day, Mr. R.'s hat fell into the water; and the
+Indian, in endeavoring to recover it, fell overboard, and
+was drowned, not having strength to swim to the
+shore.</p>
+
+<p>Now was the vessel again without a pilot, and steered
+by persons, not one of whom had the least knowledge
+of the course. Ere long, the vessel sprung a leak; and
+the unhappy company found themselves compelled to
+land, and build a hut to shelter them.</p>
+
+<p>They were yet five or six days' journey from Andoas,
+the nearest place of destination. Mr. R. offered,
+for himself and another Frenchman his companion, to
+go thither, and make arrangements, that, within fourteen
+days, a boat from there should arrive and bring
+them off. His proposal was approved of. Madame
+Godin gave him her faithful black man to accompany
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_347" id="Page_347">[Pg 347]</a></span>him. He himself took good care that nothing of his
+property should be left behind.</p>
+
+<p>Fourteen days were now elapsed; but in vain they
+strained their eyes to catch sight of the bark which
+Mr. R. had promised to send to their relief. They
+waited twelve days longer, but in vain. Their situation
+grew more painful every day.</p>
+
+<p>At last, when all hope in this quarter was lost, they
+hewed trees, and fastened them together as well as
+they could, and made in this way a raft. When they
+had finished it, they put on their baggage, and seated
+themselves upon it, and suffered it to float down the
+stream. But even this frail bark required a steersman
+acquainted with navigation; but they had none
+such. In no long time, it struck against a sunken log,
+and broke to pieces. The people and their baggage
+were cast into the river. Great, however, as was the
+danger, no one was lost. Madame Godin sunk twice
+to the bottom, but was at last rescued by her brothers.</p>
+
+<p>Wet through and through, exhausted, and half dead
+with fright, they at last all gained the shore. But
+only imagine their lamentable, almost desperate, condition!
+All their supplies lost; to make another raft
+impossible; even their stock of provisions gone!
+And where were they when all these difficulties <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_348" id="Page_348">[Pg 348]</a></span>overwhelmed
+them? In a horrid wilderness, so thick
+grown up with trees and bushes, that one could make
+a passage through it no other way than by axe and
+knife; inhabited only by fiercest tigers, and by the
+most formidable of serpents,&mdash;the rattlesnake. Moreover,
+they were without tools, without weapons!
+Could their situation be more deplorable?</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_349" id="Page_349">[Pg 349]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER X.</h2>
+
+<h3>MADAME GODIN'S VOYAGE CONTINUED.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>The unfortunate travellers had now but the choice
+of two desperate expedients,&mdash;either to wait
+where they were the termination of their wretched
+existence, or try the almost impossible task of penetrating
+along the banks of the river, through the unbroken
+forest, till they might reach Andoas. They
+chose the latter, but first made their way back to their
+lately forsaken hut to take what little provisions they
+had there left. Having accomplished this, they set
+out on their most painful and dangerous journey.
+They observed, when they followed the shore of the
+river, that its windings lengthened their way. To
+avoid this, they endeavored, without leaving the
+course of the river, to keep a straight course. By
+this means, they lost themselves in the entangled forest;
+and every exertion to find their way was ineffectual.
+Their clothes were torn to shreds, and hung
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_350" id="Page_350">[Pg 350]</a></span>dangling from their limbs; their bodies were sadly
+wounded by thorns and briers; and, as their scanty
+provision of food was almost gone, nothing seemed
+left to them but to sustain their wretched existence
+with wild fruit, seeds and buds of the palm-trees.</p>
+
+<p>At last, they sank under their unremitted labor.
+Wearied with the hardships of such travel, torn and
+bleeding in every part of their bodies, and distracted
+with hunger, terror, and apprehensions, they lost the
+small remnant of their energy, and could do no more.
+They sat down, and had no power to rise again. In
+three or four days, one after another died at this stage
+of their journey. Madame Godin lay for the space of
+twenty-four hours by the side of her exhausted and
+helpless brothers and companions: she felt herself
+benumbed, stupefied, senseless, yet at the same time
+tormented by burning thirst. At last, Providence, on
+whom she relied, gave her courage and strength to
+rouse herself and seek for a rescue, which was in store
+for her, though she knew not where to look for it.</p>
+
+<p>Around lay the dead bodies of her brothers and her
+other companions,&mdash;a sight which at another time
+would have broken her heart. She was almost naked.
+The scanty remnants of her clothing were so torn by
+the thorns as to be almost useless. She cut the shoes
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_351" id="Page_351">[Pg 351]</a></span>from her dead brothers' feet, bound the soles under
+her own, and plunged again into the thicket in search
+of something to allay her raging hunger and thirst.
+Terror at seeing herself so left alone in such a fearful
+wilderness, deserted by all the world, and apprehension
+of a dreadful death constantly hovering before
+her eyes, made such an impression upon her, that her
+hair turned gray.</p>
+
+<p>It was not till the second day after she had resumed
+her wandering that she found water, and, a little while
+after, some wild fruit, and a few eggs of birds. But
+her throat was so contracted by long fasting, that
+she could hardly swallow. These served to keep life
+in her frame.</p>
+
+<p>Eight long days she wandered in this manner hopelessly,
+and strove to sustain her wretched existence.
+If one should read in a work of fiction any thing equal
+to it, he would charge the author with exaggeration,
+and violation of probability. But it is history; and,
+however incredible her story may sound, it is rigidly
+conformed to the truth in all its circumstances, as it
+was afterwards taken down from the mouth of Madame
+Godin herself.</p>
+
+<p>On the eighth day of her hopeless wandering, the
+hapless lady reached the banks of the Bobonosa, a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_352" id="Page_352">[Pg 352]</a></span>stream which flows into the Amazon. At the break
+of day, she heard at a little distance a noise, and was
+alarmed at it. She would have fled, but at once reflected
+that nothing worse than her present circumstances
+could happen to her. She took courage, and
+went towards the place whence the sound proceeded;
+and here she found two Indians, who were occupied
+in shoving their boat into the water.</p>
+
+<p>Madame Godin approached, and was kindly received
+by them. She told to them her desire to be conveyed
+to Andoas; and the good savages consented to carry
+her thither in their boat. They did so; and now behold
+her arrived at that place which the mean and
+infamous treachery of Mr. R. was the only cause of
+her not having reached long ago. This base fellow
+had, with unfeeling cruelty, thrown to the winds his
+promise to procure them a boat, and had gone on
+business of his own to Omaguas, a Spanish mission
+station, without in the least troubling himself about his
+pledged word, and the rescue of the unfortunates left
+behind. The honest negro was more true to duty,
+though he was born and bred a heathen, and the other
+a Christian.</p>
+
+<p>While the civilized and polished Frenchman unfeelingly
+went away, and left his benefactress and her
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_353" id="Page_353">[Pg 353]</a></span>companions to languish in the depths of misery, the
+sable heathen ceased not his exertions till he had procured
+two Indians to go up the river with him, and
+bring away his deserted mistress and her companions.
+But, most unfortunately, he did not reach the
+hut where he had left them before they had carried
+into execution the unlucky determination to leave the
+hut, and seek their way through the wilderness. So
+he had the pain of failing to find her on his arrival.</p>
+
+<p>Even then, the faithful creature did not feel as if all
+was done. He, with his Indian companions, followed
+the traces of the party till he came to the place where
+the bodies of the perished adventurers lay, which
+were already so decayed, that he could not distinguish
+one from the other. This pitiable sight led him to
+conclude that none of the company could have escaped
+death. He returned to the hut to take away some
+things of Madame Godin's which were left there, and
+carried them not only back with him to Andoas, but
+from thence (another touching proof of his fidelity) to
+Omaguas, that he might deposit the articles, some of
+which were of considerable value, in the hands of the
+unworthy Mr. R., to be by him delivered to the father
+of his lamented mistress.</p>
+
+<p>And how did this unworthy Mr. R. behave when
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_354" id="Page_354">[Pg 354]</a></span>he was apprised by the negro of the lamentable death
+of those whom he had so unscrupulously given over to
+destitution? Did he shudder at the magnitude and
+baseness of his crime? Oh, no! Like a heartless
+knave, he added dishonesty to cruelty, took the things
+into his keeping, and, to secure himself in the possession
+of them, sent the generous negro back to Quito.
+Joachim&mdash;for that was the name of this honest and
+noble black man&mdash;had unluckily set out on his journey
+back before Madame Godin arrived at Andoas.
+Thus he was lost to her; and her affliction at the loss
+of such a tried friend showed that the greatness of her
+past misfortunes had not made her incapable of feeling
+new distresses.</p>
+
+<p>In Andoas she found a Christian priest, a Spanish
+missionary; and the behavior of this unchristian Christian
+contrasts with the conduct of her two Indian
+preservers, as that of the treacherous R. with that of
+the generous negro. For instance, when Madame
+Godin was in embarrassment how to show her gratitude
+to the good Indians who had saved her life, she
+remembered, that, according to the custom of the country,
+she wore around her neck a pair of gold chains,
+weighing about four ounces. These were her whole
+remaining property; but she hesitated not a moment,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_355" id="Page_355">[Pg 355]</a></span>but took them off, and gave one to each of her benefactors.
+They were delighted beyond measure at such a
+gift; but the avaricious and dishonest priest took them
+away from them before the face of the generous giver,
+and gave them instead some yards of coarse cotton
+cloth, which they call, in that country, Tukujo. And
+this man was one of those who were sent to spread
+Christianity among the heathen, and one from whom
+those same Indians whom he had treated so dishonestly
+would hear the lesson, "Thou shalt not covet
+thy neighbor's goods"!</p>
+
+<p>Madame Godin felt, at seeing such unchristian and
+unmanly behavior, such deep disgust, that, as soon
+as she was somewhat recruited from the effects of so
+many sufferings, she longed for a sight of some boat
+to enable her to escape from the companionship of this
+unjust priest, and get to Laguna, one of the aforementioned
+Spanish mission stations. A kind Indian
+woman made her a petticoat of cotton cloth, though
+Madame Godin had nothing to give her in payment
+for it. But this petticoat was to her, afterwards, a
+sacred thing, that she would not have parted with for
+any price. She laid it carefully away with the slippers
+which she made of her brothers' shoes, and never
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_356" id="Page_356">[Pg 356]</a></span>could, in after-times, look at the two without experiencing
+a rush of sad and tender recollections.</p>
+
+<p>At Laguna she had the good fortune to find a missionary
+of better disposition. This one received her
+with kindness and sympathy, and exerted himself
+every way he could to restore her health, shattered
+by so much suffering. He wrote also on her behalf
+to the Governor of Omaguas, to beg him to aid in expediting
+her journey. By this means, the elegant Mr.
+R. learned that she was still alive; and as she was not
+likely in future to be burdensome to him, while he
+might, through her means, get a passage in the Portuguese
+vessel, he failed not to call upon her at
+Laguna. He delivered to her there some few of the
+things which Joachim had left in his charge; but to
+the question, "What had become of the rest?" he had
+no other answer to make but "They were spoilt."
+The knave forgot, when he said this, that gold bracelets,
+snuff-boxes, ear-rings, and pearls, of which this
+property consisted, are not apt to spoil.</p>
+
+<p>Madame Godin could not forbear making to him the
+well-merited reproach that he was the cause of her
+late sufferings, and guilty of the mournful death of
+her brothers and her other companions. She desired
+to know, moreover, why he had sent away her faithful
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_357" id="Page_357">[Pg 357]</a></span>servant, the good Joachim; and his unworthy reply
+was, he had apprehensions that he would murder
+him. To the question, how he could have such a
+suspicion against a man whose tried fidelity and honest
+disposition were known to him, he knew not what
+to answer.</p>
+
+<p>The good missionary explained to Madame Godin,
+after she was somewhat recruited from her late sufferings,
+the frightful length of the way, and the labors and
+dangers of her journey yet to come, and tried hard to
+induce her to alter her intention, and return to Rio
+Bambas, her former residence, instead of setting forth
+to encounter a new series of disappointments and
+perils. He promised, in that case, to convey her
+safely and with comfort. But the heroic woman rejected
+the proposal with immovable firmness. "God,
+who had so wonderfully protected her so far," she
+said, "would have her in his keeping for the remainder
+of her way. She had but one wish remaining, and
+that was to be re-united to her husband; and she
+knew no danger terrible enough to induce her to give
+up this one ruling desire of her heart."</p>
+
+<p>The missionary, therefore, had a boat got ready to
+carry her to the Portuguese vessel. The Governor
+of Omaguas furnished the boat, and supplied it well
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_358" id="Page_358">[Pg 358]</a></span>with provisions: and, that the commander of the Portuguese
+galiot might be informed of her approach, he
+sent a smaller boat with provisions, and two soldiers
+by land, along the banks of the river, and betook himself
+to Loreto, where the galiot had been so long
+lying; and there he waited till Madame Godin arrived.</p>
+
+<p>She still suffered severely from the consequences
+of the injuries which she had sustained during her
+wanderings in the wilderness. Particularly, the
+thumb of one hand, in which she had thrust a thorn,
+which they had not been able to get out, was in a bad
+condition. The bone itself was become carious, and
+she found it necessary to have the flesh cut open to
+allow fragments of the bone to come out. As for the
+rest, she experienced from the commander of the Portuguese
+vessel all possible kindness, and reached the
+mouth of the Amazon River without any further misadventure.</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Godin, who still continued at Oyapoc (the same
+place where on account of sickness he had been obliged
+to stop), was no sooner informed of the approach of
+his wife than he went on board a vessel, and coasted
+along the shore till he met the galiot. The joy of
+again meeting, after a separation of so many
+years, and after such calamities undergone, was, as
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_359" id="Page_359">[Pg 359]</a></span>may well be supposed, on both sides, indescribably
+great. Their re-union seemed like a resurrection from
+the dead, since both of them had more than once
+given up all hope of ever seeing the other in this life.</p>
+
+<p>The happy husband now conveyed his wife to Oyapoc,
+and thence to Cayenne; whence they departed
+on their return to France, in company with the venerable
+Mr. De Grandmaison. Madame Godin remained,
+however, constantly sad, notwithstanding her present
+ample cause for joy; and every endeavor to raise her
+spirits was fruitless, so deep and inextinguishable an
+impression had the terrible sufferings she had undergone
+made upon her mind. She spoke unwillingly of
+all that she had suffered; and even her husband found
+out with difficulty, and by little and little, the circumstances
+which we have narrated, taken from accounts
+under his own hand. He thought he could thereby
+infer that she had kept to herself, to spare his feelings,
+many circumstances of a distressing nature, which she
+herself preferred to forget. Her heart, too, was, by
+reason of her sufferings, so attuned to pity and forbearance,
+that her compassion even extended to the
+base and wicked men who had treated her with such
+injustice. She would therefore add nothing to induce
+her husband to invoke the vengeance of the law
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_360" id="Page_360">[Pg 360]</a></span>against the faithless Tristan, the first cause of all her
+misfortunes, who had converted to his own use many
+thousand dollars' worth of property which had been
+intrusted to him. She had even allowed herself to be
+persuaded to take on board the boat from Omaguas
+down, for a second time, the mean-souled Mr. R.</p>
+
+<p>So true is it that adversity and suffering do fulfil
+the useful purpose of rendering the human heart
+tender, placable, and indulgent.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_361" id="Page_361">[Pg 361]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XI.</h2>
+
+<h3>HERNDON'S EXPEDITION.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>In the month of August, 1850, Lieut. Herndon, of
+the United-States navy, being on board the frigate
+"Vandalia," then lying at anchor in the harbor of
+Valparaiso, received information that he was designated
+by the Secretary of the Navy to explore the
+Valley of the Amazon. On the 4th of April, being
+then at Lima, he received his orders, and, on the 21st
+of May, commenced his land journey to the highest
+point on the Amazon navigable for boats, which is
+about three hundred miles from its source; in which
+distance there are twenty-seven rapids, the last of
+which is called the Pongo (or falls) de Manseriche.
+Over these the water rushes with frightful rapidity;
+but they are passed, with great peril and difficulty,
+by means of rafts. From the Pongo de Manseriche,
+Lieut. Herndon states that an unbroken channel
+of eighteen feet in depth may be found to the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_362" id="Page_362">[Pg 362]</a></span>Atlantic Ocean,&mdash;a distance of three thousand
+miles.</p>
+
+<p>The party consisted of Lieut. Herndon, commander;
+Passed-midshipman Gibbon; a young master's mate
+named Richards; a young Peruvian, who had made
+the voyage down the Amazon a few years before,
+who was employed as interpreter to the Indians;
+and Mauricio, an Indian servant. They were mounted
+on mules; and their baggage of all kinds, including
+looking-glasses, beads, and other trinkets for the Indians,
+and some supplies of provisions, were carried
+also on muleback, under the charge of an <i>arriero</i>,
+or muleteer, who was an Indian. The party were
+furnished with a tent, which often came in use
+for nightly shelter, as the roadside inns furnished
+none, and the haciendas, or farm-houses, which
+they sometimes availed themselves of, afforded but
+poor accommodation. The following picture of the
+lieutenant's first night's lodgings, not more than ten
+miles from Lima, is a specimen: "The house was
+built of <i>adobe</i>, or sun-dried bricks, and roofed with
+tiles. It had but one room, which was the general
+receptacle for all comers. A mud projection, of two
+feet high and three wide, stood out from the walls of
+the room all around, and served as a permanent <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_363" id="Page_363">[Pg 363]</a></span>bedplace
+for numbers. Others laid their blankets and
+cloaks, and stretched themselves, on the floor; so
+that, with whites, Indians, negroes, trunks, packages,
+horse-furniture, game-cocks, and guinea-pigs, we had
+quite a caravansera appearance."</p>
+
+<p>The lieutenant found the general answer to his inquiry
+for provisions for his party, and of fodder for
+their animals, was, "No hay" (there is none). The
+refusal of the people to sell supplies of these indispensable
+articles was a source of continued inconvenience.
+It arose probably from their fear to have it
+known that they had possessions, lest the hand of
+authority should be laid upon them, and their property
+be taken without payment. The cultivators, it
+must be remembered, are native Indians, under the
+absolute control of their Spanish masters, and have
+no recognized rights protected by law. While this
+state of things continues, civilization is effectually
+debarred progress.</p>
+
+<p>The usual day's travel was twelve to fifteen miles.
+The route ascended rapidly; and the River Rimac,
+along whose banks their road lay, was soon reduced
+to a mountain torrent, raging in foam over the fragments
+of the rocky cliffs which overhung its bed.
+The road occasionally widened out, and gave room
+for a little cultivation.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_364" id="Page_364">[Pg 364]</a></span>May 27.&mdash;They had now reached a height of ten
+thousand feet above the level of the sea. Here the
+traveller feels that he is lifted above the impurities
+of the lower regions of the atmosphere, and is breathing
+air free from taint. The stars sparkled with intense
+brilliancy. The temperature at night was getting
+cool, and the travellers found they required all
+their blankets. But by day the heat was oppressive
+until tempered by the sea-breeze, which set in about
+eleven o'clock in the morning.</p>
+
+<p>The productions of the country are Indian corn,
+alfalfa (a species of lucern), and potatoes. The potato,
+in this its native country, is small, but very fine.
+They saw here a vegetable of the potato kind called
+<i>oca</i>. Boiled or roasted, it is very agreeable to the
+taste, in flavor resembling green corn.</p>
+
+<p>Here they entered upon the mining region. "The
+Earth here shows her giant skeleton bare: mountains,
+rather than rocks, rear their gray heads to the skies;
+and proximity made the scene more striking and sublime."
+Lieut. Herndon had brought letters to the
+superintendent of the mines, who received the travellers
+kindly and hospitably. This establishment is
+managed by a superintendent and three assistants,
+and about forty working hands. The laborers are
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_365" id="Page_365">[Pg 365]</a></span>Indians,&mdash;strong, hardy-looking fellows, though low
+in stature, and stupid in expression. The manner of
+getting the silver from the ore is this: The ore is
+broken into pieces of the size of an English walnut,
+and then ground to a fine powder. The ground ore
+is then mixed with salt, at the rate of fifty pounds of
+salt to every six hundred of ore, and taken to the
+ovens to be toasted. After being toasted, the ore is
+laid in piles of about six hundred pounds upon the
+stone floor. The piles are then moistened with
+water, and quicksilver is sprinkled on them through
+a woollen cloth. The mass is well mixed by treading
+with the feet, and working with hoes. A little calcined
+iron pyrites, called <i>magistral</i>, is also added.
+The pile is often examined to see if the amalgamation
+is going on well. It is left to stand for eight or nine
+days until the amalgamation is complete; then carried
+to an elevated platform, and thrown into a well, or
+cavity: a stream of water is turned on, and four or
+five men trample and wash it with their feet. The
+amalgam sinks to the bottom, and the mud and water
+are let off by an aperture in the lower part of the
+well. The amalgam is then put into conical bags of
+coarse linen, which are hung up; and the weight of
+the mass presses out a quantity of quicksilver, which
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_366" id="Page_366">[Pg 366]</a></span>oozes through the linen, and is caught in vessels below.
+The mass, now dry, and somewhat harder than
+putty, is carried to the ovens, where the remainder
+of the quicksilver is driven off by heat, and the residue
+is <i>plata pina</i>, or pure silver. The proportion of
+pure silver in the amalgam is about twenty-two per
+cent. This is an unusually rich mine.</p>
+
+<p>Returning from the mine, the party met a drove of
+llamas on their way from the hacienda. This is quite
+an imposing sight, especially when the drove is encountered
+suddenly at a turn of the road. The leader,
+who is always selected on account of his superior
+height, has his head decorated with tufts of woollen
+fringe, hung with little bells; and his great height
+(often six feet), gallant and graceful carriage, pointed
+ear, restless eye, and quivering lip, as he faces you
+for a moment, make him as striking an object as one
+can well conceive. Upon pressing on him, he bounds
+aside either up or down the cliff, and is followed by
+the herd, scrambling over places that would be impassable
+for the mule or the ass. The llama travels
+not more than nine or ten miles a day, his load being
+about one hundred and thirty pounds. He will not
+carry more, and will be beaten to death rather than
+move when he is overloaded or tired. The males
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_367" id="Page_367">[Pg 367]</a></span>only are worked: they appear gentle and docile,
+but, when irritated, have a very savage look, and spit
+at the object of their resentment. The guanaco, or
+alpaca, is another species of this animal, and the
+vicunia a third. The guanaco is as large as the
+llama, and bears a fleece of long and coarse wool.
+The vicunia is much smaller, and its wool is short and
+fine: so valuable is it, that it brings at the port of
+shipment a dollar a pound. Our travellers saw no
+guanacos, but now and then, in crossing the mountains,
+caught a glimpse of the wild and shy vicunia.
+They go in herds of ten or fifteen females, accompanied
+by one male, who is ever on the alert. On
+the approach of danger, he gives warning by a shrill
+whistle; and his charge make off with the speed of
+the wind.</p>
+
+<p>On the 31st of May, the thermometer stood at
+thirty-six degrees at five, <span class="smcap">A.M.</span> This, it must be remembered,
+was in the torrid zone, in the same latitude
+as Congo in Africa, and Sumatra in Asia; yet
+how different the climate! This is owing to the elevation,
+which at this water-shed of the continent,
+which separates the rivers of the Atlantic from those
+of the Pacific, was about sixteen thousand feet above
+the level of the sea. The peaks of the Cordillera
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_368" id="Page_368">[Pg 368]</a></span>presented the appearance of a hilly country at home
+on a winter's day; while the lower ranges were
+dressed in bright green, with placid little lakes interspersed,
+giving an air of quiet beauty to the scene.</p>
+
+<p>The travellers next arrived at Morococha, where
+they found copper-mining to be the prevailing occupation.
+The copper ore is calcined in the open air,
+in piles consisting of ore and coal, which burn for a
+month. The ore thus calcined is taken to the ovens;
+and sufficient heat is employed to melt the copper,
+which runs off into moulds below. The copper, in
+this state, is impure, containing fifty per cent of foreign
+matter; and is worth fifteen cents the pound in
+England, where it is refined. There is a mine of fine
+coal near the hacienda, which yields an abundant
+supply.</p>
+
+<p>The travellers passed other mining districts, rich
+in silver and copper. A large portion of the silver
+which forms the circulation of the world is dug from
+the range of mountains which they were now crossing,
+and chiefly from that slope of them which is
+drained off into the Amazon.</p>
+
+<p>Their descent, after leaving the mining country,
+was rapid. On June 6, we find them at the head of a
+ravine leading down to the Valley of Tarma. The
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_369" id="Page_369">[Pg 369]</a></span>height of this spot above the level of the sea was
+11,270 feet. As they rode down the steep descent,
+the plants and flowers that they had left on the other
+side began to re-appear. First the short grass and
+small clover, then barley, lucern, Indian corn, beans,
+turnips, shrubs, bushes, trees, flowers, growing larger
+and gayer in their colors, till the pretty little city of
+Tarma, imbosomed among the hills, and enveloped in
+its covering of willows and fruit-trees, with its long
+lawns of <i>alfalfa</i> (the greenest of grasses) stretching
+out in front, broke upon their view. It is a place of
+seven thousand inhabitants, beautifully situated in an
+amphitheatre of mountains, which are clothed nearly
+to the top with waving fields of barley. The lieutenant
+gives an attractive description of this mountain
+city, whose natural productions extend from the apples
+and peaches of the temperate zone to the oranges
+and pine-apples of the tropics; and whose air is so
+temperate and pure, that there was but one physician
+to a district of twenty thousand people, and he was
+obliged to depend upon government for a part of his
+support.</p>
+
+<p>The party left Tarma on the 16th of June, and resumed
+their descent of the mountains. The ride was
+the wildest they had yet had. The ascents and <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_370" id="Page_370">[Pg 370]</a></span>descents
+were nearly precipitous; and the scene was
+rugged, wild, and grand beyond description. At certain
+parts of the road, it is utterly impossible for two
+beasts to pass abreast, or for one to turn and retreat;
+and the only remedy, when they meet, is to tumble
+one off the precipice, or to drag him back by the tail
+until he reaches a place where the other can pass.
+They met with a considerable fright in this way one
+day. They were riding in single file along one of
+those narrow ascents where the road is cut out of
+the mountain-side, and the traveller has a perpendicular
+wall on one hand, and a sheer precipice of many
+hundreds of feet upon the other. Mr. Gibbon was
+riding ahead. Just as he was about to turn a sharp
+bend of the road, the head of a bull peered round it,
+on the descent. When the bull came in full view, he
+stopped; and the travellers could see the heads of
+other cattle clustering over his quarters, and hear
+the shouts of the cattle-drivers far behind, urging on
+their herd. The bull, with lowered crest, and savage,
+sullen look, came slowly on, and actually got his head
+between the perpendicular rock and the neck of Gibbon's
+mule. But the sagacious beast on which he
+was mounted, pressing her haunches hard against the
+wall, gathered her feet close under her, and turned as
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_371" id="Page_371">[Pg 371]</a></span>upon a pivot. This placed the bull on the outside
+(there was room to pass, though no one would have
+thought it); and he rushed by at the gallop, followed
+in single file by the rest of the herd. The lieutenant
+owns that he and his friend "felt frightened."</p>
+
+<p>On the 18th of June, they arrived at the first hacienda,
+where they saw sugar-cane, yucca, pine-apples,
+and plantains. Besides these, cotton and coffee were
+soon after found in cultivation. The laborers are native
+Indians, nominally free, but, by the customs of
+the country, pretty closely held in subjection to their
+employers. Their nominal wages are half a dollar a
+day; but this is paid in articles necessary for their
+support, which are charged to them at such prices as
+to keep them always in debt. As debtors, the law
+will enforce the master's claim on them; and it is
+almost hopeless for them to desert; for, unless they
+get some distance off before they are recognized,
+they will be returned as debtors to their employers.
+Freedom, under such circumstances, is little better
+than slavery; but it <i>is</i> better, for this reason,&mdash;that
+it only requires some improvement in the intelligence
+and habits of the laborers to convert it into a system
+of free labor worthy of the name.</p>
+
+<p>The <i>yucca</i> (cassava-root) is a plant of fifteen or
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_372" id="Page_372">[Pg 372]</a></span>twenty feet in height. It is difficult to distinguish
+this plant from the <i>mandioc</i>, which is called "wild
+yucca;" and this, "sweet yucca." This may be eaten
+raw; but the other is poisonous until subjected to
+heat in cooking, and then is perfectly wholesome.
+The yucca answers the same purpose in Peru that
+the mandioc does in Brazil. It is the general substitute
+for bread, and, roasted or boiled, is very pleasant
+to the taste. The Indians also make from it an intoxicating
+drink. Each plant will give from twenty to
+twenty-five pounds of the eatable root, which grows
+in clusters like the potato, and some tubers of which
+are as long and thick as a man's arm.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_373" id="Page_373">[Pg 373]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XII.</h2>
+
+<h3>HERNDON'S EXPEDITION CONTINUED.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>On the 4th of July, the travellers arrived at the
+great mining station of Cerro Pasco. The
+weather was so cold, that the lieutenant, not being
+quite well, sat by the fire all day, trying to keep himself
+warm. The town is a most curious-looking place,
+entirely honey-combed, and having the mouths of
+mines, some of them two or three yards in diameter,
+gaping everywhere. From the top of a hill, the
+best view is obtained of the whole. Vast pits, called
+Tajos, surround this hill, from which many millions of
+silver have been taken; and the miners are still burrowing,
+like so many rabbits, in their bottoms and
+sides. The hill is penetrated in every direction; and
+it would not be surprising if it should cave in, any
+day, and bury many in its ruins. The falling-in of
+mines is of frequent occurrence: one caved in, some
+years ago, and buried three hundred persons. An
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_374" id="Page_374">[Pg 374]</a></span>English company undertook mining here in 1825, and
+failed. Vast sums have been spent in constructing
+tunnels, and employing steam machinery to drain the
+mines; and the parties still persevere, encouraged by
+discovering, that, the lower they penetrate, the richer
+are the ores. The yield of these mines is about two
+million dollars' worth a year, which is equal to the
+yield of all the other mines of Peru together.</p>
+
+<p>The lieutenant found the leading people here, as
+well as at Tarma, enthusiastic on the subject of opening
+the Amazon to foreign commerce. It will be a
+great day for them, they say, when the Americans
+get near them with a steamer.</p>
+
+<p>On the 14th of July, they arrived at a spot of marshy
+ground, from which trickled in tiny streams the waters,
+which, uniting with others, swell till they form
+the broad River Huallaga, one of the head tributaries
+of the Amazon. Their descent was now rapid; and
+the next day they found themselves on a sudden
+among fruit-trees, with a patch of sugar-cane, on the
+banks of the stream. The sudden transition from
+rugged mountain-peaks, where there was no cultivation,
+to a tropical vegetation, was marvellous. Two
+miles farther on, they came in sight of a pretty village,
+almost hidden in the luxuriant vegetation. The
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_375" id="Page_375">[Pg 375]</a></span>whole valley here becomes very beautiful. The land,
+which is a rich river-bottom, is laid off into alternate
+fields of sugar-cane and alfalfa. The blended green
+and yellow of this growth, divided by willows, interspersed
+with fruit-trees, and broken into wavy lines
+by the serpentine course of the river, presented a
+scene which filled them with pleasurable emotions,
+and indicated that they had exchanged a semi-barbarous
+for a civilized society.</p>
+
+<p>The party had had no occasion to complain of want
+of hospitality in any part of their route; but here they
+seemed to have entered upon a country where that
+virtue flourished most vigorously, having at its command
+the means of gratifying it. The owner of the
+hacienda of Quicacan, an English gentleman named
+Dyer, received the lieutenant and his large party exactly
+as if it were a matter of course, and as if they
+had quite as much right to occupy his house as they
+had to enter an inn. The next day they had an
+opportunity to compare with the Englishman a fine
+specimen of the Peruvian country gentleman. Col.
+Lucar is thus described: "He is probably the richest
+and most influential man in the province. He seems
+to have been the father of husbandry in these parts,
+and is the very type of the old landed proprietor of
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_376" id="Page_376">[Pg 376]</a></span>Virginia, who has always lived upon his estates, and
+attended personally to their cultivation. Seated at
+the head of his table, with his hat on to keep the
+draught from his head, and which he would insist upon
+removing unless I would wear mine; his chair surrounded
+by two or three little negro children, whom
+he fed with bits from his plate; and attending with
+patience and kindness to the clamorous wants of a
+pair of splendid peacocks, a couple of small parrots of
+brilliant and variegated plumage, and a beautiful and
+delicate monkey,&mdash;I thought I had never seen a more
+perfect pattern of the patriarch. His kindly and
+affectionate manner to his domestics, and to his little
+grand-children, a pair of sprightly boys, who came in
+the evening from the college, was also very pleasing."
+The mention of a college in a region in some respects
+so barbarous may surprise our readers; but such
+there is. It has a hundred pupils, an income of seventy-five
+thousand dollars yearly, chemical and philosophical
+apparatus, and one thousand specimens of
+European minerals.</p>
+
+<p>Ijurra, our lieutenant's Peruvian companion, had
+written to the governor of the village of Tingo Maria,
+the head of canoe navigation on the Huallaga, to send
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_377" id="Page_377">[Pg 377]</a></span>Indians to meet the travellers here, and take their
+luggage on to the place of embarkation.</p>
+
+<p>July 30.&mdash;The Indians came shouting into the
+farm-yard, thirteen in number. They were young,
+slight, but muscular-looking fellows, and wanted to
+shoulder the trunks, and be off at once. The lieutenant,
+however, gave them some breakfast; and then
+the party set forward, and, after a walk of six miles,
+reached the river, and embarked in the canoe. Two
+Indian laborers, called <i>peons</i>, paddled the canoe, and
+managed it very well. The peons cooked their dinner
+of cheese and rice, and made them a good cup
+of coffee. They are lively, good-tempered fellows,
+and, properly treated, make good and serviceable
+travelling companions. The canoe was available
+only in parts of the river where the stream was free
+from rapids. Where these occur, the cargo must be
+landed, and carried round. Lieut. Herndon and his
+party were compelled to walk a good part of the
+distance to Tingo Maria, which was thirty-six miles
+from where they first took the canoe.</p>
+
+<p>"I saw here," says our traveller, "the <i>lucernago</i>,
+or fire-fly of this country. It is a species of beetle,
+carrying two white lights in its eyes, or rather in the
+places where the eyes of insects generally are, and a
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_378" id="Page_378">[Pg 378]</a></span>red light between the scales of the belly; so that it
+reminded me somewhat of the ocean steamers. They
+are sometimes carried to Lima (enclosed in an apartment
+cut into a sugar-cane), where the ladies at balls
+or theatres put them in their hair for ornament."</p>
+
+<p>At Tingo Maria, their arrival was celebrated with
+much festivity. The governor got up a ball for them,
+where there was more hilarity than ceremony. The
+next morning, the governor and his wife accompanied
+our friends to the port. The governor made a short
+address to the canoe-men, telling them that their passengers
+were "no common persons; that they were
+to have a special care of them; to be very obedient,"
+&amp;c. They then embarked, and stood off; the boatmen
+blowing their horns, and the party on shore waving
+their hats, and shouting their adieus.</p>
+
+<p>The party had two canoes, about forty feet long by
+two and a half broad, each hollowed out of a single
+log. The rowers stand up to paddle, having one foot
+in the bottom of the boat, and the other on the gunwale.
+There is a man at the bow of the boat to look
+out for rocks or sunken trees ahead; and a steersman,
+who stands on a little platform at the stern of the
+boat, and guides her motions. When the river was
+smooth, and free from obstruction, they drifted with
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_379" id="Page_379">[Pg 379]</a></span>the current, the men sitting on the trunks and boxes,
+chatting and laughing with each other; but, when
+they approached a "bad place," their serious looks,
+and the firm position in which each one planted himself
+at his post, showed that work was to be done.
+When the bark had fairly entered the pass, the rapid
+gestures of the bow-man, indicating the channel; the
+graceful position of the steersman, holding his long
+paddle; and the desperate exertions of the rowers, the
+railroad rush of the canoes, and the wild screaming
+laugh of the Indians as the boat shot past the danger,&mdash;made
+a scene so exciting as to banish the
+sense of danger.</p>
+
+<p>After this specimen of their travel, let us take a
+glimpse of their lodging. "At half-past five, we
+camped on the beach. The first business of the boatmen,
+when the canoe is secured, is to go off to the
+woods, and cut stakes and palm-branches to make a
+house for the 'commander.' By sticking long poles
+in the sand, chopping them half-way in two about
+five feet above the ground, and bending the upper
+parts together, they make in a few minutes the frame
+of a little shanty, which, thickly thatched with palm-leaves,
+will keep off the dew or an ordinary rain.
+Some bring the drift-wood that is lying about the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_380" id="Page_380">[Pg 380]</a></span>beach, and make a fire. The provisions are cooked
+and eaten, the bedding laid down upon the leaves
+that cover the floor of the shanty, the mosquito nettings
+spread; and after a cup of coffee, a glass of grog,
+and a cigar (if they are to be had), everybody retires
+for the night by eight o'clock. The Indians sleep
+round the hut, each under his narrow mosquito curtain,
+which glisten in the moonlight like so many
+tombstones."</p>
+
+<p>The Indians have very keen senses, and see and
+hear things that would escape more civilized travellers.
+One morning, they commenced paddling with
+great vigor; for they said they heard monkeys ahead.
+It was not till after paddling a mile that they reached
+the place. "When we came up to them," says the
+lieutenant, "we found a gang of large red monkeys
+in some tall trees by the river-side, making a noise
+like the grunting of a herd of hogs. We landed; and,
+in a few moments, I found myself beating my way
+through the thick undergrowth, and hunting monkeys
+with as much excitement as I had ever felt in hunting
+squirrels when a boy." They found the game
+hard to kill, and only got three,&mdash;the lieutenant, with
+his rifle, one; and the Indians, with their blow-guns,
+two. The Indians roasted and ate theirs, and Lieut.
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_381" id="Page_381">[Pg 381]</a></span>Herndon tried to eat a piece; but it was so tough,
+that his teeth would make no impression upon it.</p>
+
+<p>Aug. 19.&mdash;The party arrived at Tarapoto. It
+is a town of three thousand five hundred inhabitants,
+and the district of which it is the capital numbers six
+thousand. The principal productions are rice, cotton,
+and tobacco; and cotton-cloth, spun and woven by
+the women, with about as little aid from machinery
+as the women in Solomon's time, of whom we are
+told, "She layeth her hands to the spindle, and her
+hands hold the distaff." The little balls of cotton
+thread which the women spin in this way are used
+as currency (and this in a land of silver-mines), and
+pass for twenty-five cents apiece in exchange for
+other goods, or twelve and a half cents in money.
+Most of the trade is done by barter. A cow is sold
+for one hundred yards of cotton cloth; a fat hog, for
+sixty; a large sheep, twelve; twenty-five pounds of
+salt fish, for twelve; twenty-five pounds of coffee, six;
+a head of plantains, which will weigh from forty to
+fifty pounds, for three needles; and so forth. All
+transportation of merchandise by land is made upon
+the backs of Indians, for want of roads suitable for
+beasts of burden. The customary weight of a load
+is seventy-five pounds: the cost of transportation to
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_382" id="Page_382">[Pg 382]</a></span>Moyobamba, seventy miles, is six yards of cloth. It
+is easy to obtain, in the term of six or eight days,
+fifty or sixty peons, or Indian laborers, for the transportation
+of cargoes, getting the order of the governor,
+and paying the above price, and supporting the
+peons on the way. The town is the most important
+in the province of Mainas. The inhabitants are called
+civilized, but have no idea of what we call comfort in
+their domestic arrangements. The houses are of
+mud, thatched with palm, and have uneven earth
+floors. The furniture consists of a grass hammock, a
+standing bedplace, a coarse table, and a stool or two.
+The governor of this populous district wore no shoes,
+and appeared to live pretty much like the rest of
+them.</p>
+
+<p>Vessels of five feet draught of water may ascend the
+river, at the lowest stage of the water, to within eighteen
+miles of Tarapoto.</p>
+
+<p>Our travellers accompanied a large fishing-party.
+They had four or five canoes, and a large quantity of
+barbasco; a root which has the property of stupefying,
+or intoxicating, the fish. The manner of fishing
+is to close up the mouth of an inlet of the river with
+a network made of reeds; and then, mashing the barbasco-root
+to a pulp, throw it into the water. This
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_383" id="Page_383">[Pg 383]</a></span>turns the water white, and poisons it; so that the fish
+soon begin rising to the surface, dead, and are taken
+into the canoes with small tridents, or pronged sticks.
+Almost at the moment of throwing the barbasco into
+the water, the smaller fish rise to the surface, and die
+in one or two minutes; the larger fish survive longer.</p>
+
+<p>The salt fish, which constitutes an important article
+of food and also of barter trade, is brought from
+down the river in large pieces of about eight pounds
+each, cut from the <i>vaca marina</i>, or sea-cow, also
+found in our Florida streams, and there called <i>manatee</i>.
+It is found in great numbers in the Amazon
+and its principal tributaries. It is not, strictly speaking,
+a fish, but an animal of the whale kind, which
+nourishes its young at the breast. It is not able to
+leave the water; but, in feeding, it gets near the
+shore, and raises its head out. It is most often taken
+when feeding.</p>
+
+<p>Our travellers met a canoe of Indians, one man and
+two women, going up the river for salt. They
+bought, with beads, some turtle-eggs, and proposed
+to buy a monkey they had; but one of the women
+clasped the little beast in her arms, and set up a
+great outcry, lest the man should sell it. The man
+wore a long cotton gown, with a hole in the neck for
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_384" id="Page_384">[Pg 384]</a></span>the head to come through, and short, wide sleeves.
+He had on his arm a bracelet of monkeys' teeth, and
+the women had nose-rings of white beads. Their
+dress was a cotton petticoat, tied round the waist;
+and all were filthy.</p>
+
+<p>Sept. 1.&mdash;They arrived at Laguna. Here they
+found two travelling merchants, a Portuguese and a
+Brazilian. They had four large boats, of about eight
+tons each, and two or three canoes. Their cargo consisted
+of iron and iron implements, crockery-ware,
+wine, brandy, copper kettles, coarse short swords (a
+very common implement of the Indians), guns, ammunition,
+salt, fish, &amp;c., which they expected to exchange
+for straw hats, cotton cloth, sugar, coffee, and money.
+They were also buying up all the sarsaparilla they
+could find, and despatching it back in canoes. They
+invited our travellers to breakfast; and the lieutenant
+says, "I thought that I never tasted any thing better
+than the <i>farinha</i>, which I saw now for the first
+time."</p>
+
+<p>Farinha is a general substitute for bread in all the
+course of the Amazon below the Brazilian frontier.
+It is used by all classes; and the boatmen seemed
+always contented with plenty of salt fish and farinha.
+The women make it in this way: They soak the root
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_385" id="Page_385">[Pg 385]</a></span>of the <i>mandioc</i> in water till it is softened a little,
+when they scrape off the skin, and grate the root
+upon a board, which is made into a rude grater by
+being smeared with some of the adhesive gums of the
+forest, and then sprinkled with pebbles. The white
+grated pulp is put into a conical-shaped bag made of
+the coarse fibres of the palm. The bag is hung up to
+a peg driven into a post of the hut; a lever is put
+through a loop at the bottom of the bag; the short end
+of the lever is placed under a chock nailed to the
+post below; and the woman hangs her weight on the
+long end. This elongates the bag, and brings a heavy
+pressure upon the mass within, causing the juice to
+ooze out through the wicker-work of the bag. When
+sufficiently pressed, the mass is put on the floor of a
+mud oven; heat is applied, and it is stirred with a
+stick till it granulates into very irregular grains, and
+is sufficiently toasted to drive off all the poisonous
+qualities which it has in a crude state. It is then
+packed in baskets (lined and covered with palm-leaves)
+of about sixty-four pounds' weight, which are
+generally sold all along the river at from seventy-five
+cents to one dollar. The sediment of the juice
+is tapioca, and is used to make custards, puddings,
+starch, &amp;c. It will surprise some of our readers to
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_386" id="Page_386">[Pg 386]</a></span>be told that the juice extracted in the preparation of
+these wholesome and nutritive substances is a powerful
+poison, and used by the Indians for poisoning
+the points of their arrows.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_387" id="Page_387">[Pg 387]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XIII.</h2>
+
+<h3>HERNDON'S EXPEDITION CONTINUED.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>The Huallaga is navigable, for vessels drawing
+five feet depth of water, 285 miles; and forty
+miles farther for canoes. Our travellers had now arrived
+at its junction with the Amazon; and their first
+sight of its waters is thus described: "The march
+of the great river in its silent grandeur was sublime;
+but in the untamed might of its turbid waters, as
+they cut away its banks, tore down the gigantic denizens
+of the forest, and built up islands, it was awful.
+I was reminded of our Mississippi at its topmost flood;
+but this stream lacked the charm which the plantation
+upon the bank, the city upon the bluff, and the steamboat
+upon the waters, lend to its fellow of the North.
+But its capacities for trade and commerce are inconceivably
+great; and to the touch of steam, settlement,
+and cultivation, this majestic stream and its magnificent
+water-shed would start up in a display of
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_388" id="Page_388">[Pg 388]</a></span>industrial results that would make the Valley of the
+Amazon one of the most enchanting regions on the
+face of the earth."</p>
+
+<p>Lieut. Herndon speaks of the Valley of the Amazon
+in language almost as enthusiastic as that of Sir
+Walter Raleigh: "From its mountains you may dig
+silver, iron, coal, copper, zinc, quicksilver, and tin;
+from the sands of its tributaries you may wash gold,
+diamonds, and precious stones; from its forests you
+may gather drugs of virtues the most rare, spices of
+aroma the most exquisite, gums and resins of the most
+varied and useful properties, dyes of hue the most
+brilliant, with cabinet and building woods of the finest
+polish and the most enduring texture. Its climate is
+an everlasting summer, and its harvest perennial."</p>
+
+<p>Sept. 8.&mdash;The party encamped at night on an
+island near the middle of the river. "The Indians,
+cooking their big monkeys over a large fire on the
+beach, presented a savage and most picturesque
+scene. They looked more like devils roasting human
+beings, than any thing mortal." We ask ourselves,
+on reading this, whether some such scene may not
+have given rise to the stories of cannibalism which
+Raleigh and others record.</p>
+
+<p>They arrived at Nauta, a village of a thousand <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_389" id="Page_389">[Pg 389]</a></span>inhabitants,
+mostly Indians. The governor of the district
+received them hospitably. Each district has its governor,
+and each town its lieutenant-governor. These
+are of European descent. The other authorities of a
+town are <i>curacas</i>, captains, alcades, and constables.
+All these are Indians. The office of curaca is hereditary,
+and is not generally interfered with by the white
+governor. The Indians treat their curaca with great
+respect, and submit to corporal punishment at his
+mandate.</p>
+
+<p>Sarsaparilla is one of the chief articles of produce
+collected here. It is a vine of sufficient size to shoot
+up fifteen or twenty feet from the root without support.
+It thus embraces the surrounding trees, and
+spreads to a great distance. The main root sends out
+many tendrils, generally about the thickness of a
+straw, and five feet long. These are gathered, and
+tied up in bundles of about an <i>arroba</i>, or thirty-two
+pounds' weight. It is found on the banks of almost
+every river of the region; but many of these are not
+worked, on account of the savages living on them,
+who attack the parties that come to gather it. The
+price in Nauta is two dollars the arroba, and in Europe
+from forty to sixty dollars.</p>
+
+<p>From Nauta, Lieut. Herndon ascended the <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_390" id="Page_390">[Pg 390]</a></span>Ucayali,
+a branch of the Amazon, stretching to the
+north-west in a direction somewhat parallel to the
+Huallaga. There is the essential difference between
+the two rivers, as avenues for commerce, that the
+Ucayali is still in the occupation of savage tribes, unchristianized
+except where under the immediate influence
+of the mission stations planted among them;
+while the population of the Huallaga is tolerably advanced
+in civilization. The following sentences will
+give a picture of the Indians of the Ucayali: "These
+people cannot count, and I can never get from them
+any accurate idea of numbers. They are very little
+removed above 'the beasts that perish.' They are
+filthy, and covered with sores. The houses are very
+large, between thirty and forty feet in length, and ten
+or fifteen in breadth. They consist of immense roofs
+of small poles and canes, thatched with palm, and supported
+by short stakes, four feet high, planted in the
+ground three or four feet apart, and having the spaces,
+except between two in front, filled in with cane. They
+have no idea of a future state, and worship nothing.
+But they can make bows and canoes; and their women
+weave a coarse cloth from cotton, and dye it. Their
+dress is a long cotton gown. They paint the face, and
+wear ornaments suspended from the nose and lower
+lip."</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_391" id="Page_391">[Pg 391]</a></span>Next let us take a view of the means in operation
+to elevate these people to civilization and Christianity.
+Sarayacu is a missionary station, governed by four
+Franciscan friars, who are thus described: "Father
+Calvo, meek and humble in personal concerns, yet full
+of zeal and spirit for his office, clad in his long serge
+gown, belted with a cord, with bare feet and accurate
+tonsure, habitual stoop, and generally bearing upon
+his shoulder a beautiful and saucy bird of the parrot
+kind, was my beau-ideal of a missionary monk. Bregati
+is a young and handsome Italian, whom Father
+Calvo sometimes calls St. John. Lorente is a tall,
+grave, and cold-looking Catalan. A lay-brother named
+Maguin, who did the cooking, and who was unwearied
+in his attentions to us, made up the establishment. I
+was sick here, and think that I shall ever remember
+with gratitude the affectionate kindness of these pious
+and devoted friars of St. Francis."</p>
+
+<p>The government is paternal. The Indians recognize
+in the "padre" the power to appoint and remove
+curacas, captains, and other officers; to inflict stripes,
+and to confine in the stocks. They obey the priests'
+orders readily, and seem tractable and docile. The
+Indian men are drunken and lazy: the women do most
+of the work; and their reward is to be maltreated
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_392" id="Page_392">[Pg 392]</a></span>by their husbands, and, in their drunken frolics, to be
+cruelly beaten, and sometimes badly wounded.</p>
+
+<p>Our party returned to the Amazon; and we find
+occurring in their narrative names which are familiar
+to us in the history of our previous adventurers. They
+touched at Omaguas, the port where Madame Godin
+found kind friends in the good missionary and the
+governor, and where she embarked on her way to
+the galiot at Loreto; and they passed the mouth of the
+Napo, which enters the Amazon from the north,&mdash;the
+river down which Orellana passed in the first adventure.
+The lieutenant says, "We spoke two canoes
+that had come from near Quito by the Napo. There
+are few Christianized towns on the Napo; and the
+rowers of the boats were a more savage-looking set
+than I had seen,"&mdash;so slow has been the progress of
+civilization in three hundred years.</p>
+
+<p>The Amazon seems to be the land of monkeys. Our
+traveller says, "I bought a young monkey of an Indian
+woman to-day. It had coarse gray and white hair;
+and that on the top of its head was stiff, like the quills
+of the porcupine, and smoothed down in front as if it
+had been combed. I offered the little fellow some
+plantain; but, finding he would not eat, the woman
+took him, and put him to her breast, when he sucked
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_393" id="Page_393">[Pg 393]</a></span>away manfully and with great gusto. She weaned
+him in a week, so that he would eat plantain mashed
+up, and put into his mouth in small bits; but the little
+beast died of mortification because I would not let
+him sleep with his arms around my neck."</p>
+
+<p>They got from the Indians some of the milk from
+the cow-tree. This the Indians drink, when fresh;
+and, brought in a calabash, it had a foamy appearance,
+as if just drawn from the cow. It, however, coagulates
+very soon, and becomes as hard and tenacious
+as glue. It does not appear to be as important an
+article of subsistence as one would expect from the
+name.</p>
+
+<p>Dec. 2.&mdash;They arrived at Loreto, the frontier
+town of the Peruvian territory, and which reminds
+us again of Madame Godin, who there joined the Portuguese
+galiot. Loreto is situated on an eminence on
+the left bank of the river, which is here three-fourths
+of a mile wide, and one hundred feet deep. There
+are three mercantile houses in Loreto, which do a
+business of about ten thousand dollars a year. The
+houses at Loreto are better built and better furnished
+than those of the towns on the river above. The population
+of the place is two hundred and fifty, made up
+of Brazilians, mulattoes, negroes, and a few Indians.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_394" id="Page_394">[Pg 394]</a></span>At the next town, Tabatinga, the lieutenant entered
+the territory of Brazil. When his boat, bearing the
+American flag, was descried at that place, the Brazilian
+flag was hoisted; and when the lieutenant landed,
+dressed in uniform, he was received by the commandant,
+also in uniform, to whom he presented his passport
+from the Brazilian minister at Washington. As
+soon as this document was perused, and the lieutenant's
+rank ascertained, a salute of seven guns was
+fired from the fort; and the commandant treated him
+with great civility, and entertained him at his table,
+giving him roast beef, which was a great treat.</p>
+
+<p>It was quite pleasant, after coming from the Peruvian
+villages, which are all nearly hidden in the
+woods, to see that Tabatinga had the forest cleared
+away from about it; so that a space of forty or fifty
+acres was covered with green grass, and had a grove
+of orange-trees in its midst. The commandant told
+him that the trade of the river was increasing very
+fast; that, in 1849, scarce one thousand dollars' worth
+of goods passed up; in 1850, two thousand five hundred
+dollars; and this year, six thousand dollars.</p>
+
+<p>The sarsaparilla seems thus far to have been the
+principal article of commerce; but here they find
+another becoming of importance,&mdash;<i>manteca</i>, or oil
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_395" id="Page_395">[Pg 395]</a></span>made of turtle-eggs. The season for making manteca
+generally ends by the 1st of November. A commandant
+is appointed every year to take care of the
+beaches, prevent disorder, and administer justice.
+Sentinels are placed at the beginning of August, when
+the turtles commence depositing their eggs. They
+see that no one wantonly interferes with the turtles,
+or destroys the eggs. The process of making the oil
+is very disgusting. The eggs are collected, thrown
+into a canoe, and trodden into a mass with the feet.
+Water is poured on, and the mass is left to stand in
+the sun for several days. The oil rises to the top, is
+skimmed off, and boiled in large copper boilers. It is
+then put in earthen pots of about forty-five pounds'
+weight. Each pot is worth, on the beach, one dollar
+and thirty cents; and at Par&aacute;, from two and a half to
+three dollars. The beaches of the Amazon and its
+tributaries yield from five to six thousand pots
+annually. It is used for the same purposes as lard
+with us.</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_396" id="Page_396">[Pg 396]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XIV.</h2>
+
+<h3>HERNDON'S EXPEDITION CONCLUDED.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>On Jan. 4, at about the point of the junction
+of the Purus River with the Amazon, Lieut.
+Herndon remarks, "The banks of the river are
+now losing the character of savage and desolate
+solitude that characterizes them above, and begin to
+show signs of habitation and cultivation. We passed
+to-day several farms, with neatly framed and plastered
+houses, and a schooner-rigged vessel lying off several
+of them."</p>
+
+<p>They arrived at the junction of the River Negro.
+This is one of the largest of the tributaries of the
+Amazon, and derives its name from the blackness of
+its waters. When taken up in a tumbler, the water
+is a light-red color, like a pale juniper-water, and is
+probably colored by some such berry. This river,
+opposite the town of Barra, is about a mile and a half
+wide, and very beautiful. It is navigable for almost
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_397" id="Page_397">[Pg 397]</a></span>any draughts to the Masaya, a distance of about four
+hundred miles: there the rapids commence, and the
+farther ascent must be made in boats. By this river,
+a communication exists with the Orinoco, by means
+of a remarkable stream, the Cassaquiare, which seems
+to have been formed for the sole purpose of connecting
+these two majestic rivers, and the future dwellers
+upon them, in the bonds of perpetual union. Humboldt,
+the great traveller and philosopher, thus speaks
+of it, "The Cassaquiare, as broad as the Rhine, and
+whose course is one hundred and eighty miles in
+length, will not much longer form in vain a navigable
+canal between two basins of rivers which have a
+surface of one hundred and ninety thousand square
+leagues. The grain of New Grenada will be carried
+to the banks of the Rio Negro; boats will descend
+from the sources of the Napo and the Ucayali, from
+the Andes of Quito and Upper Peru, to the mouths of
+the Orinoco. A country nine or ten times larger
+than Spain, and enriched with the most varied productions,
+is accessible in every direction by the
+medium of the natural canal of the Cassaquiare and
+the bifurcation of the rivers."</p>
+
+<p>The greatest of all the tributaries of the Amazon
+is the Madeira, whose junction our travellers next
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_398" id="Page_398">[Pg 398]</a></span>reached. For four hundred and fifty miles from its
+mouth, there is good navigation: then occur cascades,
+which are navigable only for boats, and occupy three
+hundred and fifty miles, above which the river is
+navigable for large vessels, by its great tributaries,
+into Bolivia and Brazil.</p>
+
+<p>They next entered the country where the cocoa is
+regularly cultivated; and the banks of the river present
+a much less desolate and savage appearance than
+they do above. The cocoa-trees have a yellow-colored
+leaf; and this, together with their regularity of size,
+distinguishes them from the surrounding forest.
+Lieut. Herndon says, "I do not know a prettier place
+than one of these plantations. The trees interlock
+their branches, and, with their large leaves, make a
+shade impenetrable to any ray of the sun; and the
+large, golden-colored fruits, hanging from branch and
+trunk, shine through the green with a most beautiful
+effect. This is the time of the harvest; and we found
+the people of every plantation engaged in the open
+space before the house in breaking open the shells of
+the fruit, and spreading the seed to dry in the sun.
+They make a pleasant drink for a hot day by pressing
+out the juice of the gelatinous pulp that envelops the
+seeds. It is called cocoa-wine: it is a white, viscid
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_399" id="Page_399">[Pg 399]</a></span>liquor, has an agreeable, acid taste, and is very refreshing."</p>
+
+<p>We must hasten on, and pass without notice many
+spots of interest on the river; but, as we have now
+reached a comparatively civilized and known region,
+it is less necessary to be particular. The Tapajos
+River stretches its branches to the town of Diamantino,
+situated at the foot of the mountains, where
+diamonds are found. Lieut. Herndon saw some of
+the diamonds and gold-sand in the possession of a resident
+of Santarem, who had traded much on the river.
+The gold-dust appeared to him equal in quality to that
+he had seen from California. Gold and diamonds,
+which are always united in this region as in many
+others, are found especially in the numerous water-courses,
+and also throughout the whole country.
+After the rains, the children of Diamantino hunt for
+the gold contained in the earth even of the streets,
+and in the bed of the River Ouro, which passes through
+the city; and they often collect considerable quantities.
+It is stated that diamonds are sometimes found
+in the stomachs of the fowls. The quantity of diamonds
+found in a year varies from two hundred and
+fifty to five hundred <i>oitavas</i>; the oitava being about
+seventeen carats. The value depends upon the <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_400" id="Page_400">[Pg 400]</a></span>quality
+and size of the specimen, and can hardly be reduced
+to an estimate. It is seldom that a stone of
+over half an oitava is found; and such a one is worth
+from two to three hundred dollars.</p>
+
+<p>As an offset to the gold and diamonds, we have this
+picture of the climate: "From the rising to the setting
+of the sun, clouds of stinging insects blind the
+traveller, and render him frantic by the torments
+they cause. Take a handful of the finest sand, and
+throw it above your head, and you would then have
+but a faint idea of the number of these demons who
+tear the skin to pieces. It is true, these insects disappear
+at night, but only to give place to others yet
+more formidable. Large bats (true, thirsty vampires)
+literally throng the forests, cling to the hammocks,
+and, finding a part of the body exposed, rest lightly
+there, and drain it of blood. The alligators are so
+numerous, and the noise they make so frightful, that
+it is impossible to sleep."</p>
+
+<p>At Santarem they were told the tide was perceptible,
+but did not perceive it. At Gurupa it was very
+apparent. This point is about five hundred miles
+from the sea. About thirty-five miles below Gurupa
+commences the great estuary of the Amazon. The
+river suddenly flows out into an immense bay, which
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_401" id="Page_401">[Pg 401]</a></span>might appropriately be called the "bay of a thousand
+islands;" for it is cut up into innumerable channels.
+The travellers ran for days through channels varying
+from fifty to five hundred yards in width, between
+numberless islands. This is the India-rubber country.
+The shores are low: indeed, one seldom sees the land
+at all; the trees on the banks generally standing in
+the water. The party stopped at one of the establishments
+for making India-rubber. The house was built
+of light poles, and on piles, to keep it out of the
+water, which flowed under and around it. This was
+the store, and, rude as it was, was a palace compared
+to the hut of the laborer who gathers the India-rubber.
+The process is as follows: A longitudinal gash
+is made in the bark of the tree with a hatchet. A
+wedge of wood is inserted to keep the gash open; and
+a small clay cup is stuck to the tree, beneath the gash.
+The cups may be stuck as close together as possible
+around the tree. In four or five hours, the milk has
+ceased to run, and each wound has given from three
+to five table-spoonfuls. The gatherer then collects it
+from the cups, pours it into an earthen vessel, and
+commences the operation of forming it into shapes,
+and smoking it. This must be done at once, as the
+juice soon coagulates. A fire is made on the ground,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_402" id="Page_402">[Pg 402]</a></span>and a rude funnel placed over it to collect the smoke.
+The maker of the rubber now takes his last, if he is
+making shoes, or his mould, which is fastened to the
+end of a stick, pours the milk over it with a cup, and
+passes it slowly several times through the smoke
+until it is dry. He then pours on the other coats
+until he has the required thickness, smoking each
+coating till it is dry. From twenty to forty coats
+make a shoe. The soles and heels are, of course, given
+more coats than the body of the shoe. The figures
+on the shoes are made by tracing them on the rubber,
+while soft, with a coarse needle, or bit of wire. This
+is done two days after the coating. In a week, the
+shoes are taken from the last. The coating occupies
+about twenty-five minutes.</p>
+
+<p>The tree is tall, straight, and has a smooth bark.
+It sometimes reaches a diameter of thirteen inches or
+more. Each incision makes a rough wound on the
+tree, which, although it does not kill it, renders it
+useless, because a smooth place is wanted to which
+to attach the cups. The milk is white and tasteless,
+and may be taken into the stomach with impunity.</p>
+
+<p>Our travellers arrived at Par&aacute; on the 12th of April,
+1852, and were most hospitably and kindly received
+by Mr. Norris, the American consul.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_403" id="Page_403">[Pg 403]</a></span>The journey of our travellers ends here. Lieut.
+Herndon's book is full of instruction, conveyed in a
+pleasant style. He seems to have manifested throughout
+good judgment, good temper, energy, and industry.
+He had no collisions with the authorities or with individuals,
+and, on his part, seems to have met friendly
+feelings and good offices throughout his whole route.</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>William Lewis Herndon was born in Fredericksburg, Va.,
+on the 25th of October, 1813. He entered the navy at the age of
+fifteen; served in the Mexican war; and was afterwards engaged
+for three years, with his brother-in-law, Lieut. Maury, in the National
+Observatory at Washington. In 1851-2, he explored the
+Amazon River, under commission of the United-States Government.
+In 1857, he was commander of the steamer "Central
+America," which left Havana for New York on Sept. 8, having on
+board four hundred and seventy-four passengers and a crew of one
+hundred and five men, and about two million dollars of gold. On
+Sept. 11, during a violent gale from the north-east and a heavy
+sea, she sprung a leak, and sunk, on the evening of Sept. 12,
+near the outer edge of the Gulf Stream, in lat. 31&deg; 44&acute; N. Only
+one hundred and fifty of the persons on board were saved, including
+the women and children. The gallant commander of the
+steamer was seen standing upon the wheel-house at the time of
+her sinking.</p>
+
+<p>In a former chapter, we have told the fate of Sir Humphrey
+Gilbert. How fair a counterpart of that heroic death is this of
+the gallant Herndon!</p></div>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_404" id="Page_404">[Pg 404]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XV.</h2>
+
+<h3>LATEST EXPLORATIONS.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>In the year 1845, an English gentleman, Henry
+Walter Bates, visited the region of the Amazon
+for the purpose of scientific exploration. He went
+prepared to spend years in the country, in order to
+study diligently its natural productions. His stay
+was protracted until 1859, during which time he
+resided successively at Par&aacute;, Santarem, Ega, Barra,
+and other places; making his abode for months, or
+even years, in each. His account of his observations
+and discoveries was published after his return,
+and affords us the best information we possess respecting
+the country, its inhabitants, and its productions,
+brought down almost to the present time. Our
+extracts relate to the cities, the river and its shores,
+the inhabitants civilized and savage, the great tributary
+rivers, the vegetation, and the animals of various
+kinds.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_405" id="Page_405">[Pg 405]</a></span>Before proceeding with our extracts, we will remark
+the various names of the river.</p>
+
+<p>It is sometimes called, from the name of its discoverer,
+"Orellana." This name is appropriate and well-sounding,
+but is not in general use.</p>
+
+<p>The name of "Mara&ntilde;on," pronounced Maranyon,
+is still often used. It is probably derived from the
+natives.</p>
+
+<p>It is called "The River of the Amazons," from the
+fable of its former inhabitants.</p>
+
+<p>This name is shortened into "The Amazons," and,
+without the plural sign, "The Amazon," in common
+use.</p>
+
+<p>Above the junction of the River Negro, the river
+is designated as "The Upper Amazon," or "Solimoens."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">PAR&Aacute;.</p>
+
+<p>"On the morning of the 28th of May, 1848, we arrived
+at our destination. The appearance of the city
+at sunrise was pleasing in the highest degree. It is
+built on a low tract of land, having only one small
+rocky elevation at its southern extremity: it therefore
+affords no amphitheatral view from the river;
+but the white buildings roofed with red tiles, the
+numerous towers and cupolas of churches and <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_406" id="Page_406">[Pg 406]</a></span>convents,
+the crowns of palm-trees reared above the
+buildings, all sharply defined against the clear blue
+sky, give an appearance of lightness and cheerfulness
+which is most exhilarating. The perpetual forest
+hems the city in on all sides landwards; and, towards
+the suburbs, picturesque country-houses are seen
+scattered about, half buried in luxuriant foliage.</p>
+
+<p>"The impressions received during our first walk
+can never wholly fade from my mind. After traversing
+the few streets of tall, gloomy, convent-looking
+buildings near the port, inhabited chiefly by merchants
+and shopkeepers; along which idle soldiers,
+dressed in shabby uniforms, carrying their muskets
+carelessly over their arms; priests; negresses with
+red water-jars on their heads; sad-looking Indian
+women, carrying their naked children astride on their
+hips; and other samples of the motley life of the place,&mdash;were
+seen; we passed down a long, narrow street
+leading to the suburbs. Beyond this, our road lay
+across a grassy common, into a picturesque lane leading
+to the virgin forest. The long street was inhabited
+by the poorer class of the population. The
+houses were mostly in a dilapidated condition; and
+signs of indolence and neglect were everywhere visible.
+But amidst all, and compensating every defect,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_407" id="Page_407">[Pg 407]</a></span>rose the overpowering beauty of the vegetation.
+The massive dark crowns of shady mangoes were
+seen everywhere among the dwellings, amidst fragrant,
+blossoming orange, lemon, and other tropical
+fruit-trees,&mdash;some in flower, others in fruit at various
+stages of ripeness. Here and there, shooting
+above the more dome-like and sombre trees, were
+the smooth columnar stems of palms, bearing aloft
+their magnificent crowns of finely-cut fronds. On
+the boughs of the taller and more ordinary-looking
+trees sat tufts of curiously leaved parasites. Slender
+woody lianas hung in festoons from the branches, or
+were suspended in the form of cords and ribbons;
+while luxuriant creeping plants overran alike tree-trunks,
+roofs, and walls, or toppled over palings in
+copious profusion of foliage.</p>
+
+<p>"As we continued our walk, the brief twilight commenced;
+and the sounds of multifarious life came from
+the vegetation around,&mdash;the whirring of cicadas; the
+shrill stridulation of a vast number of crickets and
+grasshoppers, each species sounding its peculiar
+note; the plaintive hooting of tree-frogs, all blended
+together in one continuous ringing sound,&mdash;the audible
+expression of the teeming profusion of Nature.
+This uproar of life, I afterwards found, never wholly
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_408" id="Page_408">[Pg 408]</a></span>ceased, night or day: in course of time, I became,
+like other residents, accustomed to it. After my return
+to England, the death-like stillness of summer
+days in the country appeared to me as strange as the
+ringing uproar did on my first arrival at Par&aacute;."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">CAMET&Aacute;.</p>
+
+<p>"I staid at Camet&aacute; five weeks, and made a considerable
+collection of the natural productions of the
+neighborhood. The town, in 1849, was estimated to
+contain about five thousand inhabitants. The productions
+of the district are cacao, India-rubber, and
+Brazil nuts. The most remarkable feature in the
+social aspect of the place is the mixed nature of the
+population,&mdash;the amalgamation of the white and Indian
+races being here complete. The aborigines
+were originally very numerous on the western bank
+of the Tocantins; the principal tribe being the Camet&aacute;s,
+from which the city takes its name. They were
+a superior nation, settled, and attached to agriculture,
+and received with open arms the white immigrants
+who were attracted to the district by its fertility,
+natural beauty, and the healthfulness of the climate.
+The Portuguese settlers were nearly all males. The
+Indian women were good-looking, and made excellent
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_409" id="Page_409">[Pg 409]</a></span>wives; so the natural result has been, in the course
+of two centuries, a complete blending of the two
+races.</p>
+
+<p>"The town consists of three long streets running
+parallel to the river, with a few shorter ones crossing
+them at right angles. The houses are very plain;
+being built, as usual in this country, simply of a
+strong framework, filled up with mud, and coated
+with white plaster. A few of them are of two or
+three stories. There are three churches, and also a
+small theatre, where a company of native actors, at
+the time of my visit, were representing light Portuguese
+plays with considerable taste and ability. The
+people have a reputation all over the province for
+energy and perseverance; and it is often said that
+they are as keen in trade as the Portuguese. The
+lower classes are as indolent and sensual here as in
+other parts of the province,&mdash;a moral condition not
+to be wondered at, where perpetual summer reigns,
+and where the necessaries of life are so easily obtained.
+But they are light-hearted, quick-witted, communicative,
+and hospitable. I found here a native
+poet, who had written some pretty verses, showing
+an appreciation of the natural beauties of the country;
+and was told that the Archbishop of Bahia, the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_410" id="Page_410">[Pg 410]</a></span>primate of Brazil, was a native of Camet&aacute;. It is interesting
+to find the mamelucos (half-breeds) displaying
+talent and enterprise; for it shows that degeneracy
+does not necessarily result from the mixture of
+white and Indian blood.</p>
+
+<p>"The forest behind Camet&aacute; is traversed by several
+broad roads, which lead over undulating ground many
+miles into the interior. They pass generally under
+shade, and part of the way through groves of coffee
+and orange trees, fragrant plantations of cacao, and
+tracts of second-growth woods. The narrow, broad-watered
+valleys, with which the land is intersected,
+alone have remained clothed with primeval forest, at
+least near the town. The houses along these beautiful
+roads belong chiefly to mameluco, mulatto, and
+Indian families, each of which has its own small
+plantation. There are only a few planters with large
+establishments; and these have seldom more than a
+dozen slaves. Besides the main roads, there are endless
+by-paths, which thread the forest, and communicate
+with isolated houses. Along these the traveller
+may wander day after day, without leaving the shade,
+and everywhere meet with cheerful, simple, and hospitable
+people."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_411" id="Page_411">[Pg 411]</a></span>RIVERS AND CREEKS.</p>
+
+<p>"We made many excursions down the Irritiri, and
+saw much of these creeks. The Magoary is a magnificent
+channel: the different branches form quite a
+labyrinth, and the land is everywhere of little elevation.
+All these smaller rivers throughout the Par&aacute;
+estuary are of the nature of creeks. The land is so
+level, that the short local rivers have no sources and
+downward currents, like rivers, as we understand
+them. They serve the purpose of draining the land;
+but, instead of having a constant current one way,
+they have a regular ebb and flow with the tide. The
+natives call them <i>igarap&eacute;s</i>, or canoe-paths. They are
+characteristic of the country. The land is everywhere
+covered with impenetrable forests: the houses
+and villages are all on the water-side, and nearly all
+communication is by water. This semi-aquatic life
+of the people is one of the most interesting features
+of the country. For short excursions, and for fishing
+in still waters, a small boat, called <i>montaria</i>, is universally
+used. It is made of five planks,&mdash;a broad
+one for the bottom, bent into the proper shape by
+the action of heat, two narrow ones for the sides,
+and two triangular pieces for stem and stern. It has
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_412" id="Page_412">[Pg 412]</a></span>no rudder: the paddle serves for both steering and
+propelling. The montaria takes here the place of the
+horse, mule, or camel of other regions. Besides one
+or more montarias, almost every family has a larger
+canoe, called <i>igarit&eacute;</i>. This is fitted with two masts,
+a rudder, and keel, and has an arched awning or
+cabin near the stern, made of a framework of tough
+<i>lianas</i>, thatched with palm-leaves. In the igarit&eacute;,
+they will cross stormy rivers fifteen or twenty miles
+broad. The natives are all boat-builders. It is often
+remarked by white residents, that the Indian is a carpenter
+and shipwright by intuition. It is astonishing
+to see in what crazy vessels these people will risk
+themselves. I have seen Indians cross rivers in a
+leaky montaria when it required the nicest equilibrium
+to keep the leak just above water: a movement
+of a hair's-breadth would send all to the bottom; but
+they manage to cross in safety. If a squall overtakes
+them as they are crossing in a heavily-laden canoe,
+they all jump overboard, and swim about until the
+heavy sea subsides, when they re-embark."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">JUNCTION OF THE MADEIRA.</p>
+
+<p>"Our course lay through narrow channels between
+islands. We passed the last of these, and then <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_413" id="Page_413">[Pg 413]</a></span>beheld
+to the south a sea-like expanse of water, where
+the Madeira, the greatest tributary of the Amazons,
+after two thousand miles of course, blends its waters
+with those of the king of rivers. I was hardly prepared
+for a junction of waters on so vast a scale as
+this, now nearly nine hundred miles from the sea.
+While travelling week after week along the somewhat
+monotonous stream, often hemmed in between
+islands, and becoming thoroughly familiar with it, my
+sense of the magnitude of this vast water-system had
+become gradually deadened; but this noble sight renewed
+the first feelings of wonder. One is inclined,
+in such places as these, to think the Paraenses do
+not exaggerate much when they call the Amazons
+the Mediterranean of South America. Beyond the
+mouth of the Madeira, the Amazons sweeps down in
+a majestic reach, to all appearance not a whit less in
+breadth before than after this enormous addition to
+its waters. The Madeira does not ebb and flow simultaneously
+with the Amazons; it rises and sinks
+about two months earlier: so that it was now fuller
+than the main river. Its current, therefore, poured
+forth freely from its mouth, carrying with it a long
+line of floating trees, and patches of grass, which had
+been torn from its crumbly banks in the lower part of
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_414" id="Page_414">[Pg 414]</a></span>its course. The current, however, did not reach the
+middle of the main stream, but swept along nearer to
+the southern shore.</p>
+
+<p>"The Madeira is navigable 480 miles from its
+mouth: a series of cataracts and rapids then commences,
+which extends, with some intervals of quiet
+water, about 160 miles, beyond which is another long
+stretch of navigable stream."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">JUNCTION OF THE RIO NEGRO.</p>
+
+<p>"A brisk wind from the east sprung up early in
+the morning of the 22d: we then hoisted all sail, and
+made for the mouth of the Rio Negro. This noble
+stream, at its junction with the Amazons, seems, from
+its position, to be a direct continuation of the main
+river; while the Solimoens, which joins it at an angle,
+and is somewhat narrower than its tributary, appears
+to be a branch, instead of the main trunk, of the vast
+water-system.</p>
+
+<p>"The Rio Negro broadens considerably from its
+mouth upward, and presents the appearance of a
+great lake; its black-dyed waters having no current,
+and seeming to be dammed up by the impetuous flow
+of the yellow, turbid Solimoens, which here belches
+forth a continuous line of uprooted trees, and patches
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_415" id="Page_415">[Pg 415]</a></span>of grass, and forms a striking contrast with its tributary.
+In crossing, we passed the line a little more
+than half-way over, where the waters of the two
+rivers meet, and are sharply demarcated from each
+other. On reaching the opposite shore, we found a
+remarkable change. All our insect pests had disappeared,
+as if by magic, even from the hold of the
+canoe: the turmoil of an agitated, swiftly-flowing
+river, and its torn, perpendicular, earthy banks, had
+given place to tranquil water, and a coast indented
+with snug little bays, fringed with sloping, sandy
+beaches. The low shore, and vivid, light-green, endlessly
+varied foliage, which prevailed on the south
+side of the Amazons, were exchanged for a hilly
+country, clothed with a sombre, rounded, and monotonous
+forest. A light wind carried us gently along
+the coast to the city of Barra, which lies about seven
+or eight miles within the mouth of the river.</p>
+
+<p>"The town of Barra is built on a tract of elevated
+but very uneven land, on the left bank of the Rio
+Negro, and contained, in 1850, about three thousand
+inhabitants. It is now the principal station for the
+lines of steamers which were established in 1853; and
+passengers and goods are trans-shipped here for the
+Solimoens and Peru. A steamer runs once a <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_416" id="Page_416">[Pg 416]</a></span>fortnight
+between Par&aacute; and Barra; and another as often
+between this place and Nauta, in the Peruvian territory."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">MAMELUCOS, OR HALF-BREEDS.</p>
+
+<p>"We landed at one of the cacao-plantations. The
+house was substantially built; the walls formed of
+strong, upright posts, lathed across, plastered with
+mud, and whitewashed; and the roof tiled. The family
+were Mamelucos, or offspring of the European and
+the Indian. They seemed to be an average sample
+of the poorer class of cacao-growers. All were loosely
+dressed, and barefooted. A broad veranda extended
+along one side of the house, the floor of which was
+simply the well-trodden earth; and here hammocks
+were slung between the bare upright supports, a
+large rush-mat being spread on the ground, upon
+which the stout, matron-like mistress, with a tame
+parrot perched upon her shoulder, sat sewing with
+two pretty-looking mulatto-girls. The master, coolly
+clad in shirt and drawers, the former loose about his
+neck, lay in his hammock, smoking a long gaudily
+painted wooden pipe. The household utensils&mdash;earthenware
+jars, water-pots, and sauce-pans&mdash;lay at one
+end, near which was a wood-fire, with the ever-ready
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_417" id="Page_417">[Pg 417]</a></span>coffee-pot simmering on the top of a clay tripod. A
+large shed stood a short distance off, embowered in a
+grove of banana, papaw, and mango trees; and under
+it were the troughs, ovens, sieves, and other apparatus,
+for the preparation of mandioc. The cleared
+space around the house was only a few yards in
+extent: beyond it lay the cacao-plantations, which
+stretched on each side parallel to the banks of the
+river. There was a path through the forest, which
+led to the mandioc-fields, and, several miles beyond,
+to other houses on the banks of an interior channel.
+We were kindly received, as is always the case when
+a stranger visits these out-of-the-way habitations; the
+people being invariably civil and hospitable. We had
+a long chat, took coffee; and, on departing, one of the
+daughters sent a basketful of oranges, for our use,
+down to the canoe."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">M&Uacute;RA INDIANS.</p>
+
+<p>"On the 9th of January, we arrived at Matari, a
+miserable little settlement of M&uacute;ra Indians. Here
+we again anchored, and went ashore. The place consisted
+of about twenty slightly built mud-hovels, and
+had a most forlorn appearance, notwithstanding the
+luxuriant forest in its rear. The absence of the usual
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_418" id="Page_418">[Pg 418]</a></span>cultivated trees and plants gave the place a naked
+and poverty-stricken aspect. I entered one of the
+hovels, where several women were employed cooking
+a meal. Portions of a large fish were roasting over a
+fire made in the middle of the low chamber; and the
+entrails were scattered about the floor, on which the
+women, with their children, were squatted. These
+had a timid, distrustful expression of countenance;
+and their bodies were begrimed with black mud,
+which is smeared over the skin as a protection
+against musquitoes. The children were naked: the
+women wore petticoats of coarse cloth, stained in
+blotches with <i>murixi</i>, a dye made from the bark of
+a tree. One of them wore a necklace of monkey's
+teeth. There were scarcely any household utensils:
+the place was bare, with the exception of two dirty
+grass hammocks hung in the corners. I missed the
+usual mandioc-sheds behind the house, with their
+surrounding cotton, cacao, coffee, and lemon trees.
+Two or three young men of the tribe were lounging
+about the low, open doorway. They were stoutly-built
+fellows, but less well-proportioned than the
+semi-civilized Indians of the Lower Amazons generally
+are. The gloomy savagery, filth, and poverty
+of the people in this place made me feel
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_419" id="Page_419">[Pg 419]</a></span>quite melancholy; and I was glad to return to the
+canoe."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">MARAU&Aacute; TRIBE.</p>
+
+<p>A pleasanter picture is presented by the Indians
+of the Marau&aacute; tribe. Our traveller thus describes a
+visit to them:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"Our longest trip was to some Indian houses, a
+distance of fifteen or eighteen miles up the Sap&oacute;;
+a journey made with one Indian paddler, and occupying
+a whole day. The stream is not more than forty
+or fifty yards broad: its waters are dark in color, and
+flow, as in all these small rivers, partly under shade,
+between two lofty walls of forest. We passed, in
+ascending, seven habitations, most of them hidden
+in the luxuriant foliage of the banks; their sites
+being known only by small openings in the compact
+wall of forest, and the presence of a canoe or two
+tied up in little shady ports. The inhabitants are
+chiefly Indians of the Marau&aacute; tribe, whose original
+territory comprises all the by-streams lying between
+the Jutah&iacute; and the Juru&aacute;, near the mouths of both
+these great tributaries. They live in separate families,
+or small hordes; have no common chief; and are
+considered as a tribe little disposed to adopt civilized
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_420" id="Page_420">[Pg 420]</a></span>customs, or be friendly with the whites. One of the
+houses belonged to a Jur&iacute; family; and we saw the
+owner, an erect, noble-looking old fellow, tattooed, as
+customary with his tribe, in a large patch over the
+middle of his face, fishing, under the shade of a colossal
+tree, with hook and line. He saluted us in the
+usual grave and courteous manner of the better sort
+of Indians as we passed by.</p>
+
+<p>"We reached the last house, or rather two houses,
+about ten o'clock, and spent there several hours during
+the heat of the day. The houses, which stood
+on a high, clayey bank, were of quadrangular shape,
+partly open, like sheds, and partly enclosed with rude,
+mud walls, forming one or two chambers. The inhabitants,
+a few families of Marau&aacute;s, received us in a
+frank, smiling manner. None of them were tattooed:
+but the men had great holes pierced in their ear-lobes,
+in which they insert plugs of wood; and their
+lips were drilled with smaller holes. One of the
+younger men, a fine, strapping fellow, nearly six feet
+high, with a large aquiline nose, who seemed to wish
+to be particularly friendly to me, showed me the use
+of these lip-holes, by fixing a number of little sticks
+in them, and then twisting his mouth about, and
+going through a pantomime to represent defiance in
+the presence of an enemy.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_421" id="Page_421">[Pg 421]</a></span>"We left these friendly people about four o'clock
+in the afternoon, and, in descending the umbrageous
+river, stopped, about half-way down, at another house,
+built in one of the most charming situations I had yet
+seen in this country. A clean, narrow, sandy pathway
+led from the shady port to the house, through
+a tract of forest of indescribable luxuriance. The
+buildings stood on an eminence in the middle of a
+level, cleared space; the firm, sandy soil, smooth as
+a floor, forming a broad terrace round them. The
+owner was a semi-civilized Indian, named Manoel;
+a dull, taciturn fellow, who, together with his wife
+and children, seemed by no means pleased at being
+intruded on in their solitude. The family must have
+been very industrious; for the plantations were very
+extensive, and included a little of almost all kinds of
+cultivated tropical productions,&mdash;fruit-trees, vegetables,
+and even flowers for ornament. The silent old
+man had surely a fine appreciation of the beauties of
+Nature; for the site he had chosen commanded a
+view of surprising magnificence over the summits of
+the forest; and, to give a finish to the prospect, he
+had planted a large number of banana-trees in the
+foreground, thus concealing the charred and dead
+stumps which would otherwise have marred the effect
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_422" id="Page_422">[Pg 422]</a></span>of the rolling sea of greenery. The sun set over the
+tree-tops before we left this little Eden; and the remainder
+of our journey was made slowly and pleasantly,
+under the checkered shade of the river banks,
+by the light of the moon."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE FOREST.</p>
+
+<p>The following passage describes the scenery of
+one of the peculiar channels by which the waters
+of the Amazon communicate with those of the Par&aacute;
+River:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"The forest wall under which we are now moving
+consists, besides palms, of a great variety of ordinary
+forest-trees. From the highest branches of these,
+down to the water, sweep ribbons of climbing-plants
+of the most diverse and ornamental foliage possible.
+Creeping convolvuli and others have made use of the
+slender lianas and hanging air-roots as ladders to
+climb by. Now and then appears a mimosa or other
+tree, having similar fine pinnate foliage; and thick
+masses of ing&aacute; border the water, from whose branches
+hang long bean-pods, of different shape and size according
+to the species, some of them a yard in length.
+Flowers there are very few. I see now and then
+a gorgeous crimson blossom on long spikes, <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_423" id="Page_423">[Pg 423]</a></span>ornamenting
+the sombre foliage towards the summits of
+the forest. I suppose it to belong to a climber
+of the Combretaceous order. There are also a few
+yellow and violet trumpet-flowers. The blossoms of
+the ing&aacute;s, although not conspicuous, are delicately
+beautiful. The forest all along offers so dense a
+front, that one never obtains a glimpse into the
+interior of the wilderness."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE LIANA.</p>
+
+<p>"The plant which seems to the traveller most curious
+and singular is the liana, a kind of osier, which
+serves for cordage, and which is very abundant in all
+the hot parts of America. All the species of this
+genus have this in common, that they twine around
+the trees and shrubs in their way, and after progressively
+extending to the branches, sometimes to a prodigious
+height, throw out shoots, which, declining
+perpendicularly, strike root in the ground beneath,
+and rise again to repeat the same course of uncommon
+growth. Other filaments, again, driven obliquely
+by the winds, frequently attach themselves to contiguous
+trees, and form a confused spectacle of cord,
+some in suspension, and others stretched in every
+direction, not unfrequently resembling the rigging of
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_424" id="Page_424">[Pg 424]</a></span>a ship. Some of these lianas are as thick as the arm
+of a man; and some strangle and destroy the tree
+round which they twine, as the boa-constrictor does
+its victims. At times it happens that the tree dies
+at the root, and the trunk rots, and falls in powder,
+leaving nothing but the spirals of liana, in form of a
+tortuous column, insulated and open to the day. Thus
+Nature laughs to scorn and defies the imitations of
+Art."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">CACAO.</p>
+
+<p>"The Amazons region is the original home of the
+principal species of chocolate-tree,&mdash;the theobroma
+cacao; and it grows in abundance in the forests of
+the upper river. The forest here is cleared before
+planting, and the trees are grown in rows. The
+smaller cultivators are all very poor. Labor is
+scarce: one family generally manages its own small
+plantation of ten to fifteen thousand trees; but, at
+harvest-time, neighbors assist each other. It appeared
+to me to be an easy, pleasant life: the work
+is all done under shade, and occupies only a few
+weeks in the year.</p>
+
+<p>"The cultivated crop appears to be a precarious
+one. Little or no care, however, is bestowed on the
+trees; and weeding is done very inefficiently. The
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_425" id="Page_425">[Pg 425]</a></span>plantations are generally old, and have been made on
+the low ground near the river, which renders them
+liable to inundation when this rises a few inches
+more than the average. There is plenty of higher
+land quite suitable to the tree; but it is uncleared:
+and the want of labor and enterprise prevents the
+establishment of new plantations."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE COW-TREE.</p>
+
+<p>"We had heard a good deal about this tree, and
+about its producing from its bark a copious supply of
+milk as pleasant to drink as that of the cow. We had
+also eaten of its fruit at Par&aacute;, where it is sold in the
+streets by negro market-women: we were glad, therefore,
+to see this wonderful tree growing in its native
+wilds. It is one of the largest of the forest-monarchs,
+and is peculiar in appearance, on account of
+its deeply-scored, reddish, and ragged bark. A decoction
+of the bark, I was told, is used as a red dye
+for cloth. A few days afterward, we tasted its milk,
+which was drawn from dry logs that had been standing
+many days in the hot sun at the saw-mills. It
+was pleasant with coffee, but had a slight rankness
+when drunk pure. It soon thickens to a glue, which
+is very tenacious, and is often used to cement broken
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_426" id="Page_426">[Pg 426]</a></span>crockery. I was told that it was not safe to drink
+much of it; for a slave had recently lost his life
+through taking it too freely.</p>
+
+<p>"To our great disappointment, we saw no flowers,
+or only such as were insignificant in appearance. I
+believe it is now tolerably well ascertained that the
+majority of forest-trees in equatorial Brazil have
+small and inconspicuous flowers. Flower-frequenting
+insects are also rare in the forest. Of course, they
+would not be found where their favorite food was
+wanting. In the open country, on the Lower Amazons,
+flowering trees and bushes are more abundant;
+and there a large number of floral insects are attracted.
+The forest-bees in South America are
+more frequently seen feeding on the sweet sap which
+exudes from the trees than on flowers."</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_427" id="Page_427">[Pg 427]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XVI.</h2>
+
+<h3>THE NATURALIST ON THE AMAZON.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>On the 16th of January, the dry season came abruptly
+to an end. The sea-breezes, which had
+been increasing in force for some days, suddenly
+ceased, and the atmosphere became misty: at length,
+heavy clouds collected where a uniform blue sky had
+for many weeks prevailed, and down came a succession
+of heavy showers, the first of which lasted a
+whole day and night. This seemed to give a new
+stimulus to animal life. On the first night, there
+was a tremendous uproar,&mdash;tree-frogs, crickets, goat-suckers,
+and owls, all joining to perform a deafening
+concert. One kind of goat-sucker kept repeating at
+intervals, throughout the night, a phrase similar to
+the Portuguese words, 'Joao corta pao,'&mdash;'John,
+cut wood;' a phrase which forms the Brazilian name
+of the bird. An owl in one of the trees muttered
+now and then a succession of syllables resembling
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_428" id="Page_428">[Pg 428]</a></span>the word 'murucututu.' Sometimes the croaking and
+hooting of frogs and toads were so loud, that we could
+not hear one another's voices within doors. Swarms
+of dragon-flies appeared in the day-time about the
+pools of water created by the rain; and ants and
+termites came forth in great numbers."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">ANTS.</p>
+
+<p>This region is the very headquarters and metropolis
+of ants. There are numerous species, differing
+in character and habits, but all of them at war
+with man, and the different species with one another.
+Our author thus relates his observations of the sa&uuml;ba-ant:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"In our first walks, we were puzzled to account
+for large mounds of earth, of a different color from
+the surrounding soil, which were thrown up in the
+plantations and woods. Some of them were very extensive,
+being forty yards in circumference, but not
+more than two feet in height. We soon ascertained
+that these were the work of the sa&uuml;bas, being the
+outworks, or domes, which overlie and protect the
+entrances to their vast subterranean galleries. On
+close examination, I found the earth of which they
+are composed to consist of very minute granules, <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_429" id="Page_429">[Pg 429]</a></span>agglomerated
+without cement, and forming many rows
+of little ridges and turrets. The difference of color
+from the superficial soil is owing to their being
+formed of the undersoil brought up from a considerable
+depth. It is very rarely that the ants are seen at
+work on these mounds. The entrances seem to be
+generally closed: only now and then, when some particular
+work is going on, are the galleries opened. In
+the larger hillocks, it would require a great amount
+of excavation to get at the main galleries; but I succeeded
+in removing portions of the dome in smaller
+hillocks, and then I found that the minor entrances
+converged, at the depth of about two feet, to one
+broad, elaborately worked gallery, or mine, which was
+four or five inches in diameter.</p>
+
+<p>"The habit of the sa&uuml;ba-ant, of clipping and carrying
+away immense quantities of leaves, has long been
+recorded in books of natural history; but it has not
+hitherto been shown satisfactorily to what use it applies
+the leaves. I discovered this only after much
+time spent in investigation. The leaves are used to
+thatch the domes which cover the entrances to their
+subterranean dwellings, thereby protecting from the
+deluging rains the young broods in the nests beneath.
+Small hillocks, covering entrances to the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_430" id="Page_430">[Pg 430]</a></span>underground chambers, may be found in sheltered
+places; and these are always thatched with leaves,
+mingled with granules of earth. The heavily-laden
+workers, each carrying its segment of leaf vertically,
+the lower end secured by its mandibles, troop up, and
+cast their burthens on the hillock; another relay of
+laborers place the leaves in position, covering them
+with a layer of earthy granules, which are brought
+one by one from the soil beneath.</p>
+
+<p>"It is a most interesting sight to see the vast
+host of busy, diminutive workers occupied on this
+work. Unfortunately, they choose cultivated trees
+for their purpose, such as the coffee and orange
+trees."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE FIRE-ANT.</p>
+
+<p>"Aveyros may be called the headquarters of the
+fire-ant, which might be fittingly termed the scourge
+of this fine river. It is found only on sandy soils, in
+open places, and seems to thrive most in the neighborhood
+of houses and weedy villages, such as Aveyros:
+it does not occur at all in the shades of the
+forest. Aveyros was deserted a few years before my
+visit, on account of this little tormentor; and the inhabitants
+had only recently returned to their houses,
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_431" id="Page_431">[Pg 431]</a></span>thinking its numbers had decreased. It is a small
+species, of a shining reddish color. The soil of the
+whole village is undermined by it. The houses are
+overrun with them: they dispute every fragment of
+food with the inhabitants, and destroy clothing for
+the sake of the starch. All eatables are obliged to
+be suspended in baskets from the rafters, and the
+cords well soaked with copaiba-balsam, which is the
+only thing known to prevent them from climbing.
+They seem to attack persons from sheer malice. If
+we stood for a few moments in the street, even at a
+distance from their nests, we were sure to be overrun,
+and severely punished; for, the moment an ant
+touched the flesh, he secured himself with his jaws,
+doubled in his tail, and stung with all his might. The
+sting is likened, by the Brazilians, to the puncture of
+a red-hot needle. When we were seated on chairs in
+the evenings, in front of the house, to enjoy a chat
+with our neighbors, we had stools to support our
+feet, the legs of which, as well as those of the chairs,
+were well anointed with the balsam. The cords of
+hammocks are obliged to be smeared in the same
+way, to prevent the ants from paying sleepers a
+visit."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_432" id="Page_432">[Pg 432]</a></span>BUTTERFLIES.</p>
+
+<p>"At Villa Nova, I found a few species of butterflies
+which occurred nowhere else on the Amazons.
+In the broad alleys of the forest, several species of
+Morpho were common. One of these is a sister-form
+to the Morpho Hecuba, and has been described under
+the name of Morpho Cisseis. It is a grand sight to
+see these colossal butterflies by twos and threes floating
+at a great height in the still air of a tropical
+morning. They flap their wings only at long intervals;
+for I have noticed them to sail a very considerable
+distance without a stroke. Their wing-muscles,
+and the thorax to which they are attached, are very
+feeble in comparison with the wide extent and weight
+of the wings; but the large expanse of these members
+doubtless assists the insects in maintaining their
+aerial course. The largest specimens of Morpho Cisseis
+measure seven inches and a half in expanse.
+Another smaller kind, which I could not capture, was
+of a pale, silvery-blue color; and the polished surface
+of its wings flashed like a silver speculum, as the
+insect flapped its wings at a great elevation in the
+sunlight."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_433" id="Page_433">[Pg 433]</a></span>THE BIRD-CATCHING SPIDER.</p>
+
+<p>"At Camet&aacute;, I chanced to verify a fact relating to
+the habits of a large, hairy spider of the genus Mygale,
+in a manner worth recording. The individual
+was nearly two inches in length of body; but the
+legs expanded seven inches, and the entire body and
+legs were covered with coarse gray and reddish
+hairs. I was attracted by a movement of the monster
+on a tree-trunk: it was close beneath a deep
+crevice in the tree, across which was stretched a
+dense white web. The lower part of the web was
+broken; and two small birds, finches, were entangled
+in the pieces. They were about the size of the English
+siskin; and I judged the two to be male and
+female. One of them was quite dead; the other lay
+under the body of the spider, not quite dead, and was
+smeared with the filthy liquor, or saliva, exuded by
+the monster. I drove away the spider, and took the
+birds; but the second one soon died. The fact of
+a species of mygale sallying forth at night, mounting
+trees, and sucking the eggs and young of hummingbirds,
+has been recorded long ago by Madame Merian
+and Palisot de Beauvois; but, in the absence of any
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_434" id="Page_434">[Pg 434]</a></span>confirmation, it has come to be discredited. From the
+way the fact has been related, it would appear that it
+had been derived from the report of natives, and had
+not been witnessed by the narrators. I found the
+circumstance to be quite a novelty to the residents
+hereabouts.</p>
+
+<p>"The mygales are quite common insects. Some
+species make their cells under stones; others form
+artificial tunnels in the earth; and some build their
+dens in the thatch of houses. The natives call them
+crab-spiders. The hairs with which they are clothed
+come off when touched, and cause a peculiar and almost
+maddening irritation. The first specimen that
+I killed and prepared was handled incautiously; and
+I suffered terribly for three days afterward. I think
+this is not owing to any poisonous quality residing in
+the hairs, but to their being short and hard, and thus
+getting into the fine creases of the skin. Some mygales
+are of immense size. One day, I saw the children
+belonging to an Indian family who collected for
+me with one of these monsters, secured by a cord
+round its waist, by which they were leading it about
+the house as they would a dog."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_435" id="Page_435">[Pg 435]</a></span>BATS.</p>
+
+<p>"At Carip&iacute;, near Par&aacute;, I was much troubled by
+bats. The room where I slept had not been used for
+many months, and the roof was open to the tiles and
+rafters. I was aroused about midnight by the rushing
+noise made by vast hosts of bats sweeping about
+the room. The air was alive with them. They had
+put out the lamp; and, when I relighted it, the place
+appeared blackened with the impish multitudes that
+were whirling round and round. After I had laid
+about well with a stick for a few minutes, they disappeared
+among the tiles; but, when all was still again,
+they returned, and once more extinguished the light.
+I took no further notice of them, and went to sleep.
+The next night, several of them got into my hammock.
+I seized them as they were crawling over me,
+and dashed them against the wall. The next morning,
+I found a wound, evidently caused by a bat, on
+my hip. This was rather unpleasant: so I set to
+work with the negroes, and tried to exterminate
+them. I shot a great many as they hung from the
+rafters; and the negroes, having mounted with ladders
+to the roof outside, routed out from beneath
+the eaves many hundreds of them, including young
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_436" id="Page_436">[Pg 436]</a></span>broods. There were altogether four species. By far
+the greater number belonged to the Dysopes perotis,
+a species having very large ears, and measuring two
+feet from tip to tip of the wings. I was never attacked
+by bats, except on this occasion. The fact of
+their sucking the blood of persons sleeping, from
+wounds which they make in the toes, is now well
+established; but it is only a few persons who are
+subject to this blood-letting."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">PARROTS.</p>
+
+<p>"On recrossing the river in the evening, a pretty
+little parrot fell from a great height headlong into the
+water near the boat, having dropped from a flock
+which seemed to be fighting in the air. One of the
+Indians secured it for me; and I was surprised to find
+the bird uninjured. There had probably been a quarrel
+about mates, resulting in our little stranger being
+temporarily stunned by a blow on the head from the
+beak of a jealous comrade. It was of the species
+called by the natives Maracan&aacute;; the plumage green,
+with a patch of scarlet under the wings. I wished to
+keep the bird alive, and tame it; but all our efforts
+to reconcile it to captivity were vain: it refused food,
+bit every one who went near it, and damaged its <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_437" id="Page_437">[Pg 437]</a></span>plumage
+in its exertions to free itself. My friends in
+Aveyros said that this kind of parrot never became
+domesticated. After trying nearly a week, I was
+recommended to lend the intractable creature to an
+old Indian woman living in the village, who was said
+to be a skilful bird-tamer. In two days, she brought it
+back almost as tame as the familiar love-birds of our
+aviaries. I kept my little pet for upward of two
+years. It learned to talk pretty well, and was considered
+quite a wonder, as being a bird usually so
+difficult of domestication. I do not know what arts
+the old woman used. Capt. Antonio said she fed it
+with her saliva.</p>
+
+<p>"Our maracan&aacute; used to accompany us sometimes
+in our rambles, one of the lads carrying it on his
+head. One day, in the middle of a long forest-road,
+it was missed, having clung probably to an overhanging
+bough, and escaped into the thicket without the
+boy perceiving it. Three hours afterwards, on our
+return by the same path, a voice greeted us in a colloquial
+tone as we passed, 'Maracan&aacute;!' We looked
+about for some time, but could not see any thing,
+until the word was repeated with emphasis, 'Maracan&aacute;!'
+when we espied the little truant half concealed
+in the foliage of a tree. He came down, and
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_438" id="Page_438">[Pg 438]</a></span>delivered himself up, evidently as much rejoiced at
+the meeting as we were."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">TURTLE-EGGS AND OIL.</p>
+
+<p>"I accompanied Cardozo in many wanderings on
+the Solimoens, or Upper Amazons, during which we
+visited the <i>praias</i> (sand-islands), the turtle-pools in
+the forests, and the by-streams and lakes in the great
+desert river. His object was mainly to superintend
+the business of digging up turtle-eggs on the sand-banks;
+having been elected <i>commandante</i> for the year
+of the <i>praia-real</i> (royal sand-island) of Shimuni, the
+one lying nearest to Ega. There are four of these
+royal praias within the district, all of which are visited
+annually by the Ega people, for the purpose of
+collecting eggs, and extracting oil from their yolks.
+Each has its commander, whose business is to make
+arrangements for securing to every inhabitant an
+equal chance in the egg-harvest, by placing sentinels
+to protect the turtles while laying. The turtles descend
+from the interior pools to the main river in
+July and August, before the outlets dry up, and then
+seek, in countless swarms, their favorite sand-islands;
+for it is only a few praias that are selected by them
+out of the great number existing.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_439" id="Page_439">[Pg 439]</a></span>"We left Ega, on our first trip to visit the sentinels
+while the turtles were yet laying, on the 26th of September.
+We found the two sentinels lodged in a corner
+of the praia, or sand-bank, where it commences, at
+the foot of the towering forest-wall of the island; having
+built for themselves a little rancho with poles and
+palm-leaves. Great preparations are obliged to be
+taken to avoid disturbing the sensitive turtles, who,
+previous to crawling ashore to lay, assemble in great
+shoals off the sand-bank. The men, during this time,
+take care not to show themselves, and warn off any
+fisherman who wishes to pass near the place. Their
+fires are made in a deep hollow near the borders of
+the forest, so that the smoke may not be visible. The
+passage of a boat through the shallow waters where
+the animals are congregated, or the sight of a man, or
+a fire on the sand-bank, would prevent the turtles
+from leaving the water that night to lay their eggs;
+and, if the causes of alarm were repeated once or
+twice, they would forsake the praia for some quieter
+place. Soon after we arrived, our men were sent
+with the net to catch a supply of fish for supper. In
+half an hour, four or five large basketsful were brought
+in. The sun set soon after our meal was cooked: we
+were then obliged to extinguish the fire, and remove
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_440" id="Page_440">[Pg 440]</a></span>our supper-materials to the sleeping-ground, a spit of
+land about a mile off; this course being necessary on
+account of the musquitoes, which swarm at night
+on the borders of the forest.</p>
+
+<p>"I rose from my hammock at daylight, and found
+Cardozo and the men already up, watching the turtles.
+The sentinels had erected for this purpose a
+stage about fifty feet high, on a tall tree near their
+station, the ascent to which was by a roughly-made
+ladder of woody lianas. The turtles lay their eggs
+by night, leaving the water in vast crowds, and
+crawling to the central and highest part of the
+praia. These places are, of course, the last to go
+under water, when, in unusually wet seasons, the
+river rises before the eggs are hatched by the heat
+of the sand. One would almost believe from this
+that the animals used forethought in choosing a
+place; but it is simply one of those many instances
+in animals where unconscious habit has the same
+result as conscious prevision. The hours between
+midnight and dawn are the busiest. The turtles
+excavate, with their broad-webbed paws, deep holes
+in the fine sand; the first-comer, in each case, making
+a pit about three feet deep, laying, its eggs
+(about a hundred and twenty in number), and <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_441" id="Page_441">[Pg 441]</a></span>covering
+them with sand; the next making its deposit at
+the top of that of its predecessor; and so on, until
+every pit is full. The whole body of turtles frequenting
+a praia does not finish laying in less than
+fourteen or fifteen days, even when there is no
+interruption. When all have done, the area over
+which they have excavated is distinguishable from
+the rest of the praia only by signs of the sand having
+been a little disturbed.</p>
+
+<p>"On arriving at the edge of the forest, I mounted
+the sentinels' stage just in time to see the turtles
+retreating to the water on the opposite side of the
+sand-bank after having laid their eggs. The sight
+was well worth the trouble of ascending the shaky
+ladder. They were about a mile off; but the surface
+of the sand was blackened with the multitudes
+which were waddling towards the river. The margin
+of the praia was rather steep; and they all
+seemed to tumble, head-first, down the declivity, into
+the water."</p>
+
+<hr style='width: 45%;' />
+
+<p>When the turtles have finished depositing their
+eggs, the process of collecting them takes place,
+of which our author gives an account as follows:&mdash;</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_442" id="Page_442">[Pg 442]</a></span>THE EGG-HARVEST.</p>
+
+<p>"My next excursion was made in company of Senior
+Cardozo, in the season when all the population
+of the villages turns out to dig up turtle-eggs, and to
+revel on the praias. Placards were posted on the
+church-doors at Ega, announcing that the excavation
+on Shimuni would commence on the 17th October.
+We set out on the 16th, and passed on the way, in
+our well-manned igarit&eacute; (or two-masted boat), a large
+number of people, men, women, and children, in canoes
+of all sizes, wending their way as if to a great
+holiday gathering. By the morning of the 17th, some
+four hundred persons were assembled on the borders
+of the sand-bank; each family having erected a rude
+temporary shed of poles and palm-leaves to protect
+themselves from the sun and rain. Large copper kettles
+to prepare the oil, and hundreds of red earthenware
+jars, were scattered about on the sand.</p>
+
+<p>"The excavation of the <i>taboleiro</i>, collecting the
+eggs, and preparing the oil, occupied four days.
+The commandante first took down the names of all
+the masters of households, with the number of persons
+each intended to employ in digging. He then
+exacted a payment of about fourpence a head towards
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_443" id="Page_443">[Pg 443]</a></span>defraying the expense of sentinels. The whole were
+then allowed to go to the taboleiro. They ranged
+themselves round the circle, each person armed with
+a paddle, to be used as a spade; and then all began
+simultaneously to dig, on a signal being given&mdash;the
+roll of drums&mdash;by order of the commandante. It was
+an animating sight to behold the wide circle of rival
+diggers throwing up clouds of sand in their energetic
+labors, and working gradually toward the centre of
+the ring. A little rest was taken during the great
+heat of mid-day; and, in the evening, the eggs were
+carried to the huts in baskets. By the end of the
+second day, the taboleiro was exhausted: large
+mounds of eggs, some of them four or five feet in
+height, were then seen by the side of each hut, the
+produce of the labors of the family.</p>
+
+<p>"When no more eggs are to be found, the mashing
+process begins. The egg, it may be mentioned, has
+a flexible or leathery shell: it is quite round, and
+somewhat larger than a hen's egg. The whole heap
+is thrown into an empty canoe, and mashed with
+wooden prongs; but sometimes naked Indians and
+children jump into the mass, and tread it down, besmearing
+themselves with the yolk, and making about
+as filthy a scene as can well be imagined. This being
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_444" id="Page_444">[Pg 444]</a></span>finished, water is poured into the canoe, and the fatty
+mass then left for a few hours to be heated by the
+sun, on which the oil separates, and rises to the surface.
+The floating oil is afterwards skimmed off with
+long spoons, made by tying large mussel-shells to the
+end of rods, and purified over the fire in copper-kettles.
+At least six thousand jars, holding each three gallons
+of the oil, are exported annually from the Upper Amazons
+and the Madeira to Par&aacute;, where it is used for
+lighting, frying fish, and other purposes."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">ELECTRIC EELS.</p>
+
+<p>"We walked over moderately elevated and dry
+ground for about a mile, and then descended three
+or four feet to the dry bed of another creek. This
+was pierced in the same way as the former water-course,
+with round holes full of muddy water. They
+occurred at intervals of a few yards, and had the appearance
+of having been made by the hands of man.
+As we approached, I was startled at seeing a number
+of large serpent-like heads bobbing above the
+surface. They proved to be those of electric eels;
+and it now occurred to me that the round holes were
+made by these animals working constantly round and
+round in the moist, muddy soil. Their depth (some
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_445" id="Page_445">[Pg 445]</a></span>of them were at least eight feet deep) was doubtless
+due also to the movements of the eels in the soft soil,
+and accounted for their not drying up, in the fine
+season, with the rest of the creek. Thus, while
+alligators and turtles in this great inundated forest
+region retire to the larger pools during the dry
+season, the electric eels make for themselves little
+ponds in which to pass the season of drought.</p>
+
+<p>"My companions now cut each a stout pole, and
+proceeded to eject the eels in order to get at the
+other fishes, with which they had discovered the
+ponds to abound. I amused them all very much by
+showing how the electric shock from the eels could
+pass from one person to another. We joined hands
+in a line, while I touched the biggest and freshest of
+the animals on the head with my hunting-knife. We
+found that this experiment did not succeed more than
+three times with the same eel, when out of the water;
+for, the fourth time, the shock was hardly perceptible."</p>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br /><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_446" id="Page_446">[Pg 446]</a></span>
+<br />
+
+<hr />
+<br />
+<h2>CHAPTER XVII.</h2>
+
+<h3>ANIMATED NATURE.</h3>
+<br />
+
+<p>"The number and variety of climbing trees in
+the Amazons forests are interesting, taken in
+connection with the fact of the very general tendency
+of the animals also to become climbers. All
+the Amazonian, and in fact all South-American monkeys,
+are climbers. There is no group answering to
+the baboons of the Old World, which live on the
+ground. The gallinaceous birds of the country, the
+representatives of the fowls and pheasants of Asia
+and Africa, are all adapted, by the position of the
+toes, to perch on trees; and it is only on trees, at a
+great height, that they are to be seen. Many other
+similar instances could be enumerated.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">MONKEYS.</p>
+
+<p>"On the Upper Amazons, I once saw a tame individual
+of the Midas leoninus, a species first <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_447" id="Page_447">[Pg 447]</a></span>described
+by Humboldt, which was still more playful
+and intelligent than the more common M. ursulus.
+This rare and beautiful monkey is only seven inches
+in length, exclusive of the tail. It is named leoninus
+on account of the long, brown mane which hangs
+from the neck, and which gives it very much the appearance
+of a diminutive lion. In the house where
+it was kept, it was familiar with every one: its
+greatest pleasure seemed to be to climb about the
+bodies of different persons who entered. The first
+time I went in, it ran across the room straightway to
+the chair on which I had sat down, and climbed up to
+my shoulder: arrived there, it turned round, and
+looked into my face, showing its little teeth, and chattering,
+as though it would say, "Well, and how do
+<i>you</i> do?" M. de St. Hilaire relates of a species of
+this genus, that it distinguished between different
+objects depicted on an engraving. M. Ardouin
+showed it the portraits of a cat and a wasp: at
+these it became much terrified; whereas, at the sight
+of a figure of a grasshopper or beetle, it precipitated
+itself on the picture, as if to seize the objects there
+represented."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_448" id="Page_448">[Pg 448]</a></span>THE CAIAR&Aacute;RA.</p>
+
+<p>"The light-brown caiar&aacute;ra is pretty generally distributed
+over the forests of the level country. I saw
+it frequently on the banks of the Upper Amazons,
+where it was always a treat to watch a flock leaping
+amongst the trees; for it is the most wonderful performer
+in this line of the whole tribe. The troops
+consist of thirty or more individuals, which travel in
+single file. When the foremost of the flock reaches
+the outermost branch of an unusually lofty tree, he
+springs forth into the air without a moment's hesitation,
+and alights on the dome of yielding foliage
+belonging to the neighboring tree, maybe fifty feet
+beneath; all the rest following his example. They
+grasp, on falling, with hands and tail, right themselves
+in a moment, and then away they go, along
+branch and bough, to the next tree.</p>
+
+<p>"The caiar&aacute;ra is very frequently kept as a pet in
+the houses of natives. I kept one myself for about
+a year, which accompanied me in my voyages, and
+became very familiar, coming to me always on wet
+nights to share my blanket. It keeps the house
+where it is kept in a perpetual uproar. When
+alarmed or hungry, or excited by envy, it screams
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_449" id="Page_449">[Pg 449]</a></span>piteously. It is always making some noise or other,
+often screwing up its mouth, and uttering a succession
+of loud notes resembling a whistle. Mine lost
+my favor at last by killing, in one of his jealous fits,
+another and much choicer pet,&mdash;the nocturnal, owl-faced
+monkey. Some one had given this a fruit
+which the other coveted: so the two got to quarrelling.
+The owl-faced fought only with his paws,
+clawing out, and hissing, like a cat: the other soon
+obtained the mastery, and, before I could interfere,
+finished his rival by cracking its skull with its teeth.
+Upon this I got rid of him."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE COAITA.</p>
+
+<p>"The coaita is a large, black monkey, covered
+with coarse hair, and having the prominent parts of
+the face of a tawny, flesh-colored hue. The coaitas
+are called by some French zo&ouml;logists spider-monkeys,
+on account of the length and slenderness of
+their body and limbs. In these apes, the tail, as a
+prehensile organ, reaches its highest degree of perfection;
+and, on this account, it would perhaps be
+correct to consider the coaita as the extreme development
+of the American type of apes.</p>
+
+<p>"The tail of the coaita is endowed with a <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_450" id="Page_450">[Pg 450]</a></span>wonderful
+degree of flexibility. It is always in motion,
+coiling and uncoiling like the trunk of an elephant,
+and grasping whatever comes within reach.</p>
+
+<p>"The flesh of this monkey is much esteemed by the
+natives in this part of the country; and the military
+commandant every week sends a negro hunter to
+shoot one for his table. One day I went on a coaita-hunt,
+with a negro-slave to show me the way. When
+in the deepest part of the ravine, we heard a rustling
+sound in the trees overhead; and Manoel soon
+pointed out a coaita to me. There was something
+human-like in its appearance, as the lean, shaggy
+creature moved deliberately among the branches at
+a great height. I fired, but, unfortunately, only
+wounded it. It fell, with a crash, headlong, about
+twenty or thirty feet, and then caught a bough with
+its tail, which grasped it instantaneously; and there
+the animal remained suspended in mid-air. Before
+I could reload, it recovered itself, and mounted
+nimbly to the topmost branches, out of the reach
+of a fowling-piece, where we could perceive the
+poor thing apparently probing the wound with its
+fingers."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_451" id="Page_451">[Pg 451]</a></span>THE TAME COAITA.</p>
+
+<p>"I once saw a most ridiculously tame coaita. It
+was an old female, which accompanied its owner, a
+trader on the river, in all his voyages. By way of
+giving me a specimen of its intelligence and feeling,
+its master set to, and rated it soundly, calling it scamp,
+heathen, thief, and so forth, all through the copious
+Portuguese vocabulary of vituperation. The poor
+monkey, quietly seated on the ground, seemed to be
+in sore trouble at this display of anger. It began by
+looking earnestly at him; then it whined, and lastly
+rocked its body to and fro with emotion, crying
+piteously, and passing its long, gaunt arms continually
+over its forehead; for this was its habit when excited,
+and the front of the head was worn quite bald
+in consequence. At length, its master altered his
+tone. 'It's all a lie,' my old woman. 'You're an angel,
+a flower, a good, affectionate old creature,' and
+so forth. Immediately the poor monkey ceased its
+wailing, and soon after came over to where the man
+sat."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">SCARLET-FACED MONKEY.</p>
+
+<p>The most singular of the Simian family in Brazil
+are the scarlet-faced monkeys, called by the Indians
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_452" id="Page_452">[Pg 452]</a></span>Uakari, of which there are two varieties, the white
+and red-haired. Mr. Bates first met with the white-haired
+variety under the following circumstances:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>"Early one sunny morning, in the year 1855, I saw
+in the streets of Ega a number of Indians carrying
+on their shoulders down to the port, to be embarked
+on the Upper Amazons steamer, a large cage made
+of strong lianas, some twelve feet in length, and five
+in height, containing a dozen monkeys of the most grotesque
+appearance. Their bodies (about eighteen
+inches in height, exclusive of limbs) were clothed
+from neck to tail with very long, straight, and shining
+whitish hair; their heads were nearly bald,
+owing to the very short crop of thin gray hairs; and
+their faces glowed with the most vivid scarlet hue.
+As a finish to their striking physiognomy, they had
+bushy whiskers of a sandy color, meeting under the
+chin, and reddish yellow eyes. They sat gravely and
+silently in a group, and altogether presented a strange
+spectacle."</p>
+
+<p>Another interesting creature is the owl-faced night
+ape. These monkeys are not only owl-faced, but
+their habits are those of the moping bird.</p>
+
+<p>"They sleep all day long in hollow trees, and come
+forth to prey on insects, and eat fruits, only in the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_453" id="Page_453">[Pg 453]</a></span>night. They are of small size, the body being about
+a foot long, and the tail fourteen inches; and are
+clothed with soft gray and brown fur, similar in substance
+to that of the rabbit. Their physiognomy
+reminds one of an owl or tiger-cat. The face is
+round, and encircled by a ruff of whitish fur; the muzzle
+is not at all prominent; the mouth and chin are
+small; the ears are very short, scarcely appearing
+above the hair of the head; and the eyes are large,
+and yellowish in color, imparting the staring expression
+of nocturnal animals of prey. The forehead is
+whitish, and decorated with three black stripes, which,
+in one of the species, continue to the crown, and in
+the other meet on the top of the forehead.</p>
+
+<p>"These monkeys, although sleeping by day, are
+aroused by the least noise; so that, when a person
+passes by a tree in which a number of them are concealed,
+he is startled by the sudden apparition of
+a group of little striped faces crowding a hole in a
+trunk."</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Bates had one of the Nyctipith&aelig;ci for a pet,
+which was kept in a box containing a broad-mouthed
+glass jar, into which it would dive, head foremost,
+when any one entered the room, turning round inside,
+and thrusting forth its inquisitive face an instant <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_454" id="Page_454">[Pg 454]</a></span>afterward
+to stare at the intruder. The Nyctipithecus,
+when tamed, renders one very essential service to its
+owner: it clears the house of bats as well as of insect
+vermin.</p>
+
+<p>The most diminutive of the Brazilian monkeys is
+the "Hapale pygm&aelig;us," only seven inches long in
+the body, with its little face adorned with long, brown
+whiskers, which are naturally brushed back over the
+ears. The general color of the animal is brownish-tawny;
+but the tail is elegantly barred with black.</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Bates closes his account by stating that the
+total number of species of monkeys which he found
+inhabiting the margins of the Upper and Lower Amazons
+was thirty-eight, belonging to twelve different
+genera, forming two distinct families.</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE SLOTH.</p>
+
+<p>"I once had an opportunity, in one of my excursions,
+of watching the movements of a sloth. Some
+travellers in South America have described the sloth
+as very nimble in its native woods, and have disputed
+the justness of the name which has been bestowed
+upon it. The inhabitants of the Amazons region, however,
+both Indians and descendants of the Portuguese,
+hold to the common opinion, and consider the sloth
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_455" id="Page_455">[Pg 455]</a></span>as the type of laziness. It is very common for one
+native to call to another, in reproaching him for idleness,
+'Bicho do Emba&uuml;ba' (beast of the cecropia-tree);
+the leaves of the cecropia being the food of the
+sloth. It is a strange sight to see the uncouth creature,
+fit production of these silent woods, lazily
+moving from branch to branch. Every movement
+betrays, not indolence exactly, but extreme caution.
+He never looses his hold from one branch without
+first securing himself to the next; and, when he does
+not immediately find a bough to grasp with the rigid
+hooks into which his paws are so curiously transformed,
+he raises his body, supported on his hind
+legs, and claws around in search of a fresh foothold.
+After watching the animal for about half an hour, I
+gave him a charge of shot: he fell with a terrific
+crash, but caught a bough in his descent with his
+powerful claws, and remained suspended. Two days
+afterward, I found the body of the sloth on the
+ground; the animal having dropped, on the relaxation
+of the muscles, a few hours after death. In one of
+our voyages, I saw a sloth swimming across a river
+at a place where it was probably three hundred yards
+broad. Our men caught the beast, and cooked and
+ate him."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_456" id="Page_456">[Pg 456]</a></span>THE ANACONDA.</p>
+
+<p>"We had an unwelcome visitor while at anchor in
+the port. I was awakened a little after midnight, as
+I lay in my little cabin, by a heavy blow struck at the
+sides of the canoe close to my head, succeeded by the
+sound of a weighty body plunging in the water. I
+got up; but all was quiet again, except the cackle of
+fowls in our hen-coop, which hung over the side of
+the vessel, about three feet from the cabin-door.
+Next morning I found my poultry loose about the
+canoe, and a large rent in the bottom of the hen-coop,
+which was about two feet from the surface of the
+water. A couple of fowls were missing.</p>
+
+<p>"Antonio said the depredator was the sucumj&uacute;, the
+Indian name for the anaconda, or great water-serpent,
+which had for months past been haunting this
+part of the river, and had carried off many ducks and
+fowls from the ports of various houses. I was inclined
+to doubt the fact of a serpent striking at its
+prey from the water, and thought an alligator more
+likely to be the culprit, although we had not yet met
+with alligators in the river. Some days afterward,
+the young men belonging to the different settlements
+agreed together to go in search of the <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_457" id="Page_457">[Pg 457]</a></span>serpents.
+They began in a systematic manner, forming
+two parties, each embarked in three or four canoes,
+and starting from points several miles apart, whence
+they gradually approximated, searching all the little
+inlets on both sides of the river. The reptile was
+found at last, sunning itself on a log at the mouth of
+a muddy rivulet, and despatched with harpoons. I
+saw it the day after it was killed. It was not a very
+large specimen, measuring only eighteen feet nine
+inches in length, and sixteen inches in circumference
+at the widest part of the body."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">ALLIGATORS.</p>
+
+<p>"Our rancho was a large one, and was erected in a
+line with the others, near the edge of the sand-bank,
+which sloped rather abruptly to the water. During
+the first week, the people were all more or less
+troubled by alligators. Some half-dozen full-grown
+ones were in attendance off the praia, floating about
+on the lazily flowing, muddy water. The dryness of
+the weather had increased since we left Shimuni,
+the currents had slackened, and the heat in the middle
+of the day was almost insupportable. But no one
+could descend to bathe without being advanced upon
+by one or other of these hungry monsters. There
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_458" id="Page_458">[Pg 458]</a></span>was much offal cast into the river; and this, of course,
+attracted them to the place. Every day, these visitors
+became bolder: at length, they reached a pitch of
+impudence that was quite intolerable. Cardozo had
+a poodle-dog named Carlito, which some grateful
+traveller whom he had befriended had sent him from
+Rio Janeiro. He took great pride in this dog, keeping
+it well sheared, and preserving his coat as white
+as soap and water could make it. We slept in our
+rancho, in hammocks slung between the outer posts;
+a large wood fire (fed with a kind of wood abundant
+on the banks of the river, which keeps alight all
+night) being made in the middle, by the side of
+which slept Carlito on a little mat. One night, I was
+awoke by a great uproar. It was caused by Cardozo
+hurling burning firewood with loud curses at a huge
+cayman, which had crawled up the bank, and passed
+beneath my hammock (being nearest the water)
+towards the place where Carlito lay. The dog raised
+the alarm in time. The reptile backed out, and tumbled
+down the bank into the river; the sparks from
+the brands hurled at him flying from his bony hide.
+Cardozo threw a harpoon at him, but without doing
+him any harm."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_459" id="Page_459">[Pg 459]</a></span>THE PUMA.</p>
+
+<p>"One day, I was searching for insects in the bark
+of a fallen tree, when I saw a large, cat-like animal
+advancing towards the spot. It came within a dozen
+yards before perceiving me. I had no weapon with
+me but an old chisel, and was getting ready to defend
+myself if it should make a spring; when it turned
+round hastily, and trotted off. I did not obtain a very
+distinct view of it; but I could see its color was that
+of the puma, or American lion, although it was
+rather too small for that species.</p>
+
+<p>"The puma is not a common animal in the Amazons
+forests. I did not see altogether more than a dozen
+skins in the possession of the natives. The fur is of
+a fawn-color. The hunters are not at all afraid of it,
+and speak in disparaging terms of its courage. Of
+the jaguar they give a very different account."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen">THE GREAT ANT-EATER.</p>
+
+<p>"The great ant-eater, <i>tamandua</i> of the natives,
+was not uncommon here. After the first few weeks
+of residence, I was short of fresh provisions. The
+people of the neighborhood had sold me all the fowls
+they could spare. I had not yet learned to eat the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_460" id="Page_460">[Pg 460]</a></span>stale and stringy salt fish which is the staple food of
+these places; and for several days I had lived on
+rice-porridge, roasted bananas, and farinha. Florinda
+asked me whether I could eat tamandua. I told her
+almost any thing in the shape of flesh would be acceptable:
+so she went the next day with an old
+negro named Antonio, and the dogs, and, in the evening,
+brought one of the animals. The meat was
+stewed, and turned out very good, something like
+goose in flavor. The people of Carip&iacute; would not
+touch a morsel, saying it was not considered fit to eat
+in those parts. I had read, however, that it was an
+article of food in other countries of South America.
+During the next two or three weeks, whenever we
+were short of fresh meat, Antonio was always ready,
+for a small reward, to get me a tamandua.</p>
+
+<p>"The habits of the animal are now pretty well known.
+It has an excessively long, slender muzzle, and a
+worm-like, extensile tongue. Its jaws are destitute of
+teeth. The claws are much elongated, and its gait
+is very awkward. It lives on the ground, and feeds
+on termites, or white ants; the long claws being employed
+to pull in pieces the solid hillocks made by the
+insects, and the long flexible tongue to lick them up
+from the crevices."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_461" id="Page_461">[Pg 461]</a></span>THE JAGUAR.</p>
+
+<p>Our traveller, though he resided long and in various
+parts of the Amazon country, never saw there a
+jaguar. How near he came to seeing one appears
+in the following extract. This animal is the nearest
+approach which America presents to the leopards and
+tigers of the Old World.</p>
+
+<p>"After walking about half a mile, we came upon a
+dry water-course, where we observed on the margin
+of a pond the fresh tracks of a jaguar. This discovery
+was hardly made, when a rush was heard
+amidst the bushes on the top of a sloping bank, on
+the opposite side of the dried creek. We bounded
+forward: it was, however, too late; for the animal had
+sped in a few minutes far out of our reach. It was
+clear we had disturbed on our approach the jaguar
+while quenching his thirst at the water-hole. A few
+steps farther on, we saw the mangled remains of an
+alligator. The head, fore-quarters, and bony shell,
+were all that remained: but the meat was quite fresh,
+and there were many footmarks of the jaguar around
+the carcass; so that there was no doubt this had
+formed the solid part of the animal's breakfast."</p>
+<br />
+
+<p class="cen"><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_462" id="Page_462">[Pg 462]</a></span>PAR&Aacute;.</p>
+
+<p>"I arrived at Par&aacute; on the 17th of March, 1859,
+after an absence in the interior of seven years and
+a half. My old friends, English, American, and Brazilian,
+scarcely knew me again, but all gave me a
+very warm welcome. I found Par&aacute; greatly changed
+and improved. It was no longer the weedy, ruinous,
+village-looking place that it had appeared when I first
+knew it in 1848. The population had been increased
+to twenty thousand by an influx of Portuguese, Madeiran,
+and German immigrants; and, for many years
+past, the provincial government had spent their considerable
+surplus revenue in beautifying the city.
+The streets, formerly unpaved, or strewed with stones
+and sand, were now laid with concrete in a most
+complete manner: all the projecting masonry of the
+irregularly-built houses had been cleared away, and
+the buildings made more uniform. Most of the dilapidated
+houses were replaced by handsome new edifices,
+having long and elegant balconies fronting the
+first floors, at an elevation of several feet above
+the roadway. The large swampy squares had been
+drained, weeded, and planted with rows of almond
+and other trees; so that they were now a great <span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_463" id="Page_463">[Pg 463]</a></span>ornament
+to the city, instead of an eye-sore as they formerly
+were. Sixty public vehicles, light cabriolets,
+some of them built in Par&aacute;, now plied in the streets, increasing
+much the animation of the beautified squares,
+streets, and avenues. I was glad to see several new
+book-sellers' shops; also a fine edifice devoted to a
+reading-room, supplied with periodicals, globes, and
+maps; and a circulating library. There were now
+many printing-offices, and four daily newspapers.
+The health of the place had greatly improved since
+1850,&mdash;the year of the yellow-fever; and Par&aacute; was
+now considered no longer dangerous to new-comers.</p>
+
+<p>"So much for the improvements visible in the
+place; and now for the dark side of the picture. The
+expenses of living had increased about fourfold; a
+natural consequence of the demand for labor and for
+native products of all kinds having augmented in
+greater ratio than the supply, in consequence of
+large arrivals of non-productive residents, and considerable
+importations of money, on account of the
+steamboat-company and foreign merchants.</p>
+
+<p>"At length, on the 2d of June, I left Par&aacute;,&mdash;probably
+forever. I took a last view of the glorious
+forest for which I had so much love, and to explore
+which I had devoted so many years. The saddest
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_464" id="Page_464">[Pg 464]</a></span>hours I recollect ever to have spent were those of
+the succeeding night, when, the pilot having left us
+out of sight of land, though within the mouth of the
+river, waiting for a wind, I felt that the last link
+which connected me with the land of so many pleasing
+recollections was broken."</p>
+<br />
+
+<h3>THE END.</h3>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<h4><span class="smcap">Press of Geo. C. Rand &amp; Avery, No. 3, Cornhill, Boston.</span></h4>
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+
+<div class="tr">
+<p class="cen"><a name="TN" id="TN"></a>Transcriber's Note</p>
+<br />
+Some inconsistent hyphenation and spelling in
+the original document has been preserved.<br />
+<br />
+Typographical errors corrected in the text:<br />
+<br />
+Page&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp; 74&nbsp; Sascatchawan changed to Saskatchawan<br />
+Page&nbsp; 103&nbsp; Cameawait changed to Cameahwait<br />
+Page&nbsp; 192&nbsp; Chinnook changed to Chinook<br />
+Page&nbsp; 198&nbsp; Chinnooks changed to Chinooks<br />
+Page&nbsp; 199&nbsp; Chinnooks changed to Chinooks<br />
+Page&nbsp; 199&nbsp; Killamucks changed to Killimucks<br />
+Page&nbsp; 212&nbsp; Wakiacums changed to Wahkiacums<br />
+Page&nbsp; 224&nbsp; Kooskooskie changed to Kooskooskee<br />
+Page&nbsp; 224&nbsp; Sacajaweah chanaged to Sacajawea<br />
+Page&nbsp; 232&nbsp; Kooskooskie changed to Kooskooskee<br />
+Page&nbsp; 295&nbsp; palmitoes changed to palmitos<br />
+Page&nbsp; 299&nbsp; groweth changed to growth<br />
+Page&nbsp; 360&nbsp; pursuaded changed to persuaded<br />
+</div>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+<pre>
+
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Oregon and Eldorado, by Thomas Bulfinch
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK OREGON AND ELDORADO ***
+
+***** This file should be named 38774-h.htm or 38774-h.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ https://www.gutenberg.org/3/8/7/7/38774/
+
+Produced by Greg Bergquist, Barbara Kosker and the Online
+Distributed Proofreading Team at https://www.pgdp.net (This
+file was produced from images generously made available
+by The Internet Archive/American Libraries.)
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+https://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at https://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+https://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at https://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit https://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit: https://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ https://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+
+</pre>
+
+</body>
+</html>